Juniper Networks Network Router J2350 User Manual

J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router  
Getting Started Guide  
Release 9.2  
Juniper Networks, Inc.  
1194 North Mathilda Avenue  
Sunnyvale, California 94089  
USA  
408-745-2000  
www.juniper.net  
Part Number: 530-025360-01, Revision 1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
End User License Agreement  
READ THIS END USER LICENSE AGREEMENT (AGREEMENT) BEFORE DOWNLOADING, INSTALLING, OR USING THE SOFTWARE. BY DOWNLOADING,  
INSTALLING, OR USING THE SOFTWARE OR OTHERWISE EXPRESSING YOUR AGREEMENT TO THE TERMS CONTAINED HEREIN, YOU (AS CUSTOMER  
OR IF YOU ARE NOT THE CUSTOMER, AS A REPRESENTATIVE/AGENT AUTHORIZED TO BIND THE CUSTOMER) CONSENT TO BE BOUND BY THIS  
AGREEMENT. IF YOU DO NOT OR CANNOT AGREE TO THE TERMS CONTAINED HEREIN, THEN (A) DO NOT DOWNLOAD, INSTALL, OR USE THE SOFTWARE,  
AND (B) YOU MAY CONTACT JUNIPER NETWORKS REGARDING LICENSE TERMS.  
1. The Parties. The parties to this Agreement are Juniper Networks, Inc. and its subsidiaries (collectively Juniper), and the person or organization that  
originally purchased from Juniper or an authorized Juniper reseller the applicable license(s) for use of the Software (Customer) (collectively, the Parties).  
2. The Software. In this Agreement, Softwaremeans the program modules and features of the Juniper or Juniper-supplied software, and updates and  
releases of such software, for which Customer has paid the applicable license or support fees to Juniper or an authorized Juniper reseller. Embedded  
Softwaremeans Software which Juniper has embedded in the Juniper equipment.  
3. License Grant. Subject to payment of the applicable fees and the limitations and restrictions set forth herein, Juniper grants to Customer a non-exclusive  
and non-transferable license, without right to sublicense, to use the Software, in executable form only, subject to the following use restrictions:  
a. Customer shall use the Embedded Software solely as embedded in, and for execution on, Juniper equipment originally purchased by Customer from  
Juniper or an authorized Juniper reseller.  
b. Customer shall use the Software on a single hardware chassis having a single processing unit, or as many chassis or processing units for which Customer  
has paid the applicable license fees; provided, however, with respect to the Steel-Belted Radius or Odyssey Access Client software only, Customer shall use  
such Software on a single computer containing a single physical random access memory space and containing any number of processors. Use of the  
Steel-Belted Radius software on multiple computers requires multiple licenses, regardless of whether such computers are physically contained on a single  
chassis.  
c. Product purchase documents, paper or electronic user documentation, and/or the particular licenses purchased by Customer may specify limits to  
Customers use of the Software. Such limits may restrict use to a maximum number of seats, registered endpoints, concurrent users, sessions, calls,  
connections, subscribers, clusters, nodes, realms, devices, links, ports or transactions, or require the purchase of separate licenses to use particular features,  
functionalities, services, applications, operations, or capabilities, or provide throughput, performance, configuration, bandwidth, interface, processing,  
temporal, or geographical limits. In addition, such limits may restrict the use of the Software to managing certain kinds of networks or require the Software  
to be used only in conjunction with other specific Software. Customers use of the Software shall be subject to all such limitations and purchase of all applicable  
licenses.  
d. For any trial copy of the Software, Customers right to use the Software expires 30 days after download, installation or use of the Software. Customer  
may operate the Software after the 30-day trial period only if Customer pays for a license to do so. Customer may not extend or create an additional trial  
period by re-installing the Software after the 30-day trial period.  
e. The Global Enterprise Edition of the Steel-Belted Radius software may be used by Customer only to manage access to Customers enterprise network.  
Specifically, service provider customers are expressly prohibited from using the Global Enterprise Edition of the Steel-Belted Radius software to support any  
commercial network access services.  
The foregoing license is not transferable or assignable by Customer. No license is granted herein to any user who did not originally purchase the applicable  
license(s) for the Software from Juniper or an authorized Juniper reseller.  
4. Use Prohibitions. Notwithstanding the foregoing, the license provided herein does not permit the Customer to, and Customer agrees not to and shall  
not: (a) modify, unbundle, reverse engineer, or create derivative works based on the Software; (b) make unauthorized copies of the Software (except as  
necessary for backup purposes); (c) rent, sell, transfer, or grant any rights in and to any copy of the Software, in any form, to any third party; (d) remove  
any proprietary notices, labels, or marks on or in any copy of the Software or any product in which the Software is embedded; (e) distribute any copy of  
the Software to any third party, including as may be embedded in Juniper equipment sold in the secondhand market; (f) use any lockedor key-restricted  
feature, function, service, application, operation, or capability without first purchasing the applicable license(s) and obtaining a valid key from Juniper, even  
if such feature, function, service, application, operation, or capability is enabled without a key; (g) distribute any key for the Software provided by Juniper  
to any third party; (h) use the Software in any manner that extends or is broader than the uses purchased by Customer from Juniper or an authorized Juniper  
reseller; (i) use the Embedded Software on non-Juniper equipment; (j) use the Software (or make it available for use) on Juniper equipment that the Customer  
did not originally purchase from Juniper or an authorized Juniper reseller; (k) disclose the results of testing or benchmarking of the Software to any third  
party without the prior written consent of Juniper; or (l) use the Software in any manner other than as expressly provided herein.  
5. Audit. Customer shall maintain accurate records as necessary to verify compliance with this Agreement. Upon request by Juniper, Customer shall furnish  
such records to Juniper and certify its compliance with this Agreement.  
6. Confidentiality. The Parties agree that aspects of the Software and associated documentation are the confidential property of Juniper. As such, Customer  
shall exercise all reasonable commercial efforts to maintain the Software and associated documentation in confidence, which at a minimum includes  
restricting access to the Software to Customer employees and contractors having a need to use the Software for Customers internal business purposes.  
iii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
7. Ownership. Juniper and Juniper's licensors, respectively, retain ownership of all right, title, and interest (including copyright) in and to the Software,  
associated documentation, and all copies of the Software. Nothing in this Agreement constitutes a transfer or conveyance of any right, title, or interest in  
the Software or associated documentation, or a sale of the Software, associated documentation, or copies of the Software.  
8. Warranty, Limitation of Liability, Disclaimer of Warranty. The warranty applicable to the Software shall be as set forth in the warranty statement that  
accompanies the Software (the Warranty Statement). Nothing in this Agreement shall give rise to any obligation to support the Software. Support services  
may be purchased separately. Any such support shall be governed by a separate, written support services agreement. TO THE MAXIMUM EXTENT PERMITTED  
BY LAW, JUNIPER SHALL NOT BE LIABLE FOR ANY LOST PROFITS, LOSS OF DATA, OR COSTS OR PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES,  
OR FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES ARISING OUT OF THIS AGREEMENT, THE SOFTWARE, OR ANY JUNIPER OR  
JUNIPER-SUPPLIED SOFTWARE. IN NO EVENT SHALL JUNIPER BE LIABLE FOR DAMAGES ARISING FROM UNAUTHORIZED OR IMPROPER USE OF ANY  
JUNIPER OR JUNIPER-SUPPLIED SOFTWARE. EXCEPT AS EXPRESSLY PROVIDED IN THE WARRANTY STATEMENT TO THE EXTENT PERMITTED BY LAW,  
JUNIPER DISCLAIMS ANY AND ALL WARRANTIES IN AND TO THE SOFTWARE (WHETHER EXPRESS, IMPLIED, STATUTORY, OR OTHERWISE), INCLUDING  
ANY IMPLIED WARRANTY OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE, OR NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT DOES JUNIPER  
WARRANT THAT THE SOFTWARE, OR ANY EQUIPMENT OR NETWORK RUNNING THE SOFTWARE, WILL OPERATE WITHOUT ERROR OR INTERRUPTION,  
OR WILL BE FREE OF VULNERABILITY TO INTRUSION OR ATTACK. In no event shall Junipers or its suppliersor licensorsliability to Customer, whether  
in contract, tort (including negligence), breach of warranty, or otherwise, exceed the price paid by Customer for the Software that gave rise to the claim, or  
if the Software is embedded in another Juniper product, the price paid by Customer for such other product. Customer acknowledges and agrees that Juniper  
has set its prices and entered into this Agreement in reliance upon the disclaimers of warranty and the limitations of liability set forth herein, that the same  
reflect an allocation of risk between the Parties (including the risk that a contract remedy may fail of its essential purpose and cause consequential loss),  
and that the same form an essential basis of the bargain between the Parties.  
9. Termination. Any breach of this Agreement or failure by Customer to pay any applicable fees due shall result in automatic termination of the license  
granted herein. Upon such termination, Customer shall destroy or return to Juniper all copies of the Software and related documentation in Customers  
possession or control.  
10. Taxes. All license fees for the Software are exclusive of taxes, withholdings, duties, or levies (collectively Taxes). Customer shall be responsible for  
paying Taxes arising from the purchase of the license, or importation or use of the Software.  
11. Export. Customer agrees to comply with all applicable export laws and restrictions and regulations of any United States and any applicable foreign  
agency or authority, and not to export or re-export the Software or any direct product thereof in violation of any such restrictions, laws or regulations, or  
without all necessary approvals. Customer shall be liable for any such violations. The version of the Software supplied to Customer may contain encryption  
or other capabilities restricting Customers ability to export the Software without an export license.  
12. Commercial Computer Software. The Software is commercial computer softwareand is provided with restricted rights. Use, duplication, or disclosure  
by the United States government is subject to restrictions set forth in this Agreement and as provided in DFARS 227.7201 through 227.7202-4, FAR 12.212,  
FAR 27.405(b)(2), FAR 52.227-19, or FAR 52.227-14(ALT III) as applicable.  
13. Interface Information. To the extent required by applicable law, and at Customer's written request, Juniper shall provide Customer with the interface  
information needed to achieve interoperability between the Software and another independently created program, on payment of applicable fee, if any.  
Customer shall observe strict obligations of confidentiality with respect to such information and shall use such information in compliance with any applicable  
terms and conditions upon which Juniper makes such information available.  
14. Third Party Software. Any licensor of Juniper whose software is embedded in the Software and any supplier of Juniper whose products or technology  
are embedded in (or services are accessed by) the Software shall be a third party beneficiary with respect to this Agreement, and such licensor or vendor  
shall have the right to enforce this Agreement in its own name as if it were Juniper. In addition, certain third party software may be provided with the  
Software and is subject to the accompanying license(s), if any, of its respective owner(s). To the extent portions of the Software are distributed under and  
subject to open source licenses obligating Juniper to make the source code for such portions publicly available (such as the GNU General Public License  
(GPL) or the GNU Library General Public License (LGPL)), Juniper will make such source code portions (including Juniper modifications, as appropriate)  
available upon request for a period of up to three years from the date of distribution. Such request can be made in writing to Juniper Networks, Inc., 1194  
N. Mathilda Ave., Sunnyvale, CA 94089, ATTN: General Counsel. You may obtain a copy of the GPL at http://www.gnu.org/licenses/gpl.html, and a copy of  
the LGPL at http://www.gnu.org/licenses/lgpl.html.  
15. Miscellaneous. This Agreement shall be governed by the laws of the State of California without reference to its conflicts of laws principles. The provisions  
of the U.N. Convention for the International Sale of Goods shall not apply to this Agreement. For any disputes arising under this Agreement, the Parties  
hereby consent to the personal and exclusive jurisdiction of, and venue in, the state and federal courts within Santa Clara County, California. This Agreement  
constitutes the entire and sole agreement between Juniper and the Customer with respect to the Software, and supersedes all prior and contemporaneous  
agreements relating to the Software, whether oral or written (including any inconsistent terms contained in a purchase order), except that the terms of a  
separate written agreement executed by an authorized Juniper representative and Customer shall govern to the extent such terms are inconsistent or conflict  
with terms contained herein. No modification to this Agreement nor any waiver of any rights hereunder shall be effective unless expressly assented to in  
writing by the party to be charged. If any portion of this Agreement is held invalid, the Parties agree that such invalidity shall not affect the validity of the  
remainder of this Agreement. This Agreement and associated documentation has been written in the English language, and the Parties agree that the English  
version will govern. (For Canada: Les parties aux présentés confirment leur volonté que cette convention de même que tous les documents y compris tout  
avis qui s'y rattaché, soient redigés en langue anglaise. (Translation: The parties confirm that this Agreement and all related documentation is and will be  
in the English language)).  
iv  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
vi  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Table of Contents  
Objectives ......................................................................................................xv  
Audience .......................................................................................................xv  
How to Use This Guide .................................................................................xvi  
Document Conventions ...............................................................................xvii  
Related Juniper Networks Documentation ..................................................xviii  
Documentation Feedback .............................................................................xxi  
Requesting Technical Support ......................................................................xxi  
J2320 Services Router Overview .....................................................................3  
J2350 Services Router Overview .....................................................................4  
J4350 Services Router Overview .....................................................................5  
J6350 Services Router Overview .....................................................................6  
J-series Software Features and Licenses ...........................................................7  
J2320 and J2350 Chassis .........................................................................13  
J2320 and J2350 Midplane ......................................................................18  
J2320 and J2350 Routing Engine Hardware ............................................18  
J2320 and J2350 Boot Devices ................................................................19  
J2320 and J2350 Front Panel ..................................................................19  
Physical Interface Modules (PIMs) ....................................................20  
Power Button and POWER LED ........................................................20  
STATUS LED .....................................................................................21  
ALARM LED ......................................................................................21  
HA LED ............................................................................................22  
RESET CONFIG Button .....................................................................22  
Built-In Gigabit Ethernet Ports ..........................................................23  
Console Port .....................................................................................23  
AUX Port ..........................................................................................23  
USB Port ...........................................................................................24  
J2320 and J2350 External Compact Flashes ............................................24  
Table of Contents  
vii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
J2320 Power System ...............................................................................24  
J2350 Power System ...............................................................................24  
J2320 and J2350 Cooling System ............................................................25  
J4350 and J6350 Chassis .........................................................................27  
J4350 and J6350 Midplane ......................................................................31  
J4350 and J6350 Routing Engine Hardware ............................................31  
J4350 and J6350 Boot Devices ................................................................31  
J4350 and J6350 Front Panel ..................................................................32  
Physical Interface Modules (PIMs) ....................................................32  
Power Button and POWER LED ........................................................33  
STATUS LED .....................................................................................33  
ALARM LED ......................................................................................34  
HA LED ............................................................................................34  
RESET CONFIG Button .....................................................................35  
Built-In Gigabit Ethernet Ports ..........................................................35  
Console Port .....................................................................................36  
AUX Port ..........................................................................................36  
USB Port ...........................................................................................36  
J4350 Power System ...............................................................................36  
J6350 Power System ...............................................................................37  
J4350 and J6350 Cooling System ............................................................38  
Software Overview ........................................................................................39  
Routing Engine and Packet Forwarding Engine .......................................40  
Kernel and Microkernel ..........................................................................40  
JUNOS Software Processes ......................................................................40  
User Interfaces ........................................................................................41  
PIM and VoIP Module Terms .........................................................................43  
Field-Replaceable PIMs ..................................................................................46  
J2320 and J2350 Field-Replaceable PIM Summary ..................................46  
J4350 and J6350 Field-Replaceable PIM Summary ..................................47  
1-Port Gigabit Ethernet ePIMs .................................................................52  
Dual-Port Serial PIM ................................................................................55  
Dual-Port T1 or E1 PIM ...........................................................................56  
Dual-Port Channelized T1/E1/ISDN PRI PIM ............................................57  
T3 or E3 PIM ...........................................................................................59  
Dual-Port Fast Ethernet PIM ....................................................................60  
4-Port Fast Ethernet ePIM .......................................................................61  
4-Port ISDN BRI PIMs ..............................................................................62  
ADSL PIM ................................................................................................64  
G.SHDSL PIM ..........................................................................................65  
Avaya VoIP Modules ......................................................................................66  
Avaya VoIP Module Summary .................................................................67  
TGM550 Telephony Gateway Module ......................................................69  
TIM508 Analog Telephony Interface Module ...........................................73  
TIM510 E1/T1 Telephony Interface Module ............................................74  
viii  
Table of Contents  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Table of Contents  
TIM514 Analog Telephony Interface Module ...........................................75  
TIM516 Analog Telephony Interface Module ...........................................76  
TIM518 Analog Telephony Interface Module ...........................................78  
TIM521 BRI Telephony Interface Module ................................................79  
User Interface Overview ................................................................................81  
J-Web Overview ......................................................................................81  
CLI Overview ..........................................................................................82  
Before You Begin ...........................................................................................82  
Using the J-Web Interface ..............................................................................83  
Starting the J-Web Interface ....................................................................83  
J-Web Layout ..........................................................................................83  
Elements of the J-Web Interface ..............................................................84  
Top Pane Elements ..........................................................................85  
Main Pane Elements .........................................................................85  
Side Pane Elements ..........................................................................86  
Navigating the J-Web Interface ................................................................87  
Navigating the Quick Configuration Pages ........................................88  
Navigating the J-Web Configuration Editor .......................................88  
Getting J-Web Help ...........................................................................89  
J-Web Sessions ........................................................................................90  
Using the Command-Line Interface ...............................................................91  
CLI Command Hierarchy ........................................................................91  
Starting the CLI .......................................................................................92  
CLI Operational Mode .............................................................................92  
CLI Configuration Mode ..........................................................................93  
CLI Basics ...............................................................................................94  
Editing Keystrokes ............................................................................94  
Command Completion .....................................................................95  
Online Help ......................................................................................96  
Configuring the CLI Environment .....................................................97  
General Site Guidelines ................................................................................103  
Rack Requirements .....................................................................................104  
Connection to Building Structure ..........................................................105  
Router Environmental Tolerances ...............................................................106  
Fire Safety Requirements ............................................................................106  
Fire Suppression ...................................................................................106  
Fire Suppression Equipment .................................................................107  
Table of Contents  
ix  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
Site Electrical Wiring Guidelines ............................................................108  
Signaling Limitations ......................................................................108  
Radio Frequency Interference ........................................................108  
Electromagnetic Compatibility .......................................................108  
Router Power Requirements .................................................................109  
Planning for Power Management ..........................................................112  
Network Cable Specifications ......................................................................115  
ISDN Provisioning .......................................................................................115  
Site Preparation Checklist ............................................................................115  
Before You Begin .........................................................................................117  
Unpacking a J-series Services Router ...........................................................118  
Installing J2320 and J2350 Routers .............................................................119  
Installing J4350 and J6350 Routers .............................................................120  
Connecting Interface Cables to Services Routers .........................................123  
Chassis Grounding .......................................................................................123  
Connecting Power .......................................................................................124  
Connecting AC Power ...........................................................................124  
Connecting DC Power ...........................................................................126  
Powering a Services Router On and Off ......................................................129  
Basic Connectivity Terms ............................................................................131  
Basic Connectivity Overview .......................................................................132  
Router Identification .............................................................................132  
Root Password ......................................................................................133  
Time Zone and System Time ................................................................133  
Network Settings ...................................................................................133  
Default Gateway ...................................................................................134  
Backup Router ......................................................................................134  
Loopback Address .................................................................................134  
Built-In Ethernet Interface Address .......................................................134  
Management Access .............................................................................135  
Before You Begin .........................................................................................136  
Connecting to a Services Router ..................................................................137  
Connecting to the J-Web Interface ........................................................137  
Connecting to the CLI Locally ................................................................139  
Connecting to the CLI Remotely ...........................................................141  
Configuring the Modem at the Router End .....................................141  
Connecting the Modem to the Console Port ...................................142  
Connecting to the CLI at the User End ............................................143  
x
Table of Contents  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Table of Contents  
Verifying Basic Connectivity ........................................................................150  
Displaying Basic Connectivity Configurations .......................................150  
Secure Web Access Terms ...........................................................................153  
Secure Web Access Overview ......................................................................154  
Before You Begin .........................................................................................154  
Generating SSL Certificates ...................................................................155  
Configuring Secure Web Access ..................................................................155  
Verifying Secure Web Access ......................................................................159  
Displaying an SSL Certificate Configuration ..........................................159  
Displaying a Secure Access Configuration .............................................160  
J-series License Overview ............................................................................161  
License Enforcement ............................................................................161  
Software Feature Licenses ....................................................................162  
License Key Components ......................................................................162  
Before You Begin .........................................................................................162  
Adding New Licenses with the J-Web Interface .....................................164  
Deleting Licenses with the J-Web Interface ...........................................164  
Downloading Licenses with the J-Web Interface ....................................164  
Managing J-series Licenses with the CLI ......................................................165  
Adding New Licenses with the CLI ........................................................165  
Deleting a License with the CLI .............................................................165  
Saving License Keys with the CLI ..........................................................166  
Verifying J-series License Management ........................................................166  
Displaying Installed Licenses ................................................................166  
Displaying License Usage ......................................................................167  
Displaying Installed License Keys .........................................................167  
Tools and Parts Required ............................................................................171  
Replacing the Console Port Cable ................................................................172  
Replacing a PIM ..........................................................................................172  
Removing a PIM ...................................................................................172  
Installing a PIM .....................................................................................174  
Table of Contents  
xi  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
Replacing PIM Cables ..................................................................................175  
Removing PIM Cables ...........................................................................175  
Installing PIM Cables .............................................................................175  
Replacing External Compact Flashes ...........................................................184  
Replacing USB Storage Devices ...................................................................186  
Removing the USB Storage Device ........................................................186  
Installing the USB Storage Device .........................................................187  
Replacing DRAM Modules ...........................................................................188  
Removing a DRAM Module ...................................................................189  
Installing a DRAM Module .....................................................................190  
Replacing Power System Components ........................................................191  
Replacing AC Power Supply Cords ........................................................191  
Replacing DC Power Supply Cables .......................................................194  
Removing a DC Power Supply ..............................................................195  
Installing a DC Power Supply ................................................................196  
Replacing Air Filters on J2350 Routers ........................................................205  
Replacing Air Filters on J4350 and J6350 Routers .......................................206  
Chassis Alarm Conditions ............................................................................209  
Troubleshooting Power Management ..........................................................210  
Locating Component Serial Numbers ..........................................................213  
PIM Serial Number Label ......................................................................216  
Power Supply Serial Number Labels ......................................................216  
Contacting Customer Support ......................................................................216  
Information You Might Need to Supply to JTAC ....................................216  
Return Procedure ........................................................................................216  
Packing a Router or Component for Shipment ............................................217  
Tools and Parts Required ......................................................................217  
Packing the Services Router for Shipment ............................................218  
Packing Components for Shipment .......................................................218  
xii  
Table of Contents  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Table of Contents  
Serial PIM Cable Specifications ....................................................................223  
RS-232 DTE Cable Pinout ......................................................................224  
RS-232 DCE Cable Pinout .....................................................................225  
RS-422/449 (EIA-449) DTE Cable Pinout ...............................................225  
RS-422/449 (EIA-449) DCE Cable Pinout ...............................................227  
EIA-530A DTE Cable Pinout ..................................................................228  
EIA-530A DCE Cable Pinout ..................................................................229  
V.35 DTE Cable Pinout ..........................................................................230  
V.35 DCE Cable Pinout .........................................................................231  
X.21 DTE Cable Pinout .........................................................................231  
X.21 DCE Cable Pinout .........................................................................232  
Fast Ethernet RJ-45 Connector Pinout .........................................................233  
Gigabit Ethernet uPIM RJ-45 Connector Pinout ............................................233  
Gigabit Ethernet ePIM RJ-45 Connector Pinout ............................................234  
Chassis Console Port Pinouts .......................................................................234  
E1 and T1 RJ-48 Cable Pinouts ....................................................................235  
E3 and T3 BNC Connector Pinout ................................................................238  
ADSL and G.SHDSL RJ-11 Connector Pinout ................................................238  
ISDN RJ-45 Connector Pinout ......................................................................239  
Connector Pinouts for Avaya VoIP Modules .................................................239  
TGM550 Console Port Pinouts ..............................................................239  
TIM508 Connector Pinout .....................................................................241  
TIM510 RJ-45 Connector Pinout ............................................................241  
TIM514 Connector Pinout .....................................................................242  
TIM516 Connector Pinout .....................................................................242  
TIM518 Connector Pinout .....................................................................244  
TIM521 Connector Pinout .....................................................................245  
Definition of Safety Warning Levels ............................................................247  
Safety Guidelines and Warnings ..................................................................249  
General Safety Guidelines and Warnings ...............................................249  
Qualified Personnel Warning ..........................................................250  
Preventing Electrostatic Discharge Damage ...................................251  
Electrical Safety Guidelines and Warnings ............................................252  
General Electrical Safety Guidelines ................................................252  
AC Power Electrical Safety Guidelines ............................................253  
DC Power Electrical Safety Guidelines ............................................254  
DC Power Disconnection Warning .................................................255  
DC Power Wiring Sequence Warning .............................................257  
DC Power Wiring Terminations Warning .......................................259  
Table of Contents  
xiii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
Grounded Equipment Warning .......................................................260  
Warning Statement for Norway and Sweden ..................................261  
In Case of Electrical Accident .........................................................261  
Power Disconnection Warning .......................................................263  
TN Power Warning .........................................................................264  
Telecommunication Line Cord Warning .........................................265  
Installation Safety Guidelines and Warnings .........................................266  
Chassis Lifting Guidelines ...............................................................266  
Installation Instructions Warning ....................................................266  
Rack-Mounting Requirements and Warnings ..................................267  
Ramp Warning ...............................................................................271  
Laser and LED Safety Guidelines and Warnings ....................................271  
General Laser Safety Guidelines ......................................................272  
Class 1 Laser Product Warning .......................................................272  
Class 1 LED Product Warning .........................................................273  
Laser Beam Warning ......................................................................273  
Battery Handling Warning ..............................................................276  
Jewelry Removal Warning ..............................................................277  
Lightning Activity Warning .............................................................278  
Operating Temperature Warning ....................................................279  
Product Disposal Warning ..............................................................281  
Agency Approvals ........................................................................................282  
Lithium Battery .....................................................................................283  
Compliance Statements for NEBS ................................................................283  
Compliance Statements for EMC Requirements ..........................................283  
Canada .................................................................................................284  
European Community ...........................................................................285  
Japan ....................................................................................................286  
United States ........................................................................................287  
FCC Part 15 Statement ...................................................................287  
FCC Part 68 Statement ...................................................................287  
Index ...........................................................................................................291  
xiv  
Table of Contents  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
About This Guide  
This preface provides the following guidelines for using the J2320, J2350, J4350, and  
J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide:  
Objectives  
This guide contains an overview, basic instructions, and specifications for J2320,  
J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Routers. It explains how to prepare your site for  
installation, unpack and install a Services Router and its components, power on the  
router, install licenses, and establish basic connectivity.  
J-series Services Router operations are controlled by the JUNOS software. You direct  
the JUNOS software through either a Web browser or a command-line interface (CLI).  
NOTE: This guide documents Release 9.2 of the JUNOS software. For additional  
information about J-series Services Routerseither corrections to or omissions from  
this guidesee the J-series Services Router Release Notes at http://www.juniper.net.  
Audience  
This guide is designed for anyone who installs and sets up a J-series Services Router  
or prepares a site for Services Router installation. The guide is intended for the  
following audiences:  
Customers with technical knowledge of and experience with networks and the  
Internet  
Network administrators who install, configure, and manage Internet routers but  
are unfamiliar with the JUNOS software  
Objectives  
xv  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
Network administrators who install, configure, and manage products of Juniper  
Networks  
Personnel operating the equipment must be trained and competent; must not conduct  
themselves in a careless, willfully negligent, or hostile manner; and must abide by  
the instructions provided by the documentation.  
How to Use This Guide  
J-series documentation explains how to install, configure, and manage J-series routers  
by providing information about JUNOS implementation specifically on J-series routers.  
(For comprehensive JUNOS information, see the JUNOS software manuals listed in  
the location of J-series information, by task type, in Juniper Networks documentation.  
Table 1: Location of J-series Information  
J-series Tasks  
Location of Instruction  
Installing hardware and establishing basic connectivity  
Getting Started Guide for your router  
Configuring interfaces and routing protocols such as RIP, OSPF, BGP, J-series Services Router Basic LAN and WAN Access  
and IS-IS Configuration Guide  
Configuring advanced features such as virtual private networks (VPNs), J-series Services Router Advanced WAN Access  
IP Security (IPsec), multicast, routing policies, firewall filters, and class Configuration Guide  
of service (CoS)  
Managing users and operations, monitoring performance, upgrading J-series Services Router Administration Guide  
software, and diagnosing common problems  
Using the J-Web interface  
Using the CLI  
J-Web Interface User Guide  
JUNOS CLI User Guide  
Typically, J-series documentation provides both general and specific informationfor  
example, a configuration overview, configuration examples, and verification methods.  
Because you can configure and manage J-series routers in several ways, you can  
choose from multiple sets of instructions to perform a task. To make best use of this  
information:  
If you are new to the topicRead through the initial overview information, keep  
the related JUNOS guide handy for details about the JUNOS hierarchy, and follow  
the step-by-step instructions for your preferred interface.  
If you are already familiar with the featureGo directly to the instructions for the  
interface of your choice, and follow the instructions. You can choose a J-Web  
method, the JUNOS CLI, or a combination of methods based on the level of  
complexity or your familiarity with the interface.  
For many J-series features, you can use J-Web Quick Configuration pages to configure  
the router quickly and easily without configuring each statement individually. For  
xvi  
How to Use This Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
About This Guide  
more extensive configuration, use the J-Web configuration editor or CLI configuration  
mode commands.  
To monitor, diagnose, and manage a router, use the J-Web interface or CLI operational  
mode commands.  
Document Conventions  
Table 2 on page xvii defines the notice icons used in this guide.  
Table 2: Notice Icons  
Icon Meaning  
Description  
Informational note  
Caution  
Indicates important features or instructions.  
Indicates a situation that might result in loss of data or hardware damage.  
Warning  
Alerts you to the risk of personal injury or death.  
Alerts you to the risk of personal injury from a laser.  
Laser warning  
Table 3 on page xvii defines the text and syntax conventions used in this guide.  
Table 3: Text and Syntax Conventions  
Convention  
Description  
Examples  
Represents text that you type.  
To enter configuration mode, type the  
Bold text like this  
configure command:  
user@host> configure  
Represents output that appears on the  
terminal screen.  
Fixed-width text like this  
user@host> show chassis alarms  
No alarms currently active  
Italic text like this  
Introduces important new terms.  
A policy term is a named structure  
that defines match conditions and  
actions.  
Identifies book names.  
Identifies RFC and Internet draft  
titles.  
JUNOS System Basics Configuration  
Guide  
RFC 1997, BGP Communities  
Attribute  
Document Conventions  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
xvii  
         
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
Table 3: Text and Syntax Conventions (continued)  
Convention  
Description  
Examples  
Represents variables (options for which Configure the machines domain name:  
Italic text like this  
you substitute a value) in commands or  
configuration statements.  
[edit]  
root@# set system domain-name  
domain-name  
Represents names of configuration  
statements, commands, files, and  
directories; IP addresses; configuration  
hierarchy levels; or labels on routing  
platform components.  
To configure a stub area, include  
the stub statement at the [edit  
protocols ospf area area-id]  
hierarchy level.  
Plain text like this  
The console port is labeled  
CONSOLE.  
< > (angle brackets)  
| (pipe symbol)  
Enclose optional keywords or variables.  
stub <default-metric metric>;  
broadcast | multicast  
Indicates a choice between the mutually  
exclusive keywords or variables on either  
side of the symbol. The set of choices is  
often enclosed in parentheses for clarity.  
(string1 | string2 | string3)  
# (pound sign)  
Indicates a comment specified on the  
same line as the configuration statement  
to which it applies.  
rsvp { # Required for dynamic MPLS only  
[ ] (square brackets)  
Indention and braces ( { } )  
; (semicolon)  
Enclose a variable for which you can  
substitute one or more values.  
community name members [  
community-ids ]  
Identify a level in the configuration  
hierarchy.  
[edit]  
routing-options {  
static {  
route default {  
Identifies a leaf statement at a  
configuration hierarchy level.  
nexthop address;  
retain;  
}
}
}
J-Web GUI Conventions  
Bold text like this  
Represents J-Web graphical user  
In the Logical Interfaces box, select  
interface (GUI) items you click or select.  
All Interfaces.  
To cancel the configuration, click  
Cancel.  
> (bold right angle bracket)  
Separates levels in a hierarchy of J-Web In the configuration editor hierarchy,  
selections. select Protocols>Ospf.  
Related Juniper Networks Documentation  
J-series Services Routers are documented in multiple guides. Although the J-series  
guides provide instructions for configuring and managing a Services Router with the  
JUNOS CLI, they are not a comprehensive JUNOS software resource. For complete  
xviii  
Related Juniper Networks Documentation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
About This Guide  
documentation of the statements and commands described in J-series guides, see  
the JUNOS software manuals listed in Table 4 on page xix.  
Table 4: J-series Guides and Related JUNOS Software Publications  
Chapter in a J-series Guide  
Corresponding JUNOS Software Manual  
Getting Started Guide for Your Router  
Services Router User Interface Overview”  
JUNOS CLI User Guide  
JUNOS System Basics Configuration Guide  
Establishing Basic Connectivity”  
J-series Services Router Basic LAN and WAN Access Configuration Guide  
Using Services Router Configuration Tools”  
JUNOS CLI User Guide  
JUNOS System Basics Configuration Guide  
Interfaces Overview”  
JUNOS Network Interfaces Configuration Guide  
JUNOS Interfaces Command Reference  
Configuring DS1, DS3, Ethernet, and Serial Interfaces”  
Configuring Channelized T1/E1/ISDN PRI Interfaces”  
Configuring Digital Subscriber Line Interfaces  
Configuring Point-to-Point Protocol over Ethernet”  
Configuring ISDN”  
Configuring Link Services Interfaces”  
JUNOS Services Interfaces Configuration Guide  
JUNOS System Basics and Services Command Reference  
Configuring VoIP”  
JUNOS Network Interfaces Configuration Guide  
JUNOS Interfaces Command Reference  
Configuring uPIMs as Ethernet Switches”  
JUNOS Network Interfaces Configuration Guide  
JUNOS System Basics Configuration Guide  
JUNOS System Basics and Services Command Reference  
Routing Overview”  
JUNOS Routing Protocols Configuration Guide  
JUNOS Routing Protocols and Policies Command Reference  
Configuring Static Routes”  
Configuring a RIP Network”  
Configuring an OSPF Network”  
Configuring the IS-IS Protocol”  
Configuring BGP Sessions”  
J-series Services Router Advanced WAN Access Configuration Guide  
Related Juniper Networks Documentation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
xix  
 
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
Table 4: J-series Guides and Related JUNOS Software Publications (continued)  
Chapter in a J-series Guide  
Corresponding JUNOS Software Manual  
Multiprotocol Label Switching Overview”  
Configuring Signaling Protocols for Traffic Engineering”  
Configuring Virtual Private Networks”  
Configuring CLNS VPNs”  
JUNOS MPLS Applications Configuration Guide  
JUNOS Routing Protocols and Policies Command Reference  
JUNOS VPNs Configuration Guide  
Configuring IPSec for Secure Packet Exchange”  
JUNOS System Basics Configuration Guide  
JUNOS Services Interfaces Configuration Guide  
JUNOS System Basics and Services Command Reference  
Multicast Overview”  
JUNOS Multicast Protocols Configuration Guide  
JUNOS Routing Protocols and Policies Command Reference  
Configuring a Multicast Network”  
Configuring Data Link Switching”  
JUNOS Services Interfaces Configuration Guide  
JUNOS System Basics and Services Command Reference  
Policy Framework Overview”  
Configuring Routing Policies”  
Configuring NAT”  
JUNOS Policy Framework Configuration Guide  
JUNOS Routing Protocols and Policies Command Reference  
JUNOS Network Interfaces Configuration Guide  
JUNOS Policy Framework Configuration Guide  
JUNOS Services Interfaces Configuration Guide  
Configuring Stateful Firewall Filters and NAT”  
Configuring Stateless Firewall Filters”  
Secure Configuration Guide for Common Criteria and  
JUNOS-FIPS  
JUNOS System Basics and Services Command Reference  
JUNOS Routing Protocols and Policies Command Reference  
Class-of-Service Overview”  
Configuring Class of Service”  
JUNOS Class of Service Configuration Guide  
JUNOS System Basics and Services Command Reference  
J-series Services Router Administration Guide  
Managing User Authentication and Access”  
JUNOS System Basics Configuration Guide  
Secure Configuration Guide for Common Criteria and  
JUNOS-FIPS  
Setting Up USB Modems for Remote Management”  
Configuring SNMP for Network Management”  
Configuring the Router as a DHCP Server”  
Configuring Autoinstallation”  
JUNOS Network Management Configuration Guide  
JUNOS System Basics Configuration Guide  
Automating Network Operations and Troubleshooting”  
JUNOS Configuration and Diagnostic Automation Guide  
xx  
Related Juniper Networks Documentation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
About This Guide  
Table 4: J-series Guides and Related JUNOS Software Publications (continued)  
Chapter in a J-series Guide  
Corresponding JUNOS Software Manual  
Monitoring the Router and Routing Operations”  
JUNOS System Basics and Services Command Reference  
JUNOS Interfaces Command Reference  
JUNOS Routing Protocols and Policies Command Reference  
Monitoring Events and Managing System Log Files”  
JUNOS System Log Messages Reference  
Secure Configuration Guide for Common Criteria and  
JUNOS-FIPS  
Configuring and Monitoring Alarms”  
Performing Software Upgrades and Reboots”  
Managing Files”  
JUNOS System Basics Configuration Guide  
JUNOS Software Installation and Upgrade Guide  
JUNOS System Basics Configuration Guide  
Using Services Router Diagnostic Tools”  
JUNOS System Basics and Services Command Reference  
JUNOS Interfaces Command Reference  
JUNOS Routing Protocols and Policies Command Reference  
Configuring Packet Capture”  
Configuring RPM Probes”  
JUNOS Services Interfaces Configuration Guide  
JUNOS System Basics and Services Command Reference  
Documentation Feedback  
We encourage you to provide feedback, comments, and suggestions so that we can  
improve the documentation. You can send your comments to  
[email protected], or fill out the documentation feedback form at  
to include the following information with your comments:  
Document name  
Document part number  
Page number  
Software release version (not required for Network Operations Guides [NOGs])  
Requesting Technical Support  
Technical product support is available through the Juniper Networks Technical  
Assistance Center (JTAC). If you are a customer with an active J-Care or JNASC support  
contract, or are covered under warranty, and need postsales technical support, you  
can access our tools and resources online or open a case with JTAC.  
JTAC policiesFor a complete understanding of our JTAC procedures and policies,  
review the JTAC User Guide located at  
Documentation Feedback  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
xxi  
       
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
Product warrantiesFor product warranty information, visit  
JTAC Hours of Operation The JTAC centers have resources available 24 hours  
a day, 7 days a week, 365 days a year.  
Self-Help Online Tools and Resources  
For quick and easy problem resolution, Juniper Networks has designed an online  
self-service portal called the Customer Support Center (CSC) that provides you with  
the following features:  
Search for known bugs: http://www2.juniper.net/kb/  
Find product documentation: http://www.juniper.net/techpubs/  
Find solutions and answer questions using our Knowledge Base:  
Download the latest versions of software and review release notes:  
Search technical bulletins for relevant hardware and software notifications:  
Join and participate in the Juniper Networks Community Forum:  
Open a case online in the CSC Case Manager: http://www.juniper.net/cm/  
To verify service entitlement by product serial number, use our Serial Number  
Opening a Case with JTAC  
You can open a case with JTAC on the Web or by telephone.  
Use the Case Manager tool in the CSC at http://www.juniper.net/cm/ .  
Call 1-888-314-JTAC (1-888-314-5822 toll-free in the USA, Canada, and Mexico).  
For international or direct-dial options in countries without toll-free numbers, visit  
xxii  
Requesting Technical Support  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Part 1  
J-series Overview  
J-series Overview  
1
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
2
J-series Overview  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 1  
Overview of Services Routers  
J-series Services Routers provide stable, reliable, and efficient IP routing, WAN and  
LAN connectivity, and management services for small to medium-sized enterprise  
networks. Services Routers typically connect small, branch, or regional offices to a  
central site router, and link Internet service provider (ISP) networks.  
All J-series Services Routers run the JUNOS software, which offers many advanced  
routing and security services. For more information about software features, see  
base simplifies deployment, patches, and software upgrades.  
You can use two user interfaces to monitor, configure, troubleshoot, and manage a  
Services Router:  
J-Web interfaceA Web-based graphical interface that allows you to operate a  
router without commands. The J-Web interface provides access to all JUNOS  
functionality and features. Quick Configuration wizards simplify basic  
configuration and minimize the risk of operator error.  
JUNOS command-line interfaceA Juniper Networks command shell that runs  
on top of a UNIX-based operating system kernel. The CLI is a straightforward  
command interface. On a single line, you type commands that are executed  
when you press the Enter key. The CLI provides command Help and command  
completion.  
For an introduction to the J-Web and CLI interfaces, see Services Router User  
Interface Overviewon page 81. For more information, see the J-Web Interface User  
Guide and the JUNOS CLI User Guide.  
This chapter contains the following topics:  
J2320 Services Router Overview  
The J2320 Services Router is primarily designed for remote or branch offices. It has  
a small chassis that is 1 U (rack unit) in size with a nonredundant AC power supply,  
J2320 Services Router Overview  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3
       
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
an external compact flash and two universal serial bus (USB) ports for external storage,  
and an optional Crypto Accelerator Module.  
J2320 routers ordered with the optional Crypto Accelerator Module come standard  
with 1 GB of memory, while those ordered without the Crypto Accelerator Module  
come standard with 256 MB of memory. The memory on J2320 routers can be  
upgraded to 1 GB. For instructions on upgrading memory, see Replacing DRAM  
Each J2320 chassis contains four built-in Gigabit Ethernet ports with link speeds of  
10/100/1000 Mbps over a copper interface. The chassis also contains three slots for  
field-replaceable Physical Interface Modules (PIMs) and Avaya voice over IP (VoIP)  
modules providing flexible WAN and voice connectivity options.  
The J2320 Services Router supports the following field-replaceable PIMs and Avaya  
VoIP modules:  
Gigabit Ethernet uPIM (1-port, 6-port, 8-port, and 16-port)  
Dual-Port Serial PIM  
Dual-Port E1 PIM  
Dual-Port T1 PIM  
Dual-Port Channelized T1/E1/ISDN PRI PIM  
4-port ISDN BRI S/T or U PIM  
ADSL 2/2+ Annex A PIM (1 port)  
ADSL 2/2+ Annex B PIM (1 port)  
G.SHDSL PIM (2 ports)  
TGM550 Telephony Gateway Module  
TIM508 Analog Telephony Interface Module (8 ports)  
TIM510 E1/T1 Telephony Interface Module (1 port)  
TIM514 Analog Telephony Interface Module (4 ports)  
TIM516 Analog Telephony Interface Module (16 ports)  
TIM518 Analog Telephony Interface Module (16 ports)  
TIM521 BRI Telephony Interface Module (4 ports)  
J2350 Services Router Overview  
The J2350 Services Router is primarily designed for regional or branch offices. It has  
a chassis that is 1.5 U (rack unit) in size with a nonredundant AC or DC power supply,  
an external compact flash and two universal serial bus (USB) ports for external storage,  
and an optional Crypto Accelerator Module.  
J2350 routers ordered with the optional Crypto Accelerator Module come standard  
with 1 GB of memory, while those ordered without the Crypto Accelerator Module  
come standard with 256 MB of memory. The memory on J2350 routers can be  
4
J2350 Services Router Overview  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 1: Overview of Services Routers  
upgraded to 1 GB. For instructions on upgrading memory, see Replacing DRAM  
Each J2350 chassis contains four built-in Gigabit Ethernet ports with link speeds of  
10/100/1000 Mbps over a copper interface. The chassis also contains five slots for  
field-replaceable Physical Interface Modules (PIMs) and Avaya VoIP modules providing  
flexible WAN and voice connectivity options.  
The J2350 Services Router supports the following field-replaceable PIMs and Avaya  
VoIP modules:  
Gigabit Ethernet uPIM (1port, 6-port, 8-port, and 16-port)  
Dual-Port Serial PIM  
Dual-Port E1 PIM  
Dual-Port T1 PIM  
Dual-Port Channelized T1/E1/ISDN PRI PIM  
4-port ISDN BRI S/T or U PIM  
ADSL 2/2+ Annex A PIM (1 port)  
ADSL 2/2+ Annex B PIM (1 port)  
G.SHDSL PIM (2 ports)  
TGM550 Telephony Gateway Module  
TIM508 Analog Telephony Interface Module (8 ports)  
TIM510 E1/T1 Telephony Interface Module (1 port)  
TIM514 Analog Telephony Interface Module (4 ports)  
TIM516 Analog Telephony Interface Module (16 ports)  
TIM518 Analog Telephony Interface Module (16 ports)  
TIM521 ISDN BRI Telephony Interface Module (4 ports)  
J4350 Services Router Overview  
The J4350 Services Router is designed primarily for regional or branch offices. It has  
a chassis that is 2 U (rack units) in size with a nonredundant AC or DC power supply,  
and a universal serial bus (USB) port for external storage.  
J4350 routers ordered with the optional Crypto Accelerator Module come standard  
with 1 GB of memory, while those ordered without the Crypto Accelerator Module  
come standard with 256 MB of memory. J4350 routers can contain between 256  
Each J4350 chassis contains four built-in Gigabit Ethernet ports with link speeds of  
10/100/1000 Mbps over a copper interface, and six slots for field-replaceable Physical  
Interface Modules (PIMs) and Avaya VoIP modules. Two of the six slots (slots 3 and  
6) support high-speed interfaces (ePIMs).  
J4350 Services Router Overview  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5
     
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
The J4350 Services Router supports the following field-replaceable PIMs and Avaya  
VoIP modules:  
Gigabit Ethernet uPIM (1-port, 6-port, 8-port, and 16-port)  
SFP Gigabit Ethernet ePIM (1 port)  
Copper Gigabit Ethernet ePIM (1 port)  
Dual-Port Serial PIM  
Dual-Port E1 PIM  
Dual-Port T1 PIM  
Dual-Port Channelized T1/E1/ISDN PRI PIM  
E3 PIM (1 port)  
DS3 (T3) PIM (1 port)  
Dual-Port Fast Ethernet PIM  
4-port Fast Ethernet ePIM  
4-port ISDN BRI S/T or U PIM  
ADSL 2/2+ Annex A PIM (1 port)  
ADSL 2/2+ Annex B PIM (1 port)  
G.SHDSL PIM (2 ports)  
TGM550 Telephony Gateway Module  
TIM508 Analog Telephony Interface Module (8 ports)  
TIM510 E1/T1 Telephony Interface Module (1 port)  
TIM514 Analog Telephony Interface Module (4 ports)  
TIM516 Analog Telephony Interface Module (16 ports)  
TIM518 Analog Telephony Interface Module (16 ports)  
TIM521 ISDN BRI Telephony Interface Module (4 ports)  
J6350 Services Router Overview  
The J6350 Services Router is designed primarily for regional or central offices. It has  
a chassis that is 2 U (rack units) in size with an optional redundant AC or DC power  
supply, up to 2 GB of memory, and two universal serial bus (USB) ports for external  
storage. The J6350 Services Router is a higher-performance system than the J4350  
Services Router.  
J6350 routers come standard with 1 GB of memory and can be upgraded to 2 GB of  
memory. For instructions on adding memory, see Replacing DRAM  
Each J6350 chassis contains four built-in Gigabit Ethernet ports with link speeds of  
10/100/1000 Mbps over a copper interface, and six slots for field-replaceable Physical  
Interface Modules (PIMs) and Avaya VoIP modules. Four of the six slots (slots 2, 3,  
5, and 6) support high-speed interfaces (ePIMs).  
6
J6350 Services Router Overview  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 1: Overview of Services Routers  
The J6350 Services Router supports the following field-replaceable PIMs and Avaya  
VoIP modules:  
Gigabit Ethernet uPIM (1port, 6-port, 8-port, and 16-port)  
SFP Gigabit Ethernet ePIM (1 port)  
Copper Gigabit Ethernet ePIM (1 port)  
Dual-Port Serial PIM  
Dual-Port E1 PIM  
Dual-Port T1 PIM  
E3 PIM (1 port)  
DS3 (T3) PIM (1 port)  
Dual-Port Fast Ethernet PIM  
Dual-Port Channelized T1/E1/ISDN PRI PIM  
4-port Fast Ethernet ePIM  
G.SHDSL PIM (2 ports)  
4-port ISDN BRI S/T or U PIM  
ADSL 2/2+ Annex A PIM (1 port)  
ADSL 2/2+ Annex B PIM (1 port)  
TGM550 Telephony Gateway Module  
TIM508 Analog Telephony Interface Module (8 ports)  
TIM510 E1/T1 Telephony Interface Module (1 port)  
TIM514 Analog Telephony Interface Module (4 ports)  
TIM516 Analog Telephony Interface Module (16 ports)  
TIM518 Analog Telephony Interface Module (16 ports)  
TIM521 ISDN BRI Telephony Interface Module (4 ports)  
J-series Software Features and Licenses  
J-series Services Routers provide the software features listed in Table 5 on page 7.  
You must purchase a separate software license to obtain some software features.  
For more information about licenses, see Installing and Managing J-series  
Table 5: Summary of J-series Features and License Requirements  
Feature Category  
J-series Feature  
IPv4  
Separate License  
Internet Protocols  
IPv6 routing and forwarding  
J-series Software Features and Licenses  
7
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
Table 5: Summary of J-series Features and License Requirements (continued)  
Feature Category  
J-series Feature  
Separate License  
Open Shortest Path First (OSPF)  
Border Gateway Protocol (BGP)  
Routing and  
Multicast  
License required for  
advanced BGP (route  
reflectors)  
Routing Information Protocol version 1 (RIPv1) and RIPv2  
Static routes  
Intermediate System-to-Intermediate System (IS-IS)  
Connectionless Network Services (CLNS):  
End system-to-Intermediate system (ES-IS) protocol  
IS-IS extensions  
BGP extensions  
Static routes  
Multiprotocol Label Switching (MPLS):  
Layer 2 and Layer 3 virtual private networks (VPNs)  
VPN routing and forwarding (VRF) table labels  
Traffic engineering protocols:  
Label Distribution Protocol (LDP)  
Resource Reservation Protocol (RSVP)  
Multicast:  
Internet Group Management Protocol (IGMP)  
Protocol Independent Multicast (PIM)  
Distance Vector Multicast Routing Protocol (DVMRP)  
Single-source multicast  
Static addresses  
IP Address  
Management  
Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol (DHCP)  
8
J-series Software Features and Licenses  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 1: Overview of Services Routers  
Table 5: Summary of J-series Features and License Requirements (continued)  
Feature Category  
J-series Feature  
Separate License  
Ethernet:  
Encapsulation  
Media access control (MAC) encapsulation  
802.1p tagging  
Point-to-Point Protocol over Ethernet (PPPoE)  
Asynchronous Transfer Mode (ATM) for asymmetric digital subscriber  
line (ADSL) or symmetric high-speed digital subscriber line (SHDSL)  
Circuit cross-connect (CCC)  
Translational cross-connect (TCC)  
Synchronous Point-to-Point Protocol (PPP)  
Frame Relay  
High-level Data Link Control (HDLC)  
Serial encapsulation over RS-232, RS-449, X.21, V.35, and EIA-530  
connections  
802.1Q filtering and forwarding  
Multilink Frame Relay  
Multilink PPP  
Data link switching (DLSw)  
Policing and shaping  
Traffic Management  
Class-based queuing with prioritization  
Weighted random early detection (WRED)  
Queuing by virtual LAN (VLAN), data link connection identifier (DLCI),  
interface, or bundle  
Access switching provided by multiport Gigabit Ethernet uPIMs  
Ethernet Switching  
J-series Software Features and Licenses  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
Table 5: Summary of J-series Features and License Requirements (continued)  
Feature Category  
J-series Feature  
Separate License  
Common Criteria  
Security  
Network attack detection  
Denial-of-service (DoS) and distributed DoS protection  
Generic routing encapsulation (GRE), IP-over-IP, and IP Security (IPSec) tunnels  
Advanced Encryption Standard (AES) 128-, 192-, and 256-bit.  
56-bit Data Encryption Standard (DES) and 168-bit 3DES encryption  
MD5 and Secure Hash Algorithm (SHA-1) authentication  
Replay attack prevention  
Stateful firewall packet filters  
Network Address Translation (NAT)  
Compressed Real-Time Transport Protocol (CRTP)  
Voice Support  
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Routers support voice over IP (VoIP)  
routing with the Avaya IG550 Integrated Gateway, which consists of modules  
that can be installed in the PIM slots.  
Virtual Router Redundancy Protocol (VRRP)  
Graceful restart according to IETF standards  
Redundant interfaces  
High Availability  
System Management  
JUNOScope network manager  
J-Web browser interfacefor Services Router configuration and management  
JUNOScript XML application programming interface (API)  
JUNOS command-line interface (CLI)for Services Router configuration and  
management through the console, Telnet, SSH, or J-Web CLI terminal  
Simple Network Management Protocol version 1 (SNMPv1), SNMPv2, and  
SNMPv3  
J-Flow flow monitoring and accounting  
License required for  
J-Flow  
Traffic Analysis  
Packet capture (PCAP)  
Real-time performance monitoring (RPM)  
10  
J-series Software Features and Licenses  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 1: Overview of Services Routers  
Table 5: Summary of J-series Features and License Requirements (continued)  
Feature Category  
J-series Feature  
Separate License  
System log  
Activity Logging and  
Monitoring  
J-Web event viewer  
Traceroute  
Supports the following external administrator databases:  
Administration  
RADIUS  
TACACS+  
Autoinstallation  
Configuration rollback  
Button-operated configuration rescue (CONFIG)  
Confirmation of configuration changes  
Software upgrades  
Supports the following features for automating network operations and  
troubleshooting:  
Commit scripts  
Operation scripts  
Event policies  
J-series Software Features and Licenses  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
11  
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
12  
J-series Software Features and Licenses  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 2  
System Overview  
J-series J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Routers have chassis that are similar  
but with important differences. J2320, J2350, and J4350 routers have a single  
nonredundant power supply and an optional Crypto Accelerator Module. J6350  
routers have redundant power supplies and a standard Crypto Accelerator Module.  
For field-replaceable PIMs and Avaya VoIP modules, the J2320 has three slots, the  
J2350 has five slots, and the J4350 and J6350 have six slots. Of the six slots, two on  
the J4350 and four on the J6350 are enhanced (high-speed) slots.  
All J-series routers run the JUNOS software.  
This chapter contains the following topics:  
J2320 and J2350 Services Router Hardware Features  
This section contains the following topics:  
J2320 and J2350 Chassis  
The J2320 and J2350 chassis is a rigid sheet metal structure that houses all the other  
router components (see Figure 1 on page 14 through Figure 7 on page 17). The  
chassis can be installed in many types of racks or cabinets. For information about  
acceptable rack types, see Rack Requirementson page 104.  
J2320 and J2350 Services Router Hardware Features  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
13  
           
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
In addition to the components described in subsequent sections, the chassis includes  
the following components:  
Mounting bracketsOne pair of metal brackets can be mounted at the front or  
center of the chassis for mounting the chassis in a rack or cabinet.  
Earthing terminalA protective earthing terminal and a PEM nut at the rear of  
the chassis ensure safe dissipation of static electricity in all situations.  
ESD pointOne electrostatic discharge (ESD) point, a banana plug receptacle at  
the front of the chassis, minimizes the risk of electrical discharge in potentially  
hazardous environments.  
CAUTION: Before removing or installing components of a functioning router, attach  
an ESD strap to an ESD point and place the other end of the strap around your bare  
wrist. Failure to use an ESD strap could result in damage to the router.  
The router must be connected to earth ground during normal operation. The protective  
earthing terminal on the rear of the chassis is provided to connect the router to  
ground (see Figure 3 on page 15). Additional grounding is provided to an AC-powered  
router when you plug its power supply into a grounded AC power receptacle.  
For additional safety information, see Safety and Regulatory Compliance  
Figure 1: Front of J2320 Chassis  
14  
J2320 and J2350 Services Router Hardware Features  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 2: System Overview  
Figure 2: Front of J2350 Chassis  
Figure 3: Rear of J2320 Chassis  
Figure 4: Rear of J2350 AC-Powered Chassis  
J2320 and J2350 Services Router Hardware Features  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
15  
     
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
Figure 5: Rear of J2350 DC-Powered Chassis  
Figure 6: J2320 Hardware Components  
16  
J2320 and J2350 Services Router Hardware Features  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 2: System Overview  
Figure 7: J2350 Hardware Components  
Table 6 on page 17 summarizes the physical specifications for the router chassis.  
Table 6: J2320 and J2350 Physical Specifications  
Description  
Value  
Chassis dimensions  
J2320 Services Router  
1.75 in. (4.45 cm) high  
17.51 in. (44.48 cm) wide18.9 in. (48.01 cm) wide with mounting brackets attached  
15.1 in. (38.35 cm) deepplus 0.78 in. (1.98 cm) of hardware that protrudes from the  
chassis front  
J2350 Services Router  
2.61 in. (6.63 cm) high  
17.51 in. (44.48 cm) wide18.9 in. (48.01 cm) wide with mounting brackets attached  
15.1 in. (38.35 cm) deepplus 0.78 in. (1.98 cm) of hardware that protrudes from the  
chassis front  
Router weight  
J2320 Services Router  
Minimum (no PIMs): 14.8 lbs (6.7 kg)  
Maximum (three PIMs): 15.9 lbs (7.2 kg)  
J2350 Services Router  
Minimum (no PIMs): 16.3 lbs (7.4 kg)  
Maximum (five PIMs): 18.2 lbs (8.3 kg)  
J2320 and J2350 Services Router Hardware Features  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
17  
       
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
J2320 and J2350 Midplane  
The J2320 and J2350 midplane is located in the center of the chassis and forms the  
rear of the PIM card cage (see Figure 6 on page 16 and Figure 7 on page 17). You  
install the PIMs into the midplane from the front of the chassis. Data packets are  
transferred across the midplane from the PIM to the Routing Engine, and from the  
Routing Engine across the midplane to the destination PIM.  
A time-division multiplexing (TDM) bus in J2320 and J2350 routers provides support  
for the Avaya VoIP module TGM550. The TGM550 converts the voice path from the  
TDM bus to compressed or uncompressed and packetized VoIP on an Ethernet  
J2320 and J2350 Routing Engine Hardware  
The Routing Engine consists of the following components. For more information,  
ProcessorCreates the packet forwarding switch fabric for the router and runs  
JUNOS software to maintain the router's routing tables and routing protocols.  
DRAMBuffers incoming packets and provides storage for the routing and  
forwarding tables and for other Routing Engine processes.  
To view the amount of DRAM installed on your router, issue the show chassis  
routing-engine command.  
EPROMStores the serial number of the Routing Engine.  
To view the serial number of the Routing Engine, issue either the show chassis  
routing-engine command or the show chassis hardware command.  
Crypto Accelerator ModuleProcessor card that enhances performance of  
cryptographic algorithms used in IP security (IPSec) services. The cryptographic  
algorithms supported include Advanced Encryption Standard (AES), Data  
Encryption Standard (DES), triple DES (3DES), Hashed Message Authentication  
Code-Message Digest 5 (HMAC-MD5), and HMAC-Secure Hash Algorithm 1  
(SHA-1). The Crypto Module is an optional feature of J2320 and J2350 Services  
Routers.  
To determine whether there is a Crypto Accelerator Module installed on your  
router, issue the show chassis hardware command.  
Compact flashProvides primary storage for software images, configuration  
files, and microcode. J-series routers have a primary or internal compact flash  
located on the system board. For information about replacing the internal  
J2320 and J2350 Services Routers also provide a slot in the rear of the chassis  
into which you can insert an additional external compact flash. For information  
about external compact flashes, see J2320 and J2350 External Compact  
18  
J2320 and J2350 Services Router Hardware Features  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
               
Chapter 2: System Overview  
J2320 and J2350 Boot Devices  
J2320 and J2350 Services Routers can boot from three devices:  
Internal compact flash  
External compact flash (also known as the removable compact flash)  
USB storage device  
Normally, a J2320 or J2350 Services Router boots from the internal compact flash.  
If the internal compact flash fails, the router attempts to boot from the external  
compact flash if it is installed. If the external compact flash is not present or fails,  
the router attempts to boot from the USB storage device.  
J2320 and J2350 Front Panel  
The front panel of a J2320 or J2350 Services Router (see Figure 8 on page 19 and  
Figure 9 on page 19) allows you to install or remove PIMs, view router status LEDs,  
access the console port, and perform simple control functions.  
Figure 8: Front of J2320 Chassis  
Figure 9: Front of J2350 Chassis  
The components of the front panel, are described in the following sections:  
J2320 and J2350 Services Router Hardware Features  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
19  
         
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
Physical Interface Modules (PIMs)  
Physical Interface Modules (PIMs) provide the physical connection to various network  
media types. For information about individual PIMs, see Field-Replaceable  
Pinoutson page 223. For PIM replacement instructions, see Replacing a  
The J2320 front panel has three slots and the J2350 front panel has five slots for  
field-replaceable PIMs. These slots are numbered from top to bottom and from left  
to right as shown in Figure 10 on page 20.  
Slot 0 is a fixed interface module that contains four built-in Gigabit Ethernet ports.  
Figure 10: Slot Number Diagram on J2320 and J2350  
Power Button and POWER LED  
The power button is located on the left side of the front panel (see  
Figure 1 on page 14). You can use the power button to power the Services Router  
on and off. When you power on the router, the Routing Engine boots as the power  
supply completes its startup sequence.  
The POWER LED is located to the upper left of the LED dashboard. Table 7 on page  
21 describes the POWER LED.  
20  
J2320 and J2350 Services Router Hardware Features  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Chapter 2: System Overview  
Table 7: J2320 and J2350 POWER LED  
Color  
State  
Description  
Green  
On steadily  
Power is functioning correctly.  
Blinking  
Off  
Power button has been pressed and quickly released, and  
the router is gracefully shutting down.  
Unlit  
Router is not receiving power.  
After the router is powered on, status indicatorssuch as LEDs on the front panel  
and show chassis command outputcan take up to 60 seconds to indicate that the  
power supply is functioning normally. Ignore error indicators that appear during the  
first 60 seconds.  
If you need to power off the router after the Routing Engine finishes booting, use the  
J-Web interface or the CLI to halt the Services Router first. For instructions, see the  
J-series Services Router Administration Guide. Alternatively, you can press and release  
the power button to gracefully shut down the router. For more information, see  
STATUS LED  
When the system is powered on, the STATUS LED changes from off to blinking green.  
Startup takes approximately 90 seconds to complete. If you want to turn the system  
off and on again, we recommend waiting a few seconds between shutting it down  
and powering it back up. Table 8 on page 21 describes the STATUS LED.  
Table 8: J2320 and J2350 STATUS LED  
Color  
State  
Description  
Green  
Blinking  
Router is starting up or performing diagnostics.  
On steadily  
Blinking  
Router is operating normally.  
Error has been detected.  
Red  
ALARM LED  
The ALARM LED lights amber to indicate a minor condition that requires monitoring  
or maintenance and lights red to indicate a major condition that can result in a system  
shutdown. When the condition is corrected, the light turns off. Table 9 on page 22  
describes the ALARM LED.  
J2320 and J2350 Services Router Hardware Features  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
21  
           
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
Table 9: J2320 and J2350 ALARM LED  
Color  
State  
Description  
Red  
On steadily  
Major alarm indicates a critical situation on the router that  
has resulted from one of the following conditions. A red  
alarm condition requires immediate action:  
One or more hardware components have failed.  
One or more hardware components have exceeded  
temperature thresholds.  
An alarm condition configured on an interface has  
triggered a critical warning.  
Yellow  
On steadily  
Minor alarm condition requires monitoring or maintenance:  
Indicates a noncritical condition on the router that, if  
left unchecked, might cause an interruption in service  
or degradation in performance.  
A missing rescue configuration or software license  
generates an amber system alarm.  
Unlit  
Off  
No alarms.  
For information about alarm conditions and corrective actions, see Chassis Alarm  
Conditionson page 209. For additional information, see the J-series Services Router  
Administration Guide.  
HA LED  
The HA (high availability) LED is for future use. The LED lights when the router starts,  
but otherwise remains unlit.  
RESET CONFIG Button  
Use the RESET CONFIG button to return the router to either the rescue configuration  
or the factory default configuration. The button is recessed to prevent it from being  
pressed accidentally. To press this button insert a small probe (such as a straightened  
paper clip) into the pinhole on the front panel (see Figure 8 on page 19 and  
For example, if someone inadvertently commits a configuration that denies  
management access to a Services Router, you can delete the invalid configuration  
and replace it with a rescue configuration by pressing the RESET CONFIG button. You  
must have previously set the rescue configuration through the J-Web interface or the  
CLI. The rescue configuration is a previously committed, valid configuration.  
CAUTION: Pressing and holding the RESET CONFIG button for 15 seconds or  
moreuntil the STATUS LED blinks reddeletes all configurations on the router,  
including the backup configurations and rescue configuration, and loads and commits  
the factory configuration.  
22  
J2320 and J2350 Services Router Hardware Features  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Chapter 2: System Overview  
You can change the default behavior of the RESET CONFIG button. For more  
information, see the J-series Services Router Basic LAN and WAN Access Configuration  
Guide.  
Built-In Gigabit Ethernet Ports  
Four built-in Gigabit Ethernet ports provide LAN connections over copper interfaces  
to hubs, switches, local servers, and workstations. You can also designate an Ethernet  
port for management traffic. When configuring one of these ports, you use the  
interface name that corresponds to the ports location. From left to right on the front  
panel, the interface names for the ports are ge-0/0/0, ge-0/0/1, ge-0/0/2, and  
ge-0/0/3.  
For Gigabit Ethernet port pinout information, see Gigabit Ethernet uPIM RJ-45  
Each port has two LEDs, a TX/RX LED on the left side and a LINK LED on the right  
side. Table 10 on page 23 describes the built-in Ethernet port LEDs.  
Table 10: Gigabit Ethernet Port LEDs  
Function  
Color  
State  
Description  
Green  
On steadily  
Port is online.  
LINK  
Unlit  
Green  
Unlit  
Off  
Port is offline.  
Blinking  
Off  
Port is transmitting or receiving data.  
Port might be online, but it is not receiving data.  
TX/RX  
Console Port  
You can use the console port on the chassis front panel to connect to the Routing  
Engine through an RJ-45 serial cable. From the chassis console port, you can use the  
CLI to configure the router. The console port is configured as data terminal equipment  
(DTE) and supports the RS-232 (EIA-232) standard.  
For information about securing the chassis console port, see the J-series Services  
Router Administration Guide.  
For pinout information, see Chassis Console Port Pinoutson page 234.  
AUX Port  
The port labeled AUX on the front panel of the J-series Services Router is for future  
use and is not activated.  
J2320 and J2350 Services Router Hardware Features  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
23  
             
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
USB Port  
The USB ports on the front panel of the router (see Figure 8 on page 19 and  
Figure 9 on page 19) accept a USB storage device or USB storage device adapter with  
a compact flash installed, as defined in the CompactFlash Specification published by  
the CompactFlash Association. When a USB storage device is installed and configured,  
it automatically acts as a secondary boot device if the internal compact flash fails on  
startup. Depending on the size of the USB storage device, you can also configure it  
to receive any core files generated during a failure. For information about configuring  
a USB storage device, see the J-series Services Router Administration Guide.  
NOTE: For a list of supported USB storage devices, see the J-series Services Router  
Release Notes at http://www.juniper.net.  
J2320 and J2350 External Compact Flashes  
On J2320 and J2350 routers, an external compact flash, also known as removable  
compact flash, accepts a type I or II compact flash, as defined in the CompactFlash  
Specification published by the CompactFlash Association. The J2320 and J2350 chassis  
has a slot on the rear for external compact flashes (see Figure 3 on page 15). When  
the external compact flash is installed and configured, it automatically acts as the  
secondary boot device if the internal compact flash fails on startup.  
Depending on the capacity of the external compact flash, you can also configure it  
to receive any core files generated during a failure. For information about configuring  
an external compact flash, see the J-series Services Router Administration Guide.  
J2320 Power System  
power supply distributes the different output voltages to the router components  
according to their voltage requirements. The power supply is fixed in the chassis,  
and is not field-replaceable.  
The AC power supply has a single AC appliance inlet that requires a dedicated AC  
power feed.  
The J2320 AC-powered chassis has a power switch and does not include a power  
LED.  
and Specificationson page 107. For information about connecting the router to power  
J2350 Power System  
The J2350 Services Router uses either AC or DC power. The autosensing power supply  
(see Figure 4 on page 15 or Figure 5 on page 16) distributes the different output  
voltages to the router components according to their voltage requirements. The  
power supply is fixed in the chassis, and is not field-replaceable.  
24  
J2320 and J2350 Services Router Hardware Features  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
               
Chapter 2: System Overview  
The AC power supply has a single AC appliance inlet that requires a dedicated AC  
power feed. The DC power supply has a terminal block that provides a single DC  
input (48 VDC and return) and requires a dedicated 15 A (48 VDC) circuit breaker.  
The J2350 AC-powered or DC-powered chassis has a power switch and does not  
include a power LED.  
and Specificationson page 107. For information about connecting the router to power  
NOTE: You cannot mix DC and AC power supplies in the same chassis.  
WARNING: DC-powered Services Routers are intended for installation only in a  
restricted access location.  
J2320 and J2350 Cooling System  
The cooling system in J2320 and J2350 routers is from side to side. The J2320 router  
has five cooling fans and the J2350 router has four cooling fans. The fans draw air  
through vents along the left side of the chassis and exhaust it through vents on the  
right side of the chassis. The airflow produced by these fans keeps router components  
within the acceptable temperature range (see Figure 11 on page 26 and  
Figure 12 on page 26). The speed of the fans is adjusted automatically according to  
the current temperature.  
On J2350 routers that comply with Network Equipment Building System (NEBS)  
criteria, an air filter protects the air intake opening at the front of the chassis and  
must be replaced periodically. To verify that the system is a NEBS-compliant system,  
run the show chassis hardware command. A NEBS-compliant system displays the  
The Routing Engine monitors the temperature of the router components. If the  
maximum temperature specification, as measured at the CPU junction, is exceeded  
and the router cannot be adequately cooled, the Routing Engine shuts down the  
hardware components.  
J2320 and J2350 routers shut down when the CPU temperature reaches 80°C (176°F).  
There is no alarm for temperature. You can view the CPU junction temperature using  
the show chassis routing-engine command. The CPU temperature runs a few degrees  
higher than the routing engine temperature displayed on the Monitor>Chassis page  
of the J-Web interface.  
An additional fan is part of each power supply. This fan is not regulated by the  
operating system.  
J2320 and J2350 Services Router Hardware Features  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
25  
         
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
Figure 11: Airflow Through the J2320 Chassis  
Figure 12: Airflow Through the J2350 Chassis  
J4350 and J6350 Services Router Hardware Features  
This section contains the following topics:  
26  
J4350 and J6350 Services Router Hardware Features  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 2: System Overview  
J4350 and J6350 Chassis  
The J4350 and J6350 chassis is a rigid sheet metal structure that houses all the other  
router components (see Figure 13 on page 28 through Figure 18 on page 30). The  
chassis can be installed in many types of racks or cabinets. For information about  
acceptable rack types, see Rack Requirementson page 104.  
In addition to the features described in subsequent sections, the chassis includes the  
following features:  
Mounting bracketsOne pair of metal brackets can be mounted at the front or  
center of the chassis. Use the brackets for mounting the chassis in a rack or  
cabinet.  
Earthing terminalsTwo protective earthing terminals, PEM nuts at the rear of  
the chassis ensure safe dissipation of static electricity in all situations.  
ESD pointOne electrostatic discharge (ESD) point, a banana plug receptacle at  
the front of the chassis, minimizes the risk of electrical discharge in potentially  
hazardous environments.  
CAUTION: Before removing or installing components of a functioning router, attach  
an ESD strap to an ESD point and place the other end of the strap around your bare  
wrist. Failure to use an ESD strap could result in damage to the router.  
The router must be connected to earth ground during normal operation. The protective  
earthing terminals on the rear of the chassis are provided to connect the router to  
ground (see Figure 14 on page 28). Additional grounding is provided to an AC-powered  
router when you plug its power supply into a grounded AC power receptacle.  
For additional safety information, see Safety and Regulatory Compliance  
J4350 and J6350 Services Router Hardware Features  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
27  
     
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
Figure 13: Front of J4350 and J6350 Chassis  
Figure 14: Rear of J4350 AC-Powered Chassis  
NOTE: The J4350 AC-powered chassis has a power switch and does not include a  
power supply LED (unlike the J6350 AC-powered chassis).  
Figure 15: Rear of J6350 AC-Powered Chassis  
28  
J4350 and J6350 Services Router Hardware Features  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 2: System Overview  
Figure 16: Rear of J4350 DC-Powered Chassis  
Figure 17: Rear of DC-Powered J6350 Chassis  
J4350 and J6350 Services Router Hardware Features  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
29  
   
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
Figure 18: J4350 and J6350 Hardware Components  
Table 11 on page 30 summarizes the physical specifications for the router chassis.  
Table 11: J4350 and J6350 Physical Specifications  
Description  
Value  
Chassis dimensions  
3.44 in. (8.74 cm) high  
17.44 in. (44.3 cm) wide19.44 in. (48.38 cm) wide with mounting brackets attached  
21.13 in. (53.67 cm) deepplus 0.5 in. (1.27 cm) of hardware that protrudes from the chassis  
front  
Router weight  
J4350 Services Router:  
Minimum (no PIMs): 23 lb (10.4 kg)  
Maximum (six PIMs): 25.3 lb (11.5 kg)  
J6350 Services Router  
Minimum (no PIMs and one power supply): 25.5 lb (11.6 kg)  
Maximum (six PIMs and two power supplies): 30.7 lb (13.9 kg)  
30  
J4350 and J6350 Services Router Hardware Features  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 2: System Overview  
J4350 and J6350 Midplane  
The midplane is located in the center of the chassis and forms the rear of the PIM  
card cage (see Figure 18 on page 30). You install the PIMs into the midplane from  
the front of the chassis. Data packets are transferred across the midplane from the  
PIM to the Routing Engine, and from the Routing Engine across the midplane to the  
destination PIM.  
J4350 and J6350 Routing Engine Hardware  
The Routing Engine consists of the following components. For more information,  
ProcessorCreates the packet forwarding switch fabric for the router and runs  
JUNOS software to maintain the router's routing tables and routing protocols.  
DRAMBuffers incoming packets and provides storage for the routing and  
forwarding tables and for other Routing Engine processes.  
To view the amount of DRAM installed on your router, issue the show chassis  
routing-engine command.  
EPROMStores the serial number of the Routing Engine.  
To view the serial number of the Routing Engine, issue either the show chassis  
routing-engine command or the show chassis hardware command.  
Crypto Accelerator ModuleProcessor card that enhances performance of  
cryptographic algorithms used in IP security (IPSec) services. The cryptographic  
algorithms supported include Advanced Encryption Standard (AES), Data  
Encryption Standard (DES), triple DES (3DES), Hashed Message Authentication  
Code-Message Digest 5 (HMAC-MD5), and HMAC-Secure Hash Algorithm 1  
(SHA-1).  
To determine whether there is a Crypto Accelerator Module installed on your  
router, issue the show chassis hardware command.  
Compact flashProvides primary storage for software images, configuration  
files, and microcode. J4350 and J6350 routers have a slot on the motherboard  
for an internal compact flash. For information about replacing the compact flash,  
J4350 and J6350 Boot Devices  
The J4350 and J6350 Services Routers can boot from two devices:  
Internal compact flash  
USB storage device  
Normally, the J4350 or J6350 Services Router boots from the internal compact flash.  
If the compact flash fails, the router attempts to boot from the USB storage device.  
J4350 and J6350 Services Router Hardware Features  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
31  
                   
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
J4350 and J6350 Front Panel  
or remove PIMs, view router status LEDs, access the console port, and perform simple  
control functions.  
Figure 19: Front of J4350 and J6350 Chassis  
The components of the front panel, from left to right, are described in the following  
sections:  
Physical Interface Modules (PIMs)  
Physical Interface Modules (PIMs) provide the physical connection to various network  
media types. For information about individual PIMs, see Field-Replaceable  
Pinoutson page 223. For PIM replacement instructions, see Replacing a  
Each J4350 and J6350 Services Router has six front panel slots for field-replaceable  
PIMs. These slots are numbered from top to bottom and from left to right as shown  
in the slot number diagram on the front panel, shown in Figure 20 on page 33.  
32  
J4350 and J6350 Services Router Hardware Features  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 2: System Overview  
Figure 20: Slot Number Diagram on Front Panel  
Gigabit Ethernet and 4-port Fast Ethernet ePIMs can be installed in high-speed slots  
only. High-speed slots are indicated by a black triangle containing an E in the front  
panel slot number diagram. On J4350 Services Routers, the high-speed slots are  
slot 3 and slot 6. On J6350 Services Routers, the high-speed slots are slots 2, 3, 5,  
and 6.  
Slot 0 is the fixed interface module that contains the built-in Ethernet ports.  
Power Button and POWER LED  
The power button is located on the left side of the front panel (see  
Figure 19 on page 32). You can use the power button to power the Services Router  
on and off. When you power on the router, the Routing Engine boots as the power  
supply completes its startup sequence.  
33 describes the POWER LED.  
Table 12: POWER LED  
Color  
State  
Description  
Green  
On steadily  
Power is functioning correctly.  
Blinking  
Off  
Power button has been pressed and quickly released, and  
the router is gracefully shutting down.  
Unlit  
Router is not receiving power.  
After the router is powered on, status indicatorssuch as LEDs on the front panel  
and show chassis command outputcan take up to 60 seconds to indicate that the  
power supply is functioning normally. Ignore error indicators that appear during the  
first 60 seconds.  
If you need to power off the router after the Routing Engine finishes booting, use the  
J-Web interface or the CLI to halt the Services Router first. For instructions, see the  
J-series Services Router Administration Guide. Alternatively, you can press and release  
the power button to gracefully shut down the router. For more information, see  
STATUS LED  
When the system is powered on, the STATUS LED changes from off to blinking green.  
Startup takes approximately 90 seconds to complete. If you want to turn the system  
J4350 and J6350 Services Router Hardware Features  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
33  
             
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
off and on again, we recommend waiting a few seconds between shutting it down  
and powering it back up. Table 13 on page 34 describes the STATUS LED.  
Table 13: STATUS LED  
Color  
State  
Description  
Green  
Blinking  
Router is starting up or performing diagnostics.  
On steadily  
Blinking  
Router is operating normally.  
Error has been detected.  
Red  
ALARM LED  
The ALARM LED lights yellow to indicate a minor condition that requires monitoring  
or maintenance and lights red to indicate a major condition that can result in a system  
describes the ALARM LED.  
Table 14: ALARM LED  
Color  
State  
Description  
Red  
On steadily  
Major alarm indicates a critical situation on the router that  
has resulted from one of the following conditions. A red  
alarm condition requires immediate action:  
One or more hardware components have failed.  
One or more hardware components have exceeded  
temperature thresholds.  
An alarm condition configured on an interface has  
triggered a critical warning.  
Yellow  
On steadily  
Minor alarm condition requires monitoring or maintenance:  
Indicates a noncritical condition on the router that, if  
left unchecked, might cause an interruption in service  
or degradation in performance.  
A missing rescue configuration or software license  
generates a yellow system alarm.  
Unlit  
Off  
No alarms.  
For information about alarm conditions and corrective actions, see Chassis Alarm  
Conditionson page 209. For additional information, see the J-series Services Router  
Administration Guide.  
HA LED  
The HA (high availability) LED is for future use. The LED lights when the router starts,  
but otherwise remains unlit.  
34  
J4350 and J6350 Services Router Hardware Features  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Chapter 2: System Overview  
RESET CONFIG Button  
Use the RESET CONFIG button to return the router to either the rescue configuration  
or the factory default configuration. The button is recessed to prevent it from being  
pressed accidentally. To press this button insert a small probe (such as a straightened  
paper clip) into the pinhole on the front panel (see Figure 19 on page 32).  
For example, if someone inadvertently commits a configuration that denies  
management access to a Services Router, you can delete the invalid configuration  
and replace it with a rescue configuration by pressing the RESET CONFIG button. You  
must have previously set the rescue configuration through the J-Web interface or the  
CLI. The rescue configuration is a previously committed, valid configuration.  
CAUTION: Pressing and holding the RESET CONFIG button for 15 seconds or  
moreuntil the STATUS LED blinks reddeletes all configurations on the router,  
including the backup configurations and rescue configuration, and loads and commits  
the factory configuration.  
You can change the default behavior of the RESET CONFIG button. For more  
information, see the J-series Services Router Basic LAN and WAN Access Configuration  
Guide.  
Built-In Gigabit Ethernet Ports  
Four built-in Gigabit Ethernet ports provide LAN connections over copper interfaces  
to hubs, switches, local servers, and workstations. You can also designate an Ethernet  
port for management traffic. When configuring one of these ports, you use the  
interface name that corresponds to the ports location. From left to right on the front  
panel, the interface names for the ports are ge-0/0/0, ge-0/0/1, ge-0/0/2, and  
ge-0/0/3.  
For Gigabit Ethernet port pinout information, see Gigabit Ethernet ePIM RJ-45  
Each port has two LEDs, a TX/RX LED on the left side and a LINK LED on the right  
side. Table 15 on page 35 describes the built-in Ethernet port LEDs.  
Table 15: Gigabit Ethernet Port LEDs  
Function  
Color  
State  
Description  
Green  
On steadily  
Port is online.  
LINK  
Unlit  
Green  
Unlit  
Off  
Port is offline.  
Blinking  
Off  
Port is transmitting or receiving data.  
Port might be online, but it is not receiving data.  
TX/RX  
J4350 and J6350 Services Router Hardware Features  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
35  
         
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
Console Port  
You can use the console port on the chassis front panel to connect to the Routing  
Engine through an RJ-45 serial cable. From the chassis console port, you can use the  
CLI to configure the router. The console port is configured as data terminal equipment  
(DTE) and supports the RS-232 (EIA-232) standard.  
For information about securing the chassis console port, see the J-series Services  
Router Administration Guide.  
For pinout information, see Chassis Console Port Pinoutson page 234.  
AUX Port  
The port labeled AUX on the front panel of the J4350 or J6350 Services Router is for  
future use and is not activated.  
USB Port  
The USB ports on the front panel of the router (see Figure 19 on page 32) accept a  
USB storage device or USB storage device adapter with a compact flash installed, as  
defined in the CompactFlash Specification published by the CompactFlash Association.  
When a USB storage device is installed and configured, it automatically acts as a  
secondary boot device if the internal compact flash fails on startup. Depending on  
the size of the USB storage device, you can also configure it to receive any core files  
generated during a failure. For information about configuring a USB storage device,  
see the J-series Services Router Administration Guide.  
NOTE: For a list of supported USB storage devices, see the J-series Services Router  
Release Notes at http://www.juniper.net.  
J4350 Power System  
The J4350 Services Router uses either AC or DC power. The autosensing power supply  
(see Figure 14 on page 28 or Figure 16 on page 29) distributes the different output  
voltages to the router components according to their voltage requirements. The  
power supply is fixed in the chassis and is not field-replaceable.  
The AC power supply has a single AC appliance inlet that requires a dedicated AC  
power feed. The DC power supply has a terminal block that provides a single DC  
input (48 VDC and return) and requires a dedicated 15 A (48 VDC) circuit breaker.  
The J4350 AC-powered chassis has a power switch and does not include a power  
LED.  
The J4350 DC-powered chassis includes a power supply LED located to the upper  
LED.  
36  
J4350 and J6350 Services Router Hardware Features  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                 
Chapter 2: System Overview  
Table 16: Power Supply LED  
State  
Off  
Description  
No power is flowing to the power supply.  
Green  
Yellow  
Power supply is connected and power is flowing.  
Power supply is connected, but the router is not powered on.  
and Specificationson page 107. For information about connecting the router to power  
NOTE: You cannot mix DC and AC power supplies in the same chassis.  
WARNING: DC-powered Services Routers are intended for installation only in a  
restricted access location.  
J6350 Power System  
The J6350 Services Router uses either AC or DC power. You can install one or two  
autosensing, load-sharing power supplies on the system board at the bottom of the  
chassis, as shown in Figure 15 on page 28 or Figure 17 on page 29. The power  
supplies distribute the different output voltages to the router components, depending  
on their voltage requirements. When two power supplies are installed and operational,  
they automatically share the electrical load.  
For full redundancy, two power supplies are required. If a power supply stops  
functioning for any reason, the second power supply instantly begins providing all  
the power the router needs for normal functioning. It can provide full power  
indefinitely.  
Each power supply has an LED located to the upper right of the power supply  
connector. Table 16 on page 37 describes the power supply LED.  
and Specificationson page 107. For information about connecting the router to power  
Power supplies on J6350 Services Routers are hot-removable and hot-insertable. You  
can remove and replace a redundant power supply without powering down the router  
or disrupting the routing functions. To avoid electrical injury, carefully follow the  
NOTE: You cannot mix DC and AC power supplies in the same chassis.  
J4350 and J6350 Services Router Hardware Features  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
37  
         
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
WARNING: DC-powered Services Routers are intended for installation only in a  
restricted access location.  
J4350 and J6350 Cooling System  
The cooling system includes three fans at the rear of the chassis. The airflow produced  
by these fans keeps router components within the acceptable temperature range  
(see Figure 21 on page 39). The speed of the fans is adjusted automatically according  
to the current temperature.  
An air filter protects the air intake opening at the front of the chassis and must be  
The Routing Engine monitors the temperature of the router components. If the  
maximum temperature specification, as measured at the CPU junction, is exceeded  
and the router cannot be adequately cooled, the Routing Engine shuts down the  
hardware components.  
When the CPU temperature reaches 80°C (176°F), a yellow alarm is triggered. When  
the CPU temperature reaches 105°C (221°F), the system shuts down. There is no  
red alarm for temperature. You can view the CPU junction temperature using the  
show chassis routing-engine command. The CPU temperature runs a few degrees  
higher than the routing engine temperature displayed on the Monitor>Chassis page  
of the J-Web interface.  
NOTE: On J4350 and J6350 routers that are not designed to comply with Network  
Equipment Building System (NEBS) criteria, the temperature at which the system  
shuts down is 90°C (194°F) rather than 105°C (221°F). To verify that the system is  
a NEBS-compliant system, run the show chassis hardware command. A  
NEBS-compliant system displays the term NEBS in the output.  
An additional fan is part of each power supply. This fan is not regulated by the  
operating system.  
38  
J4350 and J6350 Services Router Hardware Features  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Chapter 2: System Overview  
Figure 21: Airflow Through the J4350 and J6350 Chassis  
Software Overview  
Each J-series Services Router runs the JUNOS software on its general-purpose  
processors. Designed for the large production networks typically supported by Internet  
service providers (ISPs), the JUNOS software includes processes for Internet Protocol  
(IP) routing and for managing interfaces, networks, and the router chassis.  
The JUNOS software runs on the Routing Engine. The Routing Engine kernel  
coordinates communication among the JUNOS software processes and provides a  
link to the Packet Forwarding Engine.  
With the J-Web interface and the command-line interface (CLI) you configure the  
routing protocols that run on the Services Router and set the properties of its network  
interfaces. After activating a software configuration, use either user interface to  
monitor the protocol traffic passing through the router, manage operations, and  
diagnose protocol and network connectivity problems.  
This section contains the following topics:  
Software Overview  
39  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
Routing Engine and Packet Forwarding Engine  
A Services Router has two primary software processing components:  
Routing EngineThe Routing Engine provides three main functions:  
Creates the packet forwarding switch fabric for the Services Router, providing  
route lookup, filtering, and switching on incoming data packets, then directing  
outbound packets to the appropriate interface for transmission to the  
network.  
Maintains the routing tables used by the router and controls the routing  
protocols that run on the router.  
Provides control and monitoring functions for the router, including controlling  
power and monitoring system status.  
Packet Forwarding EngineProcesses packets; applies filters, routing policies,  
and other features; and forwards packets to the next hop along the route to their  
final destination.  
For information about Routing Engine hardware, see J2320 and J2350 Routing  
Kernel and Microkernel  
The Routing Engine kernel provides the underlying infrastructure for all JUNOS  
software processes by doing the following:  
Linking the routing tables maintained by the routing protocol process with the  
forwarding table maintained by the Routing Engine  
Coordinating communication with the Packet Forwarding Engine, primarily by  
synchronizing the Packet Forwarding Engines forwarding table with the master  
forwarding table maintained by the Routing Engine  
The microkernel contains device drivers and processes that the Packet Forwarding  
Engine uses to govern the flow of packets through the Services Router.  
JUNOS Software Processes  
The JUNOS software running on the Routing Engine and Packet Forwarding Engine  
consists of multiple processes that are responsible for individual Services Router  
functions.  
The separation of functions provides operational stability, because each process  
accesses its own protected memory space. In addition, because each process is a  
separate software package, you can selectively upgrade all or part of the JUNOS  
software, for added flexibility.  
Table 17 on page 41 describes the primary JUNOS software processes.  
40  
Software Overview  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Chapter 2: System Overview  
Table 17: JUNOS Software Processes  
Process  
Name  
Description  
Management  
process  
mgd  
Manages the Services Router system as follows:  
Provides communication between the other processes and an interface to the  
configuration database  
Populates the configuration database with configuration information and retrieves  
the information when queried by other processes to ensure that the system  
operates as configured  
Interacts with the other processes when commands are issued through one of  
the user interfaces on the router  
Chassis  
process  
chassisd  
Controls a Services Router chassis and its components as follows:  
Detects hardware on the system that is used to configure network interfaces  
Monitors the physical status of hardware components and field-replaceable units  
(FRUs), detecting when environment sensors such as temperature sensors are  
triggered  
Relays signals and interruptsfor example, when devices are taken offline, so  
that the system can close sessions and shut down gracefully  
Routing  
protocol  
process  
rpd  
dcd  
Defines how routing protocols such as RIP, OSPF, and BGP operate on the router,  
including selecting routes and maintaining fowarding tables.  
Interface  
Supplies the programs that configure and monitor network interfaces by defining  
physical characteristics such as link encapsulation, hold times, and keepalive timers.  
process (also  
called device  
control  
process)  
Forwarding  
process  
fwdd  
Responsible for most of the packet transmission through a Services Router. The overall  
performance of the router is largely determined by the effectiveness of the forwarding  
process.  
User Interfaces  
The user interfaces on a Services Router interact with the management process to  
execute commands and store and retrieve information from the configuration  
database. The user interfaces operate as clients that communicate with the JUNOS  
software through an application programming interface (API).  
The following primary user interfaces are shipped with the router:  
J-Web graphical user interfaceIncludes quick configuration capabilities for  
performing the minimum required steps to enable a feature, plus a built-in  
configuration editor with access to the entire configuration hierarchy to fully  
configure the router. The J-Web interface also provides tools for monitoring,  
managing, and diagnosing router operation.  
Command-line interface (CLI)Grants access to the complete JUNOS command  
and configuration hierarchies, to monitor the router, diagnose problems, and  
configure it completely.  
Software Overview  
41  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
Other user interfaces for the Services Router interact with the management process  
through the common API interface. These interfaces are designed to facilitate the  
configuration of one or, in some cases, many routers on the network. Among the  
supported interfaces are the JUNOScope and Session and Resource Control (SRC)  
applications. For more information about these products, see the JUNOScope Software  
User Guide and the SRC-PE Getting Started Guide.  
42  
Software Overview  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 3  
PIM and VoIP Module Overview  
J-series Services Routers accept Physical Interface Modules (PIMs) and Avaya VoIP  
modules in the slots on the front of the chassis.  
CAUTION: PIMs and VoIP modules are not hot-swappable. You must power off the  
Services Router before removing or inserting a PIM or VoIP module. Ensure that the  
PIMs and VoIP modules are installed in the router chassis before booting up the  
system.  
A Physical Interface Module (PIM) is a network interface card that is installed on a  
J-series Services Router, to provide physical connections to a LAN or a WAN. The  
PIM receives incoming packets from the network and transmits outgoing packets to  
the network. Each PIM is equipped with a dedicated network processor that forwards  
incoming data packets to the Routing Engine, and receives outgoing data packets  
from the Routing Engine. During this process, the PIM performs framing and  
line-speed signaling for its medium type.  
For a complete list of supported PIMs, see Field-Replaceable PIMson page 46.  
Avaya VoIP modules are installed in the router chassis like PIMs, but are controlled  
by the Avaya Communication Manager (CM) software rather than the JUNOS software.  
For a complete list of supported modules, see Avaya VoIP Moduleson page 66.  
For J-series Services Router PIM compatibility matrix and datasheets, go to  
For information about network interfaces, and for configuration instructions, see the  
J-series Services Router Basic LAN and WAN Access Configuration Guide.  
This chapter contains the following topics:  
PIM and VoIP Module Terms  
To understand PIMs and VoIP modules, become familiar with the terms defined in  
PIM and VoIP Module Terms  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
43  
             
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
Table 18: PIM and VoIP Module Terms  
Term  
Definition  
ADSL 2/2+ Annex A  
ITU-T Standard G.992.1 that defines how ADSL works over plain old telephone service  
(POTS) lines.  
ADSL 2/2+ Annex B  
ITU-T Standard G.992.1 that defines how ADSL works over Integrated Services Digital  
Network (ISDN) lines.  
bandwidth on demand  
ISDN cost-control feature defining the bandwidth threshold that must be reached on  
all links before a Services Router initiates additional ISDN data connections to provide  
more bandwidth.  
Basic Rate Interface (BRI) ISDN interface intended for home and small enterprise applications. BRI consists of  
two 64-Kbps B-channels and one 16-Kbps D-channel.  
callback  
Alternative feature to dial-in that enables a J-series Services Router to call back the  
caller from the remote end of a backup ISDN connection. Instead of accepting a call  
from the remote end of the connection, the router rejects the call, waits a configured  
period of time, and calls a number configured on the router's dialer interface. See also  
dial-in.  
caller ID  
Telephone number of the caller on the remote end of a backup ISDN connection, used  
to dial in and also to identify the caller. Multiple caller IDs can be configured on an  
ISDN dialer interface. During dial-in, the router matches the incoming call's caller ID  
against the caller IDs configured on its dialer interfaces. Each dialer interface accepts  
calls from only callers whose caller IDs are configured on it.  
channel service unit (CSU) Unit that connects a digital telephone line to a multiplexer or other signal service.  
data service unit (DSU)  
Unit that connects a data terminal equipment (DTE) devicein this case, a Services  
Routerto a digital telephone line.  
data terminal  
Interface that a Services Router (the DTE) uses to exchange information with a serial  
device such as a modem (the DCE).  
equipmenttodata  
communication  
equipment (DTEDCE)  
interface  
A DTE cable uses a male 9-pin or 25-pin connector, and a DCE cable uses a female  
9-pin or 25-pin connector.  
demand circuit  
dial backup  
dial-in  
Interface configured for dial-on-demand routing backup. In OSPF, the demand circuit  
reduces the amount of OSPF traffic by removing all OSPF protocols when the routing  
domain is in a steady state.  
Feature that reestablishes network connectivity through one or more backup ISDN  
dialer interfaces after a primary interface fails. When the primary interface is  
reestablished, the ISDN interface is disconnected.  
Feature that enables J-series Services Routers to receive calls from the remote end of  
a backup ISDN connection. The remote end of the ISDN call might be a service provider,  
a corporate central location, or a customer premises equipment (CPE) branch office.  
All incoming calls can be verified against caller IDs configured on the router's dialer  
interface. See also callback.  
44  
PIM and VoIP Module Terms  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 3: PIM and VoIP Module Overview  
Table 18: PIM and VoIP Module Terms (continued)  
Term  
Definition  
dialer filter  
Stateless firewall filter that enables dial-on-demand routing backup when applied to  
a physical ISDN interface and its dialer interface configured as a passive static route.  
The passive static route has a lower priority than dynamic routes. If all dynamic routes  
to an address are lost from the routing table and the router receives a packet for that  
address, the dialer interface initiates an ISDN backup connection and sends the packet  
over it. See also dial-on-demand routing backup; floating static route.  
dial-on-demand-routing  
(DDR) backup  
Feature that provides a J-series Services Router with full-time connectivity across an  
ISDN line. When routes on a primary serial T1, E1, T3, E3, Fast Ethernet, or PPPoE  
interface are lost, an ISDN dialer interface establishes a backup connection. To save  
connection time costs, the Services Router drops the ISDN connection after a configured  
period of inactivity. Services Router with ISDN interfaces support two types of  
dial-on-demand routing backup: on-demand routing with a dialer filter and dialer  
watch. See also dialer filter; dialer watch.  
dialer watch  
Dial-on-demand routing (DDR) backup feature that provides reliable connectivity  
without relying on a dialer filter to activate the ISDN interface. The ISDN dialer interface  
monitors the existence of each route on a watch list. If all routes on the watch list are  
lost from the routing table, dialer watch initiates the ISDN interface for failover  
connectivity. See also dial-on-demand routing backup.  
dying gaspnotification  
ePIM  
Ability of a Services Router with a digital subscriber line (DSL) connection that has lost  
power to send a message informing the attached DSL access multiplexer (DSLAM)  
that it is about to go offline.  
Enhanced PIM. A particular type of high-speed PIM, such as the Gigabit Ethernet ePIM  
or 4-port Fast Ethernet ePIM, which can be inserted only in high-speed slots (slots 3  
and 6 on a J4350 Services Router, or slots 2, 3, 5, and 6 on a J6350 Services Router).  
floating static route  
Route with an administrative distance greater than the administrative distance of the  
dynamically learned versions of the same route. The static route is used only when  
the dynamic routes are no longer available. When a floating static route is configured  
on an interface with a dialer filter, the interface can be used for backup.  
ISDN S/T interface  
ISDN U interface  
Interface between an ISDN network and a network termination device consisting of  
two twisted pairs, one each for transmitting and receiving. The S/T interface usually  
resides in the customer premises and operates at 192 Kbps, of which ISDN traffic  
accounts for 144 Kbps.  
Single twistedpair interface line connecting the customer premises unit in an ISDN  
network to the central office. A U interface runs at 144 Kbps (128 Kbps for two B  
channels and 16 Kbps for the D channel).  
plain old telephone  
service (POTS)  
Standard telephone service that allows limited speed and bandwidth of 52 Kbps, which  
is also know as public switched telephone network (PSTN).  
Primary Rate Interface  
(PRI)  
ISDN service intended for higher-bandwidth applications than ISDN BRI. ISDN PRI  
consists of a single D-channel for control and signaling, plus a number of 64-Kbps  
B-channelseither 23 B-channels on a T1 line or 30 B-channels on an E1 lineto  
carry network traffic.  
uPIM  
Universal switching PIM. A particular type of PIM, such as the Gigabit Ethernet uPIM,  
which can be universally inserted in any slot on a J2320, J2350, J4350, or J6350  
Services Router.  
PIM and VoIP Module Terms  
45  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
Field-Replaceable PIMs  
PIMs are removable and insertable only when the Services Router is powered off.  
You can install a PIM into one of the slots in the router chassis. If a slot is not occupied  
by a PIM, a PIM blank panel must be installed to shield the empty slot and to allow  
cooling air to circulate properly through the router.  
This section contains the following topics:  
J2320 and J2350 Field-Replaceable PIM Summary  
Table 19 on page 47 provides software release information, port numbers, and  
sample interface names for the field-replaceable PIMs supported on J2320 and J2350  
Services Routers. The supported PIMs can be installed in any slot available on the  
J2320 and J2350 routers.  
CAUTION: Do not install a combination of PIMs in a single chassis that exceeds the  
maximum power and heat capacity of the chassis. If J-series power management is  
enabled, PIMs that exceed the maximum power and heat capacity remain offline  
when the chassis is powered on.  
To verify that the combination of PIMs to be installed in a chassis does not exceed  
NOTE: Although J2320 and J2350 Services Routers support PIMs that were introduced  
before the JUNOS 8.4 release, these routers do not support software releases earlier  
than JUNOS 8.4.  
46  
Field-Replaceable PIMs  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Chapter 3: PIM and VoIP Module Overview  
Table 19: J2320 and J2350 Field-Replaceable PIM Summary  
Sample Interface Name  
(type-pim/0/port)  
ge-2/0/0  
Supported Software Releases  
for This PIM  
PIM  
Port Numbering  
1-Port SFP, 6-Port SFP,  
8-Port, and 16-Port  
Gigabit Ethernet uPIMs  
JUNOS 8.4 and later  
Ports:  
0
0 through 5  
0 through 7  
0 through 15  
Dual-Port Serial PIM  
JUNOS 8.4 and later  
JUNOS 8.4 and later  
Ports0 and 1  
Ports0 and 1  
se-3/0/1  
t1-0/0/1  
or  
Dual-Port T1 or E1 PIM  
e1-0/0/1  
ct1-0/0/0  
ce1-0/0/0  
br-1/0/2  
at-2/0/0  
at-1/0/0  
Dual-Port Channelized  
T1/E1/ISDN PRI PIM  
JUNOS 8.4 and later  
Ports0 and 1  
4-Port ISDN BRI PIM  
ADSL PIM  
JUNOS 8.4 and later  
JUNOS 8.4 and later  
JUNOS 8.4 and later  
Ports0, 1, 2, and 3  
Port0  
G.SHDSL PIM  
Ports0 and 1  
J4350 and J6350 Field-Replaceable PIM Summary  
Table 20 on page 48 provides software release information, slot and port numbers,  
and sample interface names for the field-replaceable PIMs supported on J4350, and  
J6350 Services Routers.  
CAUTION: Do not install a combination of PIMs in a single chassis that exceeds the  
maximum power and heat capacity of the chassis. If J-series power management is  
enabled, PIMs that exceed the maximum power and heat capacity remain offline  
when the chassis is powered on.  
To verify that the combination of PIMs to be installed in a chassis does not exceed  
Field-Replaceable PIMs  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
47  
     
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
Table 20: J4350 and J6350 Field-Replaceable PIM and Module Summary  
Sample Interface Name  
(type-pim/0/port)  
ge-2/0/0  
Supported Software Releases  
for This PIM  
PIM  
Slot and Port Numbering  
Slots1 through 6  
Port0  
1-Port SFP Gigabit  
Ethernet uPIM  
JUNOS 8.4 and later  
6-Port SFP Gigabit  
Ethernet uPIM  
JUNOS 8.3 and later  
JUNOS 8.3 and later  
Slots1 through 6  
Ports0 through 5  
Slots1 through 6  
Ports0 through 7  
Slots1 through 6  
Ports0 through 15  
ge-2/0/5  
ge-2/0/7  
ge-2/0/15  
ge-3/0/0  
8-Port Gigabit Ethernet  
uPIM  
16-Port Gigabit Ethernet JUNOS 8.3 and later  
uPIM  
1-Port SFP Gigabit  
Ethernet ePIM  
JUNOS 8.0 and later  
Can be installed in any  
high-speed slot, as follows:  
J4350: Slots 3 and 6  
Port0  
J6350: Slots 2, 3, 5,  
and 6  
Port0  
Dual-Port Serial PIM  
JUNOS 8.0 and later  
JUNOS 8.0 and later  
Slots1 through 6  
Ports0 and 1  
se-3/0/1  
Dual-Port T1 or E1 PIM  
Slots1 through 6  
Ports0 and 1  
t1-0/0/1  
or  
e1-0/0/1  
ct1-0/0/0  
ce1-0/0/0  
Dual-Port Channelized  
T1/E1/ISDN PRI PIM  
Channelized T1/E1: JUNOS 8.1 Slots1 through 6  
and later  
Port0 and 1  
ISDN PRI: JUNOS 8.3 and later  
T3 or E3 PIM  
JUNOS 8.0 and later  
Slots1 through 6  
Port0  
t3-0/0/0  
or  
e3-2/0/0  
fe-1/0/0  
Dual-Port Fast Ethernet  
PIM  
JUNOS 8.0 and later  
Slots1 through 6  
Ports0 and 1  
48  
Field-Replaceable PIMs  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 3: PIM and VoIP Module Overview  
Table 20: J4350 and J6350 Field-Replaceable PIM and Module Summary (continued)  
Sample Interface Name  
(type-pim/0/port)  
fe-3/0/0  
Supported Software Releases  
for This PIM  
PIM  
Slot and Port Numbering  
4-port Fast Ethernet  
ePIM PIM  
JUNOS 8.0 and later  
Can be installed in any  
high-speed slot, as follows:  
J4350: Slots 3 and 6  
Ports0 through 3  
J6350: Slots 2, 3, 5,  
and 6  
Ports0 through 3  
4-Port ISDN BRI PIM  
ADSL PIM  
JUNOS 8.0 and later  
JUNOS 8.0 and later  
JUNOS 8.0 and later  
Slots1 through 6  
Ports0, 1, 2, and 3  
Slots1 through 6  
Port0  
br-1/0/2  
at-2/0/0  
at-1/0/0  
G.SHDSL PIM  
Slots1 through 6  
Ports0 and 1  
1-Port, 6-Port, 8-Port, and 16-Port Gigabit Ethernet uPIMs  
Gigabit Ethernet uPIMs are supported on J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services  
Routers. Gigabit Ethernet uPIMs are available in four versions.  
The 1-port and 6-port SFP Gigabit Ethernet uPIM, shown in Figure 22 on page 49  
and Figure 23 on page 50, have small form-factor pluggable (SFP) transceivers to  
allow you to use different connectors. The optical SFP transceivers supported by  
these uPIMs are described in Table 22 on page 52.  
Figure 22: 1-Port Gigabit Ethernet uPIM  
Field-Replaceable PIMs  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
49  
     
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
Figure 23: 6-Port Gigabit Ethernet uPIM  
The 8-port and 16-port Gigabit Ethernet uPIMs, shown in Figure 24 on page 50 and  
Figure 25 on page 50, have RJ-45 connectors.  
Figure 24: 8-Port Gigabit Ethernet uPIM  
Figure 25: 16-Port Gigabit Ethernet uPIM  
Features. Gigabit Ethernet uPIMs provide the following key features:  
The multiport uPIMs can be used as switches in the access layer (for connections  
to workstations and desktops). For more information, see theJ-series Services  
Router Basic LAN and WAN Access Configuration Guide.  
Link speed for 8-port and 16-port Gigabit Ethernet uPIMs is configurable to 10,  
100, or 1000 Mbps, and transmission mode is configurable to half or full duplex.  
The 1-port and 6-port SFP Gigabit Ethernet uPIMs cannot be manually  
configuredthey are set at 1000 Mbps and full duplex.  
Autonegotiation.  
1-port and 6-port Gigabit Ethernet uPIMs use SFP transceivers to allow different  
connectors to be used on uPIM ports. These SFP Gigabit Ethernet uPIMs support  
50  
Field-Replaceable PIMs  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 3: PIM and VoIP Module Overview  
1000Base-SX, 1000Base-LX, and 1000Base-T SFPs. They do not support  
1000Base-LH SFPs.  
1000Base-SX and 1000Base-LX SFP transceivers have the following characteristics:  
Duplex LC/PC connector (Rx and Tx).  
Optical interface supportSee the J-series Services Router Administration  
Guide.  
8-port and 16-port Gigabit Ethernet uPIMsand SFPs on the 1-port and 6-port  
uPIMssupport 1000Base-T RJ-45 connectors.  
Limitations. Gigabit Ethernet uPIMs have the following limitations:  
Gigabit Ethernet uPIMs do not support SNMP.  
Gigabit Ethernet uPIM interfaces can be configured up to a maximum MTU size  
of 9014 bytes.  
Installation. Gigabit Ethernet uPIMs can be inserted in any slot on J2320, J2350,  
J4350, or J6350 Services Routers.  
Throughput for a uPIM is higher when it is inserted in a high-speed slot. High-speed  
slots are slots 3 and 6 on the J4350 router, and slots 2, 3, 5, and 6 on the J6350  
router.  
16-port Gigabit Ethernet uPIMs are two slots high. Because the connector on the PIM  
is on the lower half, the PIM occupies the slot that it is plugged into and the slot above  
it. Thus you cannot install a 16-port uPIM in the top slots of a router. For example,  
on a J4350 router you cannot install a 16-port uPIM in slots 1 and 4. If you install  
the PIM in slot 2, it occupies both slots 2 and 1.  
To install or remove a PIM, see Replacing a PIMon page 172.  
Interface LEDs. For 8-port and 16-port Gigabit Ethernet uPIMs, the activity LED is  
located on the left side of each port, and the link LED is located on the right side of  
each port. For the 6-port Gigabit Ethernet uPIM, the LEDs are located to the right of  
each port, with the link LED above the activity LED. LEDs on the 1-port uPIM are  
clearly labeled.Table 21 on page 51 describes the meaning of the LEDs.  
Table 21: Gigabit Ethernet Port LEDs  
Function  
Color  
State  
Description  
Link  
Green  
On steadily  
Port is online.  
Unlit  
Green  
Unlit  
Off  
Port is offline.  
Activity  
(TX/RX)  
Blinking  
Off  
Port is transmitting or receiving traffic.  
Port might be online, but it is not  
receiving traffic.  
Field-Replaceable PIMs  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
51  
     
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
For alarms, see the configuring and monitoring alarms information in the J-series  
Services Router Administration Guide.  
Optical Interface Support. Table 22 on page 52 describes the optical interface  
support on the 1-port and 6-port Gigabit Ethernet uPIMs over single-mode fiber-optic  
(SMF) and multimode fiber-optic (MMF) cables.  
Table 22: Optical Interface Support for SFP Gigabit Ethernet uPIMs  
Parameter  
1000Base-SX Transceiver  
1000Base-LX Transceiver  
Model number  
JX-SFP-1GE-SX  
JX-SFP-1GE-LX  
Maximum distance  
500 m (1640 ft) on 50/125-µm  
MMF cable  
10 km (6.2 mi) on 9/125-µm SMF  
cable  
200 m (656 ft) on 62.5/125-µm 550 m (1894 ft) on MMF cable  
MMF cable  
Transmitter  
wavelength  
830 nm through 860 nm  
1270 nm through 1355 nm  
Average launch power 9.5 dBm through 4 dBm  
For SMF cable: 9.5 dBm through  
3 dBm  
For MMF cable: 11.5 dBm through  
3 dBm  
Receiver sensitivity  
21 dBm through 18 dBm  
25 dBm through 20.5 dBm  
Copper Interface Support. The 1-port and 6-port Gigabit Ethernet uPIMs also support  
1000Base-T SFPs (model number JX-SFP-1GE-T).  
1-Port Gigabit Ethernet ePIMs  
The 1-port Gigabit Ethernet ePIM is supported on J4350 and J6350 Services Routers  
and is available in two versions, one with copper connector (see  
Figure 26 on page 52), the other with small form-factor pluggable (SFP) transceivers  
Figure 26: Copper Gigabit Ethernet ePIM  
52  
Field-Replaceable PIMs  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Chapter 3: PIM and VoIP Module Overview  
Figure 27: SFP Gigabit Ethernet ePIM  
Features. The Gigabit Ethernet ePIM provides the following key features:  
Autonegotiation through medium-dependent interface (MDI) and MDI crossover  
(MDI-X) support.  
Link speeds for the Copper Gigabit Ethernet ePIM are configurable to 10, 100,  
or 1000 Mbps, and transmission mode is configurable to half or full duplex. The  
SFP Gigabit Ethernet ePIM cannot be manually configuredit is set at 1000 Mbps  
and full duplex.  
The SFP Gigabit Ethernet ePIM uses SFPs to allow different connectors to be  
used on the ePIM ports. The ePIM supports 1000Base-SX, 1000Base-LX, and  
1000Base-T copper SFPs. It does not support 1000Base-LH SFPs.  
1000Base-SX and 1000Base-LX SFP transceivers have the following characteristics:  
Duplex LC/PC connector (Rx and Tx).  
Optical interface supportSee Table 24 on page 54.  
Copper Gigabit Ethernet ePIM and 1000Base-T SFP transceivers have the following  
characteristics:  
Connector: Four-pair, category 5 unshielded twisted-pair cable through an  
RJ-45 connector  
Pinout: MDI crossover  
Maximum distance: 100 m (328 ft)  
For pinouts of cable connectors for Copper Gigabit Ethernet ePIMs, see Gigabit  
Limitations. The Gigabit Ethernet ePIM has the following limitations:  
Gigabit Ethernet ePIMs do not support SNMP.  
Configure Gigabit Ethernet ePIM interfaces up to a maximum MTU size of  
9018 bytes.  
Installation. You can install Gigabit Ethernet ePIMs in any high-speed slot as follows:  
J4350Install up to two Gigabit Ethernet ePIMs in slots 3 and 6.  
J6350Install up to four Gigabit Ethernet ePIMs in slots 2, 3, 5, and 6.  
Field-Replaceable PIMs  
53  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
NOTE: High-speed slots are labeled with an E on the front-panel slot number diagram.  
To install or remove a PIM, see Replacing a PIMon page 172.  
Interface LEDs. The LINK and TX/RX LEDs indicate link status and activity.  
Table 23 on page 54 describes the meaning of the LEDs.  
Table 23: Gigabit Ethernet Port LEDs  
Function  
Color  
State  
Description  
Green  
On steadily  
Port is online.  
LINK  
Unlit  
Green  
Unlit  
Off  
Port is offline.  
Blinking  
Off  
Port is transmitting or receiving traffic.  
TX/RX  
Port might be online, but it is not  
receiving traffic.  
For alarms, see the configuring and monitoring alarms information in the J-series  
Services Router Administration Guide.  
Optical Interface Support. Table 24 on page 54 describes the optical interface  
support on the SFP Gigabit Ethernet ePIM over single-mode fiber-optic (SMF) and  
multimode fiber-optic (MMF) cables.  
Table 24: Optical Interface Support for SFP Gigabit Ethernet ePIM  
Parameter  
1000Base-SX Transceiver  
500 m (1640 ft) on 50/125-µm 10 km (6.2 mi) on 9/125-µm SMF  
MMF cable cable  
1000Base-LX Transceiver  
Maximum distance  
200 m (656 ft) on 62.5/125-µm 550 m (1894 ft) on MMF cable  
MMF cable  
Transmitter wavelength 830 nm through 860 nm  
1270 nm through 1355 nm  
Average launch power  
9.5 dBm through 4 dBm  
For SMF cable: 9.5 dBm through  
3 dBm  
For MMF cable: 11.5 dBm through  
3 dBm  
Receiver saturation  
Receiver sensitivity  
3 dBm  
3 dBm  
18 dBm  
20.5 dBm  
54  
Field-Replaceable PIMs  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 3: PIM and VoIP Module Overview  
Dual-Port Serial PIM  
The Dual-Port Serial PIM (Figure 28 on page 55) provides a physical connection to  
serial network media types through two serial interface ports.  
Figure 28: Dual-Port Serial PIM  
The Dual-Port Serial PIM provides the following key features:  
Onboard network processor  
Autoselection of operation modes based on data terminal equipment (DTE) or  
data communication equipment (DCE) cables  
Local and remote loopback diagnostics  
Configurable clock rate for the transmit (Tx) clock and receive (Rx) clock  
For pinouts of cable connectors for serial PIMs, see Serial PIM Cable  
To install or remove a PIM, see Replacing a PIMon page 172.  
Status LEDs indicate port status. Table 25 on page 55 describes the meaning of the  
LED states.  
Table 25: Status LEDs for Serial Ports  
Color  
Green  
Red  
State  
Description  
On steadily  
On steadily  
Online with no alarms or failures.  
Active with a local alarm. The router has  
detected a failure.  
Unlit  
Off  
Offline.  
For alarms, see the configuring and monitoring alarms information in the J-series  
Services Router Administration Guide.  
Field-Replaceable PIMs  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
55  
       
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
Dual-Port T1 or E1 PIM  
The Dual-Port T1 PIM (Figure 29 on page 56) and Dual-Port E1 PIM  
(Figure 30 on page 56) provide a physical connection to T1 or E1 network media  
types. Each PIM has two physical T1 or E1 ports with an integrated channel service  
unit (CSU) or data service unit (DSU).  
Figure 29: Dual-Port T1 PIM  
Figure 30: Dual-Port E1 PIM  
The Dual-Port T1 and E1 PIMs provides the following key features:  
Onboard network processor  
Integrated CSU/DSUEliminates the need for a separate external device  
56-Kbps and 64-Kbps modes  
ANSI T1.102, T1.107, and T1.403 standards compliance  
G.703, G.704, and G.706 E1 standards compliance  
Independent internal and external clocking system  
Loopback, bit error rate test (BERT), T1 facilities data link (FDL), and long buildout  
diagnostics  
For pinouts of cable connectors for T1 and E1 PIMs, see E1 and T1 RJ-48 Cable  
To install or remove a PIM, see Replacing a PIMon page 172.  
Status LEDs indicate port status. Table 26 on page 57 describes the meaning of the  
LED states.  
56  
Field-Replaceable PIMs  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 3: PIM and VoIP Module Overview  
Table 26: Status LEDs for T1 and E1 Ports  
Color  
Green  
Red  
State  
Description  
On steadily  
On steadily  
Online with no alarms or failures.  
Active with a local alarm. The router has  
detected a failure.  
Unlit  
Off  
Offline.  
For alarms, see the configuring and monitoring alarms information in the J-series  
Services Router Administration Guide.  
Dual-Port Channelized T1/E1/ISDN PRI PIM  
interface card that allows you to configure a single interface as a channelized T1  
interface or a channelized E1 interface. You can also configure ISDN PRI services on  
a channelized T1 or E1 interface. The channelized T1/E1/ISDN PRI interface supports  
up to 24 DS0 channels on a T1 interface and up to 31 DS0 channels on an E1  
interface, in addition to supporting the features of regular (unchannelized) T1 and  
E1 PIMs. Each interface can be configured as a single clear-channel, fractionalized,  
or channelized interface.  
NOTE: You cannot configure a channelized T1/E1/ISDN PRI interface through a J-Web  
Quick Configuration page.  
Figure 31: Channelized T1/E1/ISDN PRI PIM  
The Dual-Port Channelized T1/E1/ISDN PRI PIM provides the following key features:  
Onboard network processor  
Two-port channelization  
Interfaces that are software configurable as T1 or E1 channels or ISDN PRI  
B-channels  
Clear-channel, fractional, and channelized operation  
Lower latency due to the addition of a Freescale processor  
Field-Replaceable PIMs  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
57  
       
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
Maximum MTU value of 4500 bytes (for channelized T1 or E1 interface) and  
4098 bytes (for ISDN PRI services)  
NOTE: For a clear-channel T1 or E1 interface, the maximum MTU is 9150 bytes.  
56-Kbps and 64-Kbps modes  
ANSI T1.102, T1.107, and T1.403 standards compliance  
G.703, G.704, and G.706 E1 standards compliance  
Independent internal and external clocking system  
Loopback, bit error rate test (BERT), T1 facilities data link (FDL), and long buildout  
diagnostics  
For pinouts of cable connectors for channelized T1/E1/ISDN PRI PIMs, see ISDN  
To install or remove a PIM, see Replacing a PIMon page 172.  
Channelized T1/E1/ISDN PRI LEDs indicate PIM and port status. Table 27 on page  
58 describes the meaning of the LED states.  
NOTE: The STATUS LED displays channelized T1 or E1 port activity and alarms only.  
It does not display ISDN PRI B-channel or D-channel status.  
Table 27: LEDs for Channelized T1/E1/ISDN PRI PIMs  
Label  
Color  
State  
Description  
ONLINE  
Green  
On steadily  
PIM is online and  
operational.  
Unlit  
Off  
PIM is not online.  
STATUS  
Green  
On steadily  
Port is online with no  
alarms or failures, and  
the physical layer is  
active.  
Red  
Online  
Port is active with a  
local alarm. The  
router has detected a  
failure and the  
physical layer is  
inactive.  
Yellow  
Unlit  
Online  
Offline  
Port is online with  
alarms for remote  
failures.  
Port is disabled.  
58  
Field-Replaceable PIMs  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 3: PIM and VoIP Module Overview  
For alarms, see the configuring and monitoring alarms information in the J-series  
Services Router Administration Guide.  
T3 or E3 PIM  
The T3 (also known as DS3) PIM (Figure 32 on page 59) and E3 PIM  
(Figure 33 on page 59) provide a physical connection to T3 or E3 network media  
types. The T3 and E3 PIMs include one physical T3 or E3 port with an integrated  
data service unit (DSU).  
Figure 32: T3 PIM  
Figure 33: E3 PIM  
The T3 and E3 PIMs provide the following key features:  
Onboard network processor  
Integrated DSUEliminates the need for a separate external device  
Subrate and scrambling options with support for major DSU vendors  
Independent internal and external clocking system  
Loopback (payloadsupported only on T3 PIM, local, and remote), bit error rate  
test (BERT), and T3 far-end alarm and control (FEAC) diagnostics  
To install or remove a PIM, see Replacing a PIMon page 172.  
Status LEDs indicate port status. Table 28 on page 60 describes the meaning of the  
LED states.  
Field-Replaceable PIMs  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
59  
       
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
Table 28: Status LEDs for T3 and E3 Ports  
Color  
Green  
Red  
State  
Description  
On steadily  
On steadily  
Online with no alarms or failures.  
Active with a local alarm. The router has  
detected a failure.  
Yellow  
On steadily  
Loopback mode.  
T3 (DS3)Remote endpoint is in red  
alarm failure.  
E3Remote defect indication (RDI).  
Unlit  
Off  
Offline.  
For alarms, see the configuring and monitoring alarms information in the J-series  
Services Router Administration Guide.  
Dual-Port Fast Ethernet PIM  
Fast Ethernet ports.  
Figure 34: Fast Ethernet PIM  
The Dual-Port Fast Ethernet PIM provides the following key features:  
Onboard network processor  
Full-duplex and half-duplex modes  
Media access control (MAC) address filtering  
Autonegotiation through medium-dependent interface (MDI) and MDI crossover  
(MDIX) support  
For pinouts of cable connectors for Fast Ethernet PIMs, see Fast Ethernet RJ-45  
To install or remove a PIM, see Replacing a PIMon page 172.  
Fast Ethernet LEDs indicate link status, port speed, and activity. Table 29 on page  
61 describes the meaning of the LEDs.  
60  
Field-Replaceable PIMs  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 3: PIM and VoIP Module Overview  
Table 29: LEDs for Dual-Port Fast Ethernet PIM  
Label  
Color  
State  
Description  
Green (100 Mbps)  
Yellow (10 Mbps)  
Red  
On steadily  
Online and link is active.  
LINK/SPEED  
Disconnected  
Blinking  
Link is unavailable.  
Green  
Online with network traffic.  
Online without traffic.  
ACTIVITY  
Green  
On steadily  
For alarms, see the configuring and monitoring alarms information in the J-series  
Services Router Administration Guide.  
4-Port Fast Ethernet ePIM  
You can install 4-Port Fast Ethernet ePIMs in any of the high-speed slots, as follows:  
J4350Install up to two 4-Port Fast Ethernet ePIMs in slots 3 and 6.  
J6350Install up to four 4-Port Fast Ethernet ePIMs in slots 2, 3, 5, and 6.  
NOTE: For 4-port Fast Ethernet ePIMs, if you apply a CoS scheduler map on outgoing  
(egress) traffic, the router does not divide the bandwidth appropriately among the  
CoS queues. As a workaround, configure enforced CoS shaping on the ports.  
The 4-Port 10/100-Mbps Fast Ethernet ePIM, shown in Figure 35 on page 61, has  
four physical Fast Ethernet ports.  
Figure 35: 4-Port Fast Ethernet ePIM  
The 4-Port Fast Ethernet ePIM provides the following key features:  
Full-duplex and half-duplex modes.  
Autonegotiation through medium-dependent interface (MDI) and MDI crossover  
(MDIX) support.  
Field-Replaceable PIMs  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
61  
       
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
For pinouts of cable connectors for Fast Ethernet ePIMs, see Fast Ethernet RJ-45  
NOTE: 4-port Fast Ethernet ePIMs support a maximum frame size of 1514 bytes.  
Jumbo frames are not supported.  
For information about installing and removing a PIM, see Replacing a  
Fast Ethernet LEDs indicate link status and activity. Table 30 on page 62 describes  
the meaning of the LEDs.  
Table 30: LEDs for 4-Port Fast Ethernet ePIM  
Label  
Color  
Green  
Unlit  
State  
Description  
Link status (upper  
left)  
On steadily  
Off  
Port is online.  
Port is offline.  
Link activity (upper Green  
right)  
Blinking  
Port is transmitting or receiving  
data.  
Unlit  
Off  
Port might be online, but it is not  
transmitting or receiving data.  
For alarms, see the configuring and monitoring alarms information in the J-series  
Services Router Administration Guide.  
4-Port ISDN BRI PIMs  
The 4-port ISDN BRI PIMs have four physical ports that support the ISDN BRI S/T  
(Figure 36 on page 62) or ISDN BRI U (Figure 37 on page 63) interface type.  
Figure 36: ISDN BRI S/T PIM  
62  
Field-Replaceable PIMs  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 3: PIM and VoIP Module Overview  
Figure 37: ISDN BRI U PIM  
ISDN BRI PIMs provide the following key features:  
Onboard network processor  
Bandwidth on demand  
Dial backup  
Dial-on-demand routing backup (floating static and dialer watch)  
For pinouts of cable connectors for ISDN PIMs, see ISDN RJ-45 Connector  
To install or remove a PIM, see Replacing a PIMon page 172.  
of the LED states.  
Table 31: LEDs for ISDN BRI S/T and U PIMs  
Label  
Color  
State  
Description  
Green  
Blinking  
Call setup is successful on either the B1 or B2  
channel.  
ONLINE  
Green  
On steadily  
On steadily  
ISDN Layer 2 is active.  
Amber  
ISDN Layer 1 is active.  
ISDN Layer 2 is unavailable.  
Red  
Disconnected  
BRI interface port is not connected.  
ISDN Layer 1 is unavailable.  
Unlit  
Green  
Red  
Off  
BRI interface is offline.  
On steadily  
Disconnected  
Off  
PIM is online and operational.  
PIM is not operational and needs replacement.  
PIM is offline.  
STATUS  
Unlit  
Field-Replaceable PIMs  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
63  
   
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
For alarms, see the configuring and monitoring alarms information in the J-series  
Services Router Administration Guide.  
ADSL PIM  
The ADSL PIM provides a single physical interface to asymmetric digital subscriber  
line (ADSL) network media types. The ADSL PIM, one supporting Annex A  
(Figure 38 on page 64) over plain old telephone service (POTS) and the other Annex B  
(Figure 39 on page 64) over ISDN, includes one physical ADSL port for an  
ATM-over-ADSL connection.  
Figure 38: ADSL 2/2+ Annex A PIM  
Figure 39: ADSL 2/2+ Annex B PIM  
The ADSL PIM provides the following key features:  
Onboard network processor  
ADSL, ADSL2, and ADSL2+ protocols on the same PIM  
Dying gaspnotification  
Asynchronous Transfer Mode (ATM) Adaptation Layer 5 (AAL5) encapsulation  
For pinouts of cable connectors for ADSL PIMs, see ADSL and G.SHDSL RJ-11  
To install or remove a PIM, see Replacing a PIMon page 172.  
The ADSL PIMs have two LEDs to indicate the status of the PIM and its port.  
Table 32 on page 65 describes the meaning of the LED states.  
64  
Field-Replaceable PIMs  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 3: PIM and VoIP Module Overview  
Table 32: LEDs for ADSL PIMs  
Label  
Color  
State  
Description  
Green  
On steadily  
PIM passed the self-test and is online and  
operational.  
ONLINE  
Unlit  
Green  
Red  
Off  
PIM is offline.  
On steadily  
On steadily  
Online with no alarms or failures.  
STATUS  
Active with local or remote alarms. The router  
has detected a failure.  
For alarms, see the configuring and monitoring alarms information in the J-series  
Services Router Administration Guide.  
G.SHDSL PIM  
The G.SHDSL PIM (Figure 40 on page 65) provides symmetric high-speed digital  
subscriber line (SHDSL) physical interfaces to ATM network media types. The G.SHDSL  
PIM has two ports for ATM-over-SHDSL connections.  
Figure 40: G.SHDSL PIM  
The G.SHDSL PIM supports the following key features:  
Onboard network processor  
2-port two-wire mode and 1-port four-wire mode  
Programmable line rates in both modes:  
2-port two-wire mode supports autodetection of line rate and fixed line rates  
from 192 Kbps to 2.304 Mbps in 64-Kbps increments.  
1-port four-wire mode supports fixed line rates from 384 Kbps to 4.608 Mbps  
in 128-Kbps increments.  
32 virtual channels per PIM  
ATM-over-G.SHDSL framing  
Dying gaspnotification  
Field-Replaceable PIMs  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
65  
       
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
Local and remote loopback diagnostics  
ITU-T G.991.2, ITU-T G.994.1, and ITU-T G.997.1 standards compliance  
NOTE: Payload loopback functionality is not supported on ATM-over-SHDSL interfaces.  
For pinouts of cable connectors for G.SHDSL PIMs, see ADSL and G.SHDSL RJ-11  
To install or remove a PIM, see Replacing a PIMon page 172.  
The G.SHDSL PIM has two LEDs to indicate the status of the PIM and its ports.  
Table 33 on page 66 describes the meaning of the LED states.  
Table 33: LEDs for G.SHDSL PIMs  
Label  
Color  
Green  
Red  
State  
Description  
On steadily  
Disconnected  
Off  
Online with no alarms or failures.  
Initialization of the PIM has failed.  
PIM is booting.  
ONLINE  
Unlit  
Green  
Red  
On steadily  
On steadily  
Online with no alarms or failures.  
STATUS  
Active with a local alarm. The router has detected a  
failure.  
For alarms, see the configuring and monitoring alarms information in the J-series  
Services Router Administration Guide.  
Avaya VoIP Modules  
The Avaya VoIP modules are installed in a J-series chassis like Physical Interface  
Modules (PIMs), but they are controlled by the Avaya Communication Manager  
software rather than the JUNOS software.  
CAUTION: PIMs and VoIP modules are not hot-swappable. You must power off the  
Services Router before removing or inserting a PIM or VoIP module. Ensure that the  
PIMs and VoIP modules are installed in the router chassis before booting up the  
system.  
CAUTION: The grounding cable for J-series routers must be, at minimum, 14 AWG  
cable. For more information, see Chassis Groundingon page 123.  
66  
Avaya VoIP Modules  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Chapter 3: PIM and VoIP Module Overview  
Avaya VoIP modules are described in the following sections:  
Avaya VoIP Module Summary  
Table 34 on page 67 and Table 35 on page 68 provide the module names, software  
release information, slot and port numbers, maximum number allowed on a chassis,  
and sample interface names (where applicable) for the Avaya VoIP modules.  
CAUTION: Do not install a combination of PIMs in a single chassis that exceeds the  
maximum power and heat capacity of the chassis. If J-series power management is  
enabled, PIMs that exceed the maximum power and heat capacity remain offline  
when the chassis is powered on.  
On each J-series Services Router with Avaya VoIP, a single TGM550 Telephony  
Gateway Module (TGM) and at least one telephony interface module (TIM) is required.  
No more than four TIMs of any kind can be installed on a single chassis.  
Table 34: J2320 and J2350 Avaya VoIP Module Summary  
Sample Interface  
Name  
Software Release for Slot and Port  
Maximum Number on a  
Chassis  
PIM  
Also Called  
This PIM  
Numbering  
(type-pim/0/port)  
TGM550  
Telephony  
Gateway  
Module  
TGM550  
Gateway  
Module  
JUNOS 8.4 and later  
J2320Slots One (required)  
1 through 3  
vp-3/0/0  
If more than one  
TGM550 is installed,  
only the one in the  
(See the interface  
naming conventions  
in the J-series Services  
Router Basic LAN and  
WAN Access  
J2350Slots  
1 through 5  
TGM550  
lowest-numbered slot is  
enabled. For example, if  
TGM550s are installed in  
slots 2 and 3, only the  
one in slot 2 is enabled.  
Configuration Guide.)  
TIM508  
Analog  
Telephony  
Interface  
Module  
TIM508  
media  
module  
JUNOS 8.5 and later  
J2320Slots One on J2320  
1 through 3  
Three on J2350 (See  
J2350Slots  
1 through 5  
TIM508  
Avaya VoIP Modules  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
67  
     
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
Table 34: J2320 and J2350 Avaya VoIP Module Summary (continued)  
Sample Interface  
Name  
Software Release for Slot and Port  
Maximum Number on a  
Chassis  
PIM  
Also Called  
This PIM  
Numbering  
(type-pim/0/port)  
TIM510 E1/T1  
Telephony  
Interface  
TIM510  
E1/T1 media  
module  
JUNOS 8.4 and later  
J2320Slots Two  
1 through 3  
J2350Slots  
1 through 5  
Module  
TIM510  
TIM514  
Analog  
Telephony  
Interface  
Module  
TIM514  
analog media  
module  
JUNOS 8.4 and later  
JUNOS 8.5 and later  
JUNOS 8.5 and later  
JUNOS 8.4 and later  
J2320Slots Two  
1 through 3  
J2350Slots  
1 through 5  
TIM514  
TIM516  
Analog  
Telephony  
Interface  
Module  
TIM516  
analog media  
module  
J2320Slots One on J2320  
1 through 3  
Three on J2350 (See  
J2350Slots  
1 through 5  
TIM516  
TIM518  
Analog  
Telephony  
Interface  
Module  
TIM518  
analog media  
module  
J2320Slots One on J2320  
1 through 3  
Three on J2350 (See  
J2350Slots  
1 through 5  
TIM518  
TIM521 BRI  
Telephony  
Interface  
Module  
TIM521 BRI  
media  
module  
J2320Slots Two  
1 through 3  
J2350Slots  
1 through 5  
TIM521  
Table 35: J4350 and J6350 Avaya VoIP Module Summary  
Sample Interface  
Name  
Software Release for Slot and Port  
Maximum Number on a  
Chassis  
PIM  
Also Called  
This PIM  
Numbering  
(type-pim/0/port)  
TGM550  
Telephony  
Gateway  
Module  
TGM550  
Gateway  
Module  
JUNOS 8.2 and later  
Slots 1 through 6  
One (required)  
vp-3/0/0  
If more than one  
TGM550 is installed,  
only the one in the  
lowest-numbered slot is  
enabled. For example, if  
TGM550s are installed in  
slots 2 and 3, only the  
one in slot 2 is enabled.  
(See the interface  
naming conventions  
in the J-series Services  
Router Basic LAN and  
WAN Access  
TGM550  
Configuration Guide.)  
68  
Avaya VoIP Modules  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 3: PIM and VoIP Module Overview  
Table 35: J4350 and J6350 Avaya VoIP Module Summary (continued)  
Sample Interface  
Name  
Software Release for Slot and Port  
Maximum Number on a  
Chassis  
PIM  
Also Called  
This PIM  
Numbering  
(type-pim/0/port)  
TIM508  
Analog  
TIM508  
media  
JUNOS 8.5 and later  
Slots 1 through 6  
Telephony  
Interface  
Module  
module  
TIM508  
TIM510 E1/T1  
Telephony  
Interface  
TIM510  
E1/T1 media  
module  
JUNOS 8.2 and later  
JUNOS 8.2 and later  
Slots 1 through 6  
Slots 1 through 6  
Two  
Four  
Module  
TIM510  
TIM514  
Analog  
Telephony  
Interface  
Module  
TIM514  
analog media  
module  
TIM514  
TIM516  
Analog  
Telephony  
Interface  
Module  
TIM516  
analog media  
module  
JUNOS 8.5 and later  
JUNOS 8.5 and later  
JUNOS 8.2 and later  
Slots 1 through 6  
Slots 1 through 6  
Slots 1 through 6  
TIM516  
TIM518  
Analog  
Telephony  
Interface  
Module  
TIM518  
analog media  
module  
TIM518  
TIM521 BRI  
Telephony  
Interface  
Module  
TIM521 BRI  
media  
module  
Two  
TIM521  
TGM550 Telephony Gateway Module  
TGM550 Gateway Module, has two analog telephone ports, two analog trunk ports,  
and a serial console port.  
The TGM550 enables routers to provide VoIP services to telephones and trunks that  
do not directly support VoIP by translating voice and signaling data between VoIP  
and the system used by the telephones and trunks.  
Avaya VoIP Modules  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
69  
   
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
Figure 41: TGM550 Telephony Gateway Module  
The TGM550 provides the following key features:  
Voice  
VoIP Media Gateway services.  
Two analog telephone (LINE) ports to support two analog telephones or  
incoming analog direct inward dialing (DID) trunks with either wink start or  
immediate start. An analog relay supports emergency transfer relay (ETR).  
Two analog trunk (TRUNK) ports to support loop start, ground start, centralized  
automatic message accounting (CAMA), and direct inward and outward  
dialing (DIOD) (for Japan only) trunks.  
Survivability features for continuous voice services.  
Call center capabilities.  
Provisioning  
Avaya Communication Manager (CM) media server management  
Extensive alarm and troubleshooting features  
Survivability  
Media Gateway Controller (MGC) automatic switchover, migration, and  
survivability features  
Modem backup connection to the MGC  
Dynamic call admission control (CAC) for WAN interfaces  
Management: One serial port for console access over an RJ-45 connector cable  
NOTE: The RJ-45 console cable and DB-9 adapter supplied with the TGM550 are  
different from the RJ-45 cable and DB-9 adapter supplied with the Services Router  
for console connections to the Services Router. You cannot use the RJ-45 cable and  
DB-9 adapter supplied with the Services Router for console connections to the  
TGM550.  
70  
Avaya VoIP Modules  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 3: PIM and VoIP Module Overview  
Table 36 on page 71 lists the maximum number of media servers, telephones, and  
so on that are supported by the TGM550 installed on a J4350 or J6350 or J2320 or  
J2350 Services Router.  
Table 36: TGM550 Maximum Media Gateway Capacities  
Hardware or Feature  
TGM550 Maximum Capacity  
Additional Information  
TGM550s that can be controlled by an  
Avaya S8500 or S8700 Media Server  
250  
This number also applies if a  
combination of Avaya G700 Media  
Gateways, G250 Media Gateways, and  
G350 Media Gateways are controlled by  
the same media server.  
TGM550s that can be controlled by an  
Avaya S8400 Media Server  
5
This number also applies if a  
combination of Avaya G700 Media  
Gateways, G250 Media Gateways, and  
G350 Media Gateways are controlled by  
the same media server.  
TGM550s that can be controlled by an  
Avaya S8300 Media Server  
49  
This capacity is 50 if a combination of  
Avaya G700 Media Gateways, G250  
Media Gateways, and G350 Media  
Gateways are controlled by the same  
media server.  
The S8300 must reside in a G700 or  
G350 media gateway. Therefore, the  
maximum of 50 H.248 gateways  
supported by the S8300 means that only  
49 of the 50 can be TGM550s.  
Media servers that can be registered as  
Media Gateway Controllers (MGCs) on a  
TGM550  
4
If an MGC becomes unavailable, the  
TGM550 uses the next MGC on the list.  
The built-in SLS module can be  
considered as a fifth MGC, although its  
functionality is limited than that of a  
full-scale media server.  
Fixed analog line ports  
2
Fixed analog trunk ports  
Digital signal processors (DSPs)  
2
1 (up to 80 channels)  
For calls using voice codec sets with  
20-millisecond-or-higher packet sizes,  
the DSP supports:  
80 channels  
20 channels  
10 channels  
For calls with 10-millisecond-or-lower  
packet sizes, the 80channel DSP  
supports 40 channels.  
For TTY, fax, or modem over IP calls,  
the 80channel DSP supports  
40 channels.  
Avaya VoIP Modules  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
71  
 
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
Table 36: TGM550 Maximum Media Gateway Capacities (continued)  
Hardware or Feature  
TGM550 Maximum Capacity  
Additional Information  
Busy Hour Call Completion Rate (BHCC) 800  
Total of IP and analog telephones that  
can be connected to a TGM550 and TIMs  
70 (J4350)  
Maximum includes a combination of  
analog and IP telephones  
100 (J6350)  
Touch-tone recognition (TTR)  
Tone generation  
32  
Receivers  
As much as necessary for all TDM calls.  
Announcements (VAL)  
16 playback channels for playing announcements, one of which can be used for  
recording  
20 minutes for G711-quality stored announcements and music-on-hold.  
256 maximum announcements stored  
CAUTION: Some capacities may change. For the most recent list, see the Avaya  
manual System Capacities Table for Avaya Communication Manager on Avaya Media  
Servers.  
For pinouts of the TGM550 RJ-45 console connector, see TGM550 Console Port  
Pinoutson page 239. For pinouts of cable connectors for the TGM550 analog ports,  
To install or remove an Avaya VoIP module, see Replacing a PIMon page 172.  
TGM550 LEDs indicate link status and activity. Table 37 on page 72 describes the  
meaning of the LEDs.  
Table 37: LEDs for TGM550 Gateway Module  
Label  
Color  
State  
Description  
Red  
On steadily  
Alarm. A failure in the TGM550  
ALM  
requires monitoring or maintenance.  
Yellow  
Green  
On steadily  
On steadily  
Active. The TGM550 is online with  
network traffic.  
ACT  
ASB  
Alternate software bank. The  
software is not running from the  
selected boot bank.  
Green  
On steadily  
Emergency transfer relay (ETR)  
feature is active.  
ETR  
72  
Avaya VoIP Modules  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 3: PIM and VoIP Module Overview  
For more information about the TGM550, see the Avaya manual Hardware Description  
and Reference for Avaya Communication Manager.  
TIM508 Analog Telephony Interface Module  
as the TIM508 analog media module, has eight analog telephone lines that can be  
used as trunk ports.  
Figure 42: TIM508 Analog Telephony Interface Module  
8
1
LINES  
Analog  
ALM  
CT  
A
508  
TIM  
NOTE: All eight analog lines can be configured as analog direct inward (DID) trunks.  
You can configure TIM508 ports as described in Table 38 on page 73.  
Table 38: TIM508 Possible Port Configurations  
Possible Analog Telephone Line Configurations  
Wink-start or immed-start DID trunk  
Analog tip/ring devices such as single-line telephones with or without LED message-waiting indication  
The TIM508 also provides the following features:  
Three ringer loads, the ringer equivalency number for up to 2,000 ft (610 m),  
for all eight lines  
Up to eight simultaneously ringing lines  
Type 1 caller ID and Type 2 caller ID for lines  
Ring voltage generation for a variety of international frequencies and cadences  
For pinouts of cable connectors for the TIM508, see TIM508 Connector  
To install or remove an Avaya VoIP module, see Replacing a PIMon page 172.  
Avaya VoIP Modules  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
73  
         
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
TIM508 LEDs indicate link status and activity. Table 39 on page 74 describes the  
meaning of the LEDs.  
Table 39: LEDs for TIM508  
Label  
Color  
State  
Description  
Red  
On steadily  
Alarm. A TIM508 failure requires  
monitoring or maintenance.  
ALM  
Yellow  
Blinking  
Active. A device connected to the  
TIM508 is in use. This situation can  
include a telephone that is off the  
hook.  
ACT  
For more information about the TIM508, see the Avaya manual Hardware Description  
and Reference for Avaya Communication Manager.  
TIM510 E1/T1 Telephony Interface Module  
The TIM510 E1/T1 Telephony Interface Module (Figure 43 on page 74), also known  
as the TIM510 E1/T1 media module, terminates an E1 or T1 trunk. The TIM510 T1/E1  
media module has a built-in channel service unit (CSU) so an external CSU is not  
necessary. The CSU is used for a T1 circuit only. Up to two TIM510s can be installed  
in any of the slots on the Services Router.  
Figure 43: TIM510 E1/T1 Telephony Interface Module  
The TIM510 provides the following key features:  
1 E1 or T1 trunk port with up to 30 channels on an E1 port and 24 channels on  
a T1 port.  
DS1-level support for a variety of E1 and T1 trunk types  
Trunk signaling to support U.S. and international central office (CO) or tie trunks  
Echo cancellation in either directionincoming or outgoing  
For pinouts of cable connectors for the TIM510, see TIM510 RJ-45 Connector  
74  
Avaya VoIP Modules  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Chapter 3: PIM and VoIP Module Overview  
To install or remove an Avaya VoIP module, see Replacing a PIMon page 172.  
TIM510 LEDs indicate link status and activity. Table 40 on page 75 describes the  
meaning of the LEDs.  
Table 40: LEDs for TIM510  
Label  
Color  
State  
Description  
Red  
On steadily  
Alarm. A TIM510 failure requires  
monitoring or maintenance.  
ALM  
Green  
On steadily  
On steadily  
Active. The TIM510 is online with  
network traffic.  
ACT  
TST  
Yellow  
Test. A test is being performed on  
the TIM510 through the Media  
Gateway Controller (MGC).  
Green  
On steadily  
Signal. The link to the central office  
(CO) is active.  
SIG  
For more information about the TIM510, see the Avaya manual Hardware Description  
and Reference for Avaya Communication Manager.  
TIM514 Analog Telephony Interface Module  
as the TIM514 analog media module, has four analog telephone ports and four analog  
trunk ports.  
Figure 44: TIM514 Analog Telephony Interface Module  
NOTE: For analog direct inward dialing (DID) trunks, you must use the four analog  
telephone (LINE) ports. You cannot use the four analog trunk (TRUNK) ports for analog  
DID trunks.  
You can configure TIM514 ports as described in Table 41 on page 76.  
Avaya VoIP Modules  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
75  
           
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
Table 41: TIM514 Possible Port Configurations  
Possible Analog Telephone (LINE) Port  
Configurations  
Possible Analog Trunk (TRUNK) Port Configurations  
Wink-start or immediate-start DID trunk  
Loop-start or ground-start central office trunk with a loop current of 18  
milliamperes (mA) to 120 mA  
Analog tip/ring devices such as single-line telephones Two-wire analog outgoing centralized automatic message accounting  
with or without LED message-waiting indication  
(CAMA) emergency E911 trunk, for connectivity to the PSTN  
Multifrequency (MF) signaling is supported for CAMA ports.  
The TIM514 also provides the following features:  
Three ringer loads, the ringer equivalency number for up to 2,000 ft (610 m),  
for all eight ports  
Up to four simultaneously ringing ports  
Type 1 caller ID and Type 2 caller ID  
Ring voltage generation for a variety of international frequencies and cadences  
For pinouts of cable connectors for the TIM514, see TIM514 Connector  
To install or remove an Avaya VoIP module, see Replacing a PIMon page 172.  
TIM514 LEDs indicate link status and activity. Table 42 on page 76 describes the  
meaning of the LEDs.  
Table 42: LEDs for TIM514  
Label  
Color  
State  
Description  
Red  
On steadily  
Alarm. A TIM514 failure requires  
monitoring or maintenance.  
ALM  
Yellow  
Blinking  
Active. A device connected to the  
TIM514 is in use. This situation can  
include a telephone that is off the  
hook.  
ACT  
For more information about the TIM514, see the Avaya manual Hardware Description  
and Reference for Avaya Communication Manager.  
TIM516 Analog Telephony Interface Module  
as the TIM516 analog media module, has 16 analog telephone lines.  
76  
Avaya VoIP Modules  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 3: PIM and VoIP Module Overview  
Figure 45: TIM516 Analog Telephony Interface Module  
8
1
S
E
S
N
E
I
L
I
N
L
4
2
7
1
S
E
N
I
L
g
lo  
a
n
A
M
L
A
T
C
A
6
1
5
M
I
T
You can configure TIM516 lines as described in Table 43 on page 77.  
Table 43: TIM516 Possible Port Configurations  
Possible Analog Telephone (LINE) Line Configurations  
Analog tip/ring devices such as single-line telephones with or without LED message-waiting indication  
The TIM516 also provides the following features:  
Three ringer loads, the ringer equivalency number for up to 2,000 ft (610 m),  
for all 16 lines  
Up to 16 simultaneously ringing lines  
Type 1 caller ID and Type 2 caller ID for line lines  
Ring voltage generation for a variety of international frequencies and cadences  
For pinouts of cable connectors for the TIM516, see TIM516 Connector  
To install or remove an Avaya VoIP module, see Replacing a PIMon page 172.  
TIM516 LEDs indicate link status and activity. Table 44 on page 77 describes the  
meaning of the LEDs.  
Table 44: LEDs for TIM516  
Label  
Color  
State  
Description  
Red  
On steadily  
Alarm. A TIM516 failure requires  
monitoring or maintenance.  
ALM  
Yellow  
Blinking  
Active. A device connected to the  
TIM516 is in use. This situation can  
include a telephone that is off the  
hook.  
ACT  
Avaya VoIP Modules  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
77  
     
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
For more information about the TIM516, see the Avaya manual Hardware Description  
and Reference for Avaya Communication Manager.  
TIM518 Analog Telephony Interface Module  
as the TIM518 analog media module, has eight analog telephone lines and eight  
analog trunk lines.  
Figure 46: TIM518 Analog Telephony Interface Module  
8
1
LINES  
24  
17  
LINES  
Analog  
ALM  
CT  
51  
A
8
TIM  
NOTE: For analog direct inward dialing (DID) trunks, you can use all eight analog  
telephone lines.  
You can configure eight TIM518 analog telephone lines as described in  
Table 45: TIM518 Possible Port Configurations  
Possible Analog Telephone Port Configurations  
Possible Analog Trunk Port Configurations  
Wink-start or immed-start DID trunk  
Loop-start or ground-start central office trunk with a loop  
current of 18 milliamperes (mA) to 120 mA  
Analog tip/ring devices such as single-line telephones with or Two-wire analog outgoing centralized automatic message  
without LED message-waiting indication  
accounting (CAMA) emergency E911 trunk, for connectivity  
to the PSTN  
The TIM518 also provides the following features:  
Three ringer loads, the ringer equivalency number for up to 2,000 ft (610 m),  
for all 16 lines  
Up to 16 simultaneously ringing lines  
Type 1 caller ID and Type 2 caller ID for line lines  
Type 1 caller ID for trunk lines  
Ring voltage generation for a variety of international frequencies and cadences  
78  
Avaya VoIP Modules  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Chapter 3: PIM and VoIP Module Overview  
For pinouts of cable connectors for the TIM518, see TIM518 Connector  
To install or remove an Avaya VoIP module, see Replacing a PIMon page 172.  
TIM518 LEDs indicate link status and activity. Table 46 on page 79 describes the  
meaning of the LEDs.  
Table 46: LEDs for TIM518  
Label  
Color  
State  
Description  
Red  
On steadily  
Alarm. A TIM518 failure requires  
monitoring or maintenance.  
ALM  
Yellow  
Blinking  
Active. A device connected to the  
TIM518 is in use. This situation can  
include a telephone that is off the  
hook.  
ACT  
For more information about the TIM518, see the Avaya manual Hardware Description  
and Reference for Avaya Communication Manager.  
TIM521 BRI Telephony Interface Module  
The TIM521 BRI Telephony Interface Module (Figure 47 on page 79), also known as  
the TIM521 BRI media module, has four ports with RJ-45 jacks that can be  
administered as ISDN Basic Rate Interface (BRI) trunk connections. Each ISDN BRI  
port has two B-channels plus a D-channel. Up to two TIM521s (with 4 BRI trunk ports  
each) can be installed in any of the slots on the Services Router.  
Figure 47: TIM521 BRI Telephony Interface Module  
For ISDN BRI trunking, the TIM521 supports up to four BRI interfaces to the central  
office at the ISDN T reference point. Information is communicated on each port in  
two ways:  
Over two 64-Kbps B-channels, called B1 and B2, that can be circuit-switched  
simultaneously  
Avaya VoIP Modules  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
79  
         
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
NOTE: The TIM521 does not support BRI stations or combining both B-channels  
together to form a 128-Kbps channel.  
Over a 16-Kbps channel, called the D-channel, that is used for signaling. The  
TIM521 occupies one time slot for all four D-channels  
The circuit-switched connections have an a-law or mu-law option for voice operation.  
The circuit-switched connections operate as 64-Kbps clear channels transmitting  
data.  
For pinouts of cable connectors for the TIM521, see TIM521 Connector  
To install or remove an Avaya VoIP module, see Replacing a PIMon page 172.  
TIM521 LEDs indicate link status and activity. Table 47 on page 80 describes the  
meaning of the LEDs.  
Table 47: LEDs for TIM521  
Label  
Color  
State  
Description  
Red  
On steadily  
Alarm. A TIM521 failure requires  
monitoring or maintenance.  
ALM  
Yellow  
On steadily  
Active. A trunk connected to the  
TIM521 is in use.  
ACT  
For more information about the TIM521, see the Avaya manual Hardware Description  
and Reference for Avaya Communication Manager.  
80  
Avaya VoIP Modules  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 4  
Services Router User Interface Overview  
You can use two user interfaces to monitor, configure, troubleshoot, and manage a  
Services Routerthe J-Web interface and the JUNOS command-line interface (CLI).  
This chapter contains the following topics:  
User Interface Overview  
This section contains the following topics:  
J-Web Overview  
The J-Web interface allows you to monitor, configure, troubleshoot, and manage the  
Services Router by means of a Web browser enabled with Hypertext Transfer Protocol  
(HTTP) or HTTP over Secure Sockets Layer (HTTPS). J-Web provides access to all the  
configuration statements supported by the Services Router, so you can fully configure  
it without using the JUNOS CLI.  
You can perform the following tasks with the J-Web interface:  
MonitoringDisplay the current configuration and information about the system,  
interfaces, chassis, routing protocols, routing tables, routing policy filters, and  
other features.  
ConfiguringView the current configurations at a glance, configure the Services  
Router, and manage configuration files. The J-Web interface provides the following  
different configuration methods:  
Configure the Services Router quickly and easily without configuring each  
statement individually.  
Edit a graphical version of the JUNOS CLI configuration statements and  
hierarchy.  
User Interface Overview  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
81  
         
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
Edit the configuration in a text file.  
Upload a configuration file.  
The J-Web interface also allows you to manage configuration history and set a  
rescue configuration.  
DiagnosingDiagnose routing problems by running the ping or traceroute  
diagnostic tool. The diagnostic tools also allow you to capture and analyze control  
traffic on the routers.  
ManagingManage log, temporary, and core (crash) files and schedule reboots  
on the J-series routers. On J-series routers, you can also manage software packages  
and licenses and copy a snapshot of the system software to a backup device.  
Configuring and monitoring eventsFilter and view system log messages that  
record events occurring on the router. You can configure files to log system log  
messages and also assign attributes, such as severity levels, to messages.  
Configuring and monitoring alarmsOn J-series routers only, monitor and  
diagnose the router by monitoring active alarms that alert you to the conditions  
on a network interface. You can also set the conditions that trigger alarms on  
an interface.  
For more information about the J-Web interface, see Using the J-Web  
CLI Overview  
The CLI is a straightforward command interface in which you type commands on a  
line and press Enter to execute them. The CLI provides command help, command  
completion, and Emacs-style keyboard sequences for moving around on the command  
line and scrolling through a buffer of recently executed commands.  
The CLI has two modes:  
Operational modeComplete set of commands to control the CLI environment,  
monitor and troubleshoot network connectivity, manage the Services Router,  
and enter configuration mode.  
Configuration modeComplete set of commands to configure the Services  
Router. This guide refers to configuration mode as the CLI configuration editor.  
For more information about the CLI, see Using the Command-Line  
Before You Begin  
Before you start the user interface, you must perform the initial Services Router  
configuration described in Establishing Basic Connectivityon page 131. After the  
initial configuration, you use your username and password, and the hostname or IP  
address of the router, to start the user interface.  
82  
Before You Begin  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Chapter 4: Services Router User Interface Overview  
Using the J-Web Interface  
This section contains the following topics:  
For more information about using the J-Web interface, see the J-Web Interface User  
Guide.  
Starting the J-Web Interface  
To start the J-Web interface:  
1. Launch your HTTP-enabled or HTTPS-enabled Web browser.  
To use HTTPS, you must have installed a certificate on the Services Router and  
enabled HTTPS.  
NOTE: If the Services Router is running the worldwide version of the JUNOS software  
and you are using the Microsoft Internet Explorer Web browser, you must disable  
the Use SSL 3.0 option in the Web browser to access the Services Router.  
2.  
After http:// or https:// in your Web browser, type the hostname or IP address  
of the Services Router and press Enter.  
The J-Web login page appears.  
3. On the login page, type your username and password, and click Log In.  
To correct or change the username or password you typed, click Reset, type the  
new entry or entries, and click Log In.  
NOTE: The default username is root with no password. You must change this during  
initial configuration or the system does not accept the configuration.  
The J-Web Quick Configuration>Set Up or Monitor>System page appears.  
To explicitly terminate a J-Web session at any time, click Logout in the top pane.  
J-Web Layout  
Each page of the J-Web interface is divided into the following panes, as shown in  
Using the J-Web Interface  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
83  
           
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
Top paneDisplays identifying information and links.  
Main paneLocation where you monitor, configure, diagnose, and manage the  
Services Router by entering information in text boxes, making selections, and  
clicking buttons.  
Side paneDisplays subtasks of the Monitor, Configuration, Diagnose, or Manage  
task currently displayed in the main pane. For the configuration editor, this pane  
displays the hierarchy of configuration statements committed on the router.  
Click an item to access it in the main pane.  
Bottom paneDisplays copyright and trademark information.  
Figure 48: J-Web Layout  
Elements of the J-Web Interface  
This section summarizes the elements of the top pane, side pane, and main pane of  
the J-Web interface.  
84  
Using the J-Web Interface  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 4: Services Router User Interface Overview  
Top Pane Elements  
The top pane comprises the elements shown in Figure 49 on page 85.  
Figure 49: Top Pane Elements  
Juniper Networks logoLink to http://www.juniper.net in a new browser window.  
hostname modelHostname and model of the Services Router.  
Logged in as: usernameUsername you used to log in to the Services Router.  
HelpLink to context-sensitive help information.  
AboutLink to information about the J-Web interface, such as the version  
number.  
LogoutEnds your current login session with the Services Router and returns  
you to the login page.  
TaskbarMenu of J-Web tasks. Click a J-Web task to access it.  
MonitorView information about configuration and hardware on the Services  
Router.  
ConfigurationConfigure the Services Router with Quick Configuration or  
the configuration editor, and view configuration history.  
DiagnoseTroubleshoot network connectivity problems.  
ManageManage files and licenses, upgrade software, and reboot the  
Services Router.  
EventsView events and set up filters for an event summary.  
AlarmsView the alarm summary.  
Main Pane Elements  
The main pane comprises the elements shown in Figure 50 on page 86.  
Using the J-Web Interface  
85  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
Figure 50: Main Pane Elements  
Help (?) iconDisplays useful information when you move the cursor over the  
question mark. This help displays field-specific information, such as the definition,  
format, and valid range of the field.  
Red asterisk (*)Indicates a required field.  
Path to current taskShows the successive J-Web tasks and subtasks you selected  
to display the current main and side panes. Click a task to return to it.  
Icon LegendFor the Edit Configuration subtask (J-Web configuration editor)  
only, explains icons that appear in the user interface to provide information  
about configuration statements:  
CComment. Move your cursor over the icon to view a comment about the  
configuration statement.  
IInactive. The configuration statement does not affect the Services Router.  
MModified. The configuration statement is added or modified.  
*Mandatory. The configuration statement must have a value.  
Side Pane Elements  
The side pane comprises the elements shown in Figure 51 on page 87.  
86  
Using the J-Web Interface  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Chapter 4: Services Router User Interface Overview  
Figure 51: Side Pane Elements  
SubtaskDisplays options related to the selected task in the J-Web taskbar.  
Configuration hierarchyFor the J-Web configuration editor, displays the  
hierarchy of committed statements in the Services Router configuration.  
Click Expand all to display the entire hierarchy.  
Click Hide all to display only the statements at the top level.  
Click plus signs (+) to expand individual items.  
Click minus signs () to hide individual items.  
Navigating the J-Web Interface  
The layout of the panes allows you to quickly navigate through the interface. You  
navigate the J-Web interface, move forward and backward, scroll pages, and expand  
and collapse elements as you do in a typical Web browser interface.  
From the taskbar, select the J-Web task that you want to perform. Selecting the task  
displays related subtasks in the side pane. When you select a subtask, related fields  
are displayed in the main pane. By default, the system selects the first subtask and  
displays its related fields in the main pane. The side pane and taskbar are available  
from all pages, allowing you to skip from one task or subtask to the other from any  
page in the interface.  
Using the J-Web Interface  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
87  
     
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
The path displayed in the top right corner of each page provides a context. Use this  
path to see your location in a configuration hierarchy. Clicking any link in the path  
displays the corresponding page.  
You can easily navigate to most subtasks by selecting them from the side pane. On  
pages where you are required to take an action, buttons and links allow you to move  
to the next or previous page as you perform certain actions. Most buttons and links  
are self-explanatory. But some buttons have different functions on the Quick  
Configuration and Edit Configuration (J-Web configuration editor) pages. For more  
Navigating the Quick Configuration Pages  
Table 48 on page 88 describes the functions of key Quick Configuration buttons.  
Table 48: J-Web Quick Configuration Buttons  
Function  
Button  
Commit your entries into the configuration, and return to the previous J-Web  
page.  
OK  
Clear the entries you have not yet applied to the configuration, and return to the Cancel  
previous J-Web page.  
Commit your entries into the configuration, and stay on the same J-Web page.  
Apply  
Navigating the J-Web Configuration Editor  
When you select Edit Configuration (J-Web configuration editor), the side pane  
displays the top level of the configured hierarchy committed on the Services Router.  
The main pane displays the configuration hierarchy options.  
As you navigate through the configuration, the hierarchy level is displayed at the top  
of the main pane. You can click a statement or identifier displayed in the main pane,  
or in the hierarchy in the left pane, to display the corresponding configuration options  
in the main pane.  
After typing or selecting your configuration edits, click a button in the main pane  
(described in Table 49 on page 88) to move to the previous page after applying,  
committing, or canceling the configuration. An updated configuration does not take  
effect until you commit it.  
Table 49: Key J-Web Edit Configuration Buttons  
Function  
Button  
Apply edits to the candidate configuration, and return one level up (previous OK  
page) in the configuration hierarchy.  
88  
Using the J-Web Interface  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
               
Chapter 4: Services Router User Interface Overview  
Table 49: Key J-Web Edit Configuration Buttons (continued)  
Function  
Button  
Clear the entries you have not yet applied to the candidate configuration, and Cancel  
return one level up (previous page) in the configuration hierarchy.  
Verify edits and apply them to the current configuration file running on the  
Services Router.  
Commit  
Getting J-Web Help  
The J-Web interface provides two ways to display Help for the Monitor, Quick  
Configuration, Diagnose, Manage, Events, and Alarms tasks. For Help on the View  
To get Help in the J-Web interface:  
Field-sensitive HelpMove the cursor over the question mark (?) next to the field  
for which you want more information. The system displays useful information  
about the field. Typically, this Help includes one line of information about what  
this field does or what you must enter in a given text box. For example, Help  
for the Peer Autonomous System Number field states, the value should be a  
number between 1 and 65535.”  
Context-sensitive HelpClick Help in the taskbar to open a separate page  
displaying the summary of all the fields on that page. To exit Help, close the  
page. You can navigate Help pages using hypertext links connecting related  
topics, or click the following options (if available) at the top and bottom of each  
page. Figure 52 on page 90 shows Help for the CoS Configuration page.  
PrevAccess the previous page.  
NextAccess the next page.  
Report an ErrorAccess a form for providing feedback.  
Using the J-Web Interface  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
89  
       
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
Figure 52: CoS Help Page  
J-Web Sessions  
You establish a J-Web session with the Services Router through an HTTP-enabled or  
HTTPS-enabled Web browser. The HTTPS protocol, which uses 128-bit encryption,  
is available only in domestic versions of the JUNOS software. To use HTTPS, you  
must have installed a certificate on the Services Router and enabled HTTPS.  
When you attempt to log in through the J-Web interface, the Services Router  
authenticates your username with the same methods used for Telnet and SSH.  
The Services Router can support multiple J-Web sessions for a single user who logs  
in to each session. However, if a single user attempts to launch multiple J-Web  
windowsfor example, by right-clicking a link to launch another instance of a Web  
browserthe session can have unpredictable results.  
If the Services Router does not detect any activity through the J-Web interface for  
15 minutes, the session times out and is terminated. You must log in again to begin  
a new session.  
To explicitly terminate a J-Web session at any time, click Logout in the top pane.  
90  
Using the J-Web Interface  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 4: Services Router User Interface Overview  
Using the Command-Line Interface  
This section contains the following topics:  
For more information about the CLI, see the JUNOS CLI User Guide.  
CLI Command Hierarchy  
The CLI commands are organized hierarchically, with commands that perform a  
similar function grouped together under the same level. For example, all commands  
that display information about the Services Router system and system software are  
grouped under the show command, and all commands that display information about  
the routing table are grouped under the show route command. Figure 53 on page  
91 illustrates a portion of the show command hierarchy.  
Figure 53: CLI Command Hierarchy Example  
To execute a command, you enter the full command name, starting at the top level  
of the hierarchy. For example, to display a brief view of the routes in the routing  
table, use the command show route brief.  
The hierarchical organization results in commands that have a regular syntax and  
provides the following features that simplify CLI use:  
Consistent command namesCommands that provide the same type of function  
have the same name, regardless of the portion of the software they are operating  
on. For example, all show commands display software information and statistics,  
and all clear commands erase various types of system information.  
Lists and short descriptions of available commandsInformation about available  
commands is provided at each level of the CLI command hierarchy. If you type  
a question mark (?) at any level, you see a list of the available commands along  
with a short description of each command.  
Command completionCommand completion for command names (keywords)  
and command options is also available at each level of the hierarchy. If you type  
a partial command name followed immediately by a question mark (with no  
Using the Command-Line Interface  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
91  
       
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
intervening space), you see a list of commands that match the partial name you  
typed.  
Starting the CLI  
To start the CLI:  
1. Establish a connection with the Services Router:  
To access the router remotely from the network, enter the command you  
typically use to establish a remote connection (such as Telnet or ssh) using  
the router hostname.  
To access the router through a management device attached to the console  
port, start the terminal application.  
To access the router through the J-Web interface, select Diagnose>CLI  
Terminal in the J-Web interface. For more information, see the J-Web  
Interface User Guide.  
2. Log in using your username and password.  
After you log in, you enter a UNIX shell.  
3. Start the CLI.  
% cli  
user@host>  
The presence of the angle bracket (>) prompt indicates the CLI has started. By  
default, the prompt is preceded by a string that contains your username and the  
hostname of the router.  
To exit the CLI and return to the UNIX shell, enter the quit command.  
CLI Operational Mode  
The CLI has two modes: operational and configuration. When you log in to the Services  
Router and the CLI starts, you are at the top level of operational mode.  
To view a list of top-level operational mode commands, type a question mark (?) at  
the command-line prompt.  
user@host> ?  
Possible completions:  
clear  
configure  
file  
Clear information in the system  
Manipulate software configuration information  
Perform file operations  
help  
Provide help information  
monitor  
mtrace  
ping  
Show real-time debugging information  
Trace multicast path from source to receiver  
Ping remote target  
quit  
Exit the management session  
request  
restart  
Make system-level requests  
Restart software process  
92  
Using the Command-Line Interface  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Chapter 4: Services Router User Interface Overview  
set  
show  
Set CLI properties, date/time, craft interface message  
Show system information  
ssh  
Start secure shell on another host  
Start shell  
Telnet to another host  
Perform diagnostic debugging  
Trace route to remote host  
start  
telnet  
test  
traceroute  
At the top level of operational mode are a number of broad groups of CLI commands  
that are used to perform the following functions:  
Control the CLI environment.  
Monitor and troubleshoot the router.  
Connect to other systems.  
Manage files and software images.  
Control software processes.  
Stop and reboot the router.  
Enter configuration mode.  
To enter configuration mode, see CLI Configuration Modeon page 93. For  
information about the other CLI operational mode functions, see the J-series Services  
Router Administration Guide.  
CLI Configuration Mode  
To configure the Services Router, including system parameters, routing protocols,  
interfaces, network management, and user access, you must enter configuration  
mode. In configuration mode, the CLI provides commands to configure the router,  
load a text (ASCII) file that contains the router configuration, activate a configuration,  
and save the configuration to a text file.  
You enter configuration mode by entering the configure operational mode command.  
The CLI prompt changes from user@host> to user@host#.  
To view a list of configuration mode commands, type a question mark (?) at the  
command-line prompt. (You do not need to press Enter after typing the question  
mark.)  
user@host# ?  
Possible completions:  
Enter  
Execute this command  
activate  
annotate  
commit  
copy  
Remove the inactive tag from a statement  
Annotate the statement with a comment  
Commit current set of changes  
Copy a statement  
deactivate  
delete  
edit  
Add the inactive tag to a statement  
Delete a data element  
Edit a sub-element  
exit  
Exit from this level  
help  
Provide help information  
Using the Command-Line Interface  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
93  
       
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
insert  
load  
quit  
Insert a new ordered data element  
Load configuration from ASCII file  
Quit from this level  
rename  
rollback  
run  
save  
set  
Rename a statement  
Roll back to previous committed configuration  
Run an operational-mode command  
Save configuration to ASCII file  
Set a parameter  
show  
Show a parameter  
status  
top  
up  
Show users currently editing configuration  
Exit to top level of configuration  
Exit one level of configuration  
Wildcard operations  
wildcard  
The JUNOS software configuration consists of a hierarchy of statements. There are  
two types of statements: container statements, which contain other statements, and  
leaf statements, which do not contain other statements. All the container and leaf  
statements together form the configuration hierarchy.  
Each statement consists of a fixed keyword and, optionally, an identifier that you  
define, such as the name of an interface or a username.  
To configure the Services Router or to modify an existing configuration, you add  
statements to the configuration with the edit and set configuration mode commands.  
For more information about the CLI configuration editor and configuration mode,  
see the J-series Services Router Basic LAN and WAN Access Configuration Guide and  
the JUNOS software configuration guides.  
CLI Basics  
This section contains the following topics:  
Editing Keystrokes  
In the CLI, you use keystrokes to move around on and edit the command line, and  
to scroll through a list of recently executed commands. Table 50 on page 95 lists  
some typical CLI editing tasks and the keystrokes that perform them.  
94  
Using the Command-Line Interface  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 4: Services Router User Interface Overview  
Table 50: CLI Editing Keystrokes  
Task Category  
Action  
Keyboard Sequence  
Move the cursor.  
Move the cursor back one character.  
Move the cursor back one word.  
Move the cursor forward one character.  
Move the cursor forward one word.  
Ctrl-b  
Esc b  
Ctrl-f  
Esc f  
Move the cursor to the end of the command line.  
Delete the character before the cursor.  
Delete the character at the cursor.  
Ctrl-e  
Delete characters.  
Ctrl-h, Delete, or Backspace  
Ctrl-d  
Ctrl-k  
Delete all characters from the cursor to the end of  
the command line.  
Delete all characters on the command line.  
Delete the word before the cursor.  
Delete the word after the cursor.  
Ctrl-u or Ctrl-x  
Ctrl-w or Esc Backspace  
Esc d  
Ctrl-y  
Ctrl-l  
Insert recently deleted text.  
Redraw the screen.  
Insert the most recently deleted text at the cursor.  
Redraw the current line.  
Display previous command lines.  
Scroll backward through the list of recently executed Ctrl-p  
commands.  
Scroll forward through the list of recently executed  
commands.  
Ctrl-n  
Ctrl-r  
Esc /  
Search the CLI history in reverse order for lines  
matching the search string.  
Search the CLI history by typing some text at the  
prompt, followed by the keyboard sequence. The CLI  
attempts to expand the text into the most recent  
word in the history for which the text is a prefix.  
Repeat keyboard sequences.  
Specify the number of times to execute a keyboard  
sequence. Replace number with a number from 1  
through 9, and replace sequence with a keyboard  
sequence in this table.  
Esc number sequence  
Command Completion  
You do not always have to remember or type the full command or option name for  
the CLI to recognize it. To display all possible command or option completions, type  
the partial command followed immediately by a question mark (?).  
Using the Command-Line Interface  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
95  
     
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
To complete a command or option that you have partially typed, press Tab or  
Spacebar. If the partially typed letters uniquely identify a command, the complete  
command name appears. Otherwise, a message indicates that your entry is ambiguous  
or invalid. Possible command completions are displayed if your entry is ambiguous.  
You can also use command completion on filenames and usernames. To display all  
possible values, type one or more characters followed immediately by a question  
mark. To complete these partial entries, press Tab only. Pressing Spacebar does not  
work.  
Online Help  
The CLI provides context-sensitive help at every level of the command hierarchy.  
The help information tells you which commands are available at the current level in  
the hierarchy and provides a brief description of each.  
To get help while in the CLI, type a question mark (?) in one of the following ways:  
Type a question mark at the command-line prompt. The CLI lists the available  
Type a question mark after entering the complete name of a command or  
command option. The CLI lists the available commands and options, then  
redisplays the command names and options that you typed:  
user@host> request ?  
Possible completions:  
chassis  
ipsec  
message  
routing-engine  
security  
services  
Perform chassis-specific operations  
Perform IP Security operations  
Send text message to other users  
Log in to Routing Engine  
Perform security-level operations  
Perform service application operations  
Perform JUNOS support tasks  
support  
system  
Perform system-level operations  
user@host> request  
Type a question mark in the middle of a command name. The CLI lists possible  
command completions that match the letters you have entered so far, then  
redisplays the letters that you typed. For example, to list all operational mode  
commands that start with the letter s, type the following:  
user@host> s?  
Possible completions:  
set  
Set CLI properties, date/time, craft interface  
message  
show  
ssh  
Show system information  
Start secure shell on another host  
Start shell  
start  
user@host> s  
96  
Using the Command-Line Interface  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 4: Services Router User Interface Overview  
When you enter the help commands described in Table 51 on page 97, the CLI  
displays usage guidelines and summary information for configuration statements  
and operational mode commands. You can enter help commands in operational or  
configuration mode.  
Table 51: help Commands  
CLI Command  
Description  
Displays help based on a text string contained in a statement or command name.  
help apropos string  
If the string contains spaces, enclose it in quotation marks. You also can specify  
a regular expression for the string, using standard UNIX-style regular expression  
syntax.  
In configuration mode, this command displays statement names and help text  
that match the string specified.  
In operational mode, this command displays the following types of commands  
that match the string specified, plus help text:  
Operational mode commands  
help topic and help reference commands you can enter for more information  
For example, to get a list of statements that contain the string traps, enter the  
help apropos traps command in configuration mode.  
Displays summary information for configuration statements.  
help reference string  
help topic string  
For example, to display summary information for the OSPF hello interval, enter  
the command help reference ospf hello-interval.  
Displays usage guidelines for configuration statements.  
For example, to display usage guidelines for the OSPF hello interval, enter the  
command help topic ospf hello-interval.  
Configuring the CLI Environment  
You can configure the CLI environment for your current login session. Your settings  
are not retained when you exit the CLI.  
To display the current CLI settings, enter the show cli command:  
user@host> show cli  
CLI complete-on-space set to on  
CLI idle-timeout disabled  
CLI restart-on-upgrade set to on  
CLI screen-length set to 49  
CLI screen-width set to 132  
CLI terminal is 'vt100'  
CLI is operating in enhanced mode  
CLI working directory is '/cf/var/home/remote'  
To change the CLI environment, use the set cli operational mode command:  
Using the Command-Line Interface  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
97  
           
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
user@host> set cli ?  
Possible completions:  
complete-on-space  
directory  
Set whether typing space completes current word  
Set working directory  
idle-timeout  
prompt  
Set maximum idle time before login session ends  
Set CLI command prompt string  
restart-on-upgrade  
Set whether CLI prompts to restart after software upgrade  
screen-length  
screen-width  
terminal  
Set number of lines on screen  
Set number of characters on a line  
Set terminal type  
Table 52 on page 98 shows how you can change the CLI environment features.  
Table 52: Configuring the CLI Environment  
Environment  
Feature  
CLI Command  
Default Setting  
Options  
Command  
completion  
set cli  
complete-on-space  
(on | off)  
onPressing Tab or Spacebar  
completes a command.  
Set off to allow only Tab for  
command completion.  
Set on to re-enable Tab and  
Spacebar for command  
completion.  
Your working  
directory  
set cli directory path8 /cf/var/home/remote  
Replace path with the directory you want  
to enter when you log in to the Services  
Router.  
Minutes of idle time  
Your session never times out unless  
your login class specifies a timeout.  
To enable the timeout feature,  
replace timeout with a value  
between 1 and 100,000.  
set cli idle-time  
minutes  
To disable the timeout feature,  
replace timeout with 0.  
Your session prompt  
set cli prompt string  
user@host>  
Replace string with the prompt you  
want. If the prompt contains spaces or  
special characters, enclose string in  
quotation marks (“ “).  
Restart-after-upgrade  
prompt  
CLI prompts you to restart the  
Services Router after a software  
upgrade.  
set cli  
restart-on-upgrade  
(on | off)  
Set off to disable the prompt for the  
session.  
Set on to reenable the prompt.  
Number of CLI  
output line displayed  
at once  
Variable (depends on terminal type).  
To change the number of lines  
displayed on the screen, replace  
length with a value between 1 and  
100,000.  
set cli screen-length  
length  
To disable the display of a set  
number of lines, replace length  
with 0. (This feature can be useful  
when you are issuing CLI  
commands from scripts.)  
98  
Using the Command-Line Interface  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Chapter 4: Services Router User Interface Overview  
Table 52: Configuring the CLI Environment (continued)  
Environment  
Feature  
CLI Command  
Default Setting  
Options  
Number of CLI  
characters displayed  
on a line  
Variable (depends on terminal type). To change the number of characters  
displayed on a line, replace width with  
set cli screen-width  
width  
a value between 0 and 100,000.  
Your terminal type.  
set cli terminal  
unknown, or set by console.  
Replace terminal-type with one of the  
following values:  
terminal-type  
ansi  
vt100  
small-xterm  
xterm  
Using the Command-Line Interface  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
99  
   
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
100  
Using the Command-Line Interface  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Part 2  
Installing a Services Router  
Installing a Services Router  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
101  
 
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
102  
Installing a Services Router  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 5  
Preparing for Router Installation  
Before installing a J-series Services Router, make sure that your site has the proper  
operating environment and equipment. Use the checklist at the end of the chapter  
to help you prepare your site.  
This chapter discusses the following topics:  
General Site Guidelines  
The following precautions help you plan an acceptable operating environment for  
your Services Router and avoid environmentally caused equipment failures:  
For the cooling system to function properly, the airflow around the chassis must  
be unrestricted. Ensure that there is adequate circulation in the installation  
location. In J2320 and J2350 routers, allow at least 6 in. (15.2 cm) of clearance  
between the left and right sides of the chassis and adjacent equipment. In J4350  
and J6350 routers, allow at least 6 in. (15.2 cm) of clearance between the front  
and back of the chassis and adjacent equipment.  
Follow ESD procedures described in Preventing Electrostatic Discharge  
Damageon page 251, to avoid damaging equipment. Static discharge can cause  
components to fail completely or intermittently over time.  
Install blank PIM panels in empty slots, to prevent any interruption or reduction  
in the flow of air across internal components.  
General Site Guidelines  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
103  
         
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
Rack Requirements  
J-series Services Routers must be installed in a rack. Many types of racks are  
acceptable, including front-mount racks, four-post (telco) racks, and center-mount  
racks.  
The following sections describe rack requirements:  
Rack Size and Strength for J2320 and J2350 Routers  
The J2320 and j2350 Services Routers are designed for installation in a rack that  
complies with either of the following standards:  
A 19-in. rack as defined in Cabinets, Racks, Panels, and Associated Equipment  
(document number EIA-310-D) published by the Electronics Industry Association  
(http://www.eia.org)  
A 600-mm rack as defined in the four-part Equipment Engineering (EE); European  
telecommunications standard for equipment practice (document numbers ETS 300  
119-1 through 119-4) published by the European Telecommunications Standards  
Institute (http://www.etsi.org)  
The horizontal spacing between the rails in a rack that complies with this standard  
is usually wider than the router's mounting ears, which measure 19 in. (48.2 cm)  
from outer edge to outer edge. Use approved wing devices to narrow the opening  
between the rails as required.  
The rack rails must be spaced widely enough to accommodate the router chassis's  
external dimensions:  
J2320 chassis1.75 in. (4.45 cm) high, 17.51 in. (44.48 cm) wide, and 15.1 in.  
(38.35 cm) deep.  
J2350 chassis2.61 in. (6.63 cm) high, 17.51 in. (44.48 cm) wide, and 15.1 in.  
(38.35 cm) deep.  
The outer edges of the mounting ears extend the width of either chassis to 19 in.  
(48.2 cm), and the front of the chassis extends approximately 0.78 in. (1.98 cm)  
beyond the mounting ears. The spacing of rails and adjacent racks must also allow  
for the clearances around the router and rack. (See General Site  
CAUTION: If you are mounting the router in a cabinet, be sure that ventilation is  
sufficient to prevent overheating.  
If a front-mount rack is used, we recommend supporting the back of the router with  
a shelf or other structure.  
104  
Rack Requirements  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Chapter 5: Preparing for Router Installation  
The J2320 chassis height of 1.75 in. (4.45 cm) equals 1 U. The J2350 chassis height  
of 2.61 in. (6.63 cm) equals 1.5 U. Each U is a standard rack unit defined in Cabinets,  
Racks, Panels, and Associated Equipment (document number EIA-310-D) published  
by the Electronics Industry Association.  
Rack Size and Strength for J4350 and J6350 Routers  
The Services Router is designed for installation in a rack that complies with either  
of the following standards:  
A 19-in. rack as defined in Cabinets, Racks, Panels, and Associated Equipment  
(document number EIA-310-D) published by the Electronics Industry Association  
(http://www.eia.org)  
A 600-mm rack as defined in the four-part Equipment Engineering (EE); European  
telecommunications standard for equipment practice (document numbers ETS 300  
119-1 through 119-4) published by the European Telecommunications Standards  
Institute (http://www.etsi.org)  
The horizontal spacing between the rails in a rack that complies with this standard  
is usually wider than the router's mounting ears, which measure 19 in. (48.2 cm)  
from outer edge to outer edge. Use approved wing devices to narrow the opening  
between the rails as required.  
The rack rails must be spaced widely enough to accommodate the router chassis's  
external dimensions: 3.44 in. (8.74 cm) high, 17.44 in. (44.3 cm) wide, and 21.13  
in. (53.67 cm) deep.  
The outer edges of the mounting ears extend the width of either chassis to 19.44 in.  
(48.38 cm), and the front of the chassis extends approximately 0.5 in. (1.27 cm)  
beyond the mounting ears. The spacing of rails and adjacent racks must also allow  
for the clearances around the router and rack. (See General Site  
CAUTION: If you are mounting the router in a cabinet, be sure that ventilation is  
sufficient to prevent overheating.  
If a front-mount rack is used, we recommend supporting the back of the router with  
a shelf or other structure.  
The J4350, and J6350 chassis height of 3.44 in. (8.74 cm) equals 2 U. Each U is a  
standard rack unit defined in Cabinets, Racks, Panels, and Associated Equipment  
(document number EIA-310-D) published by the Electronics Industry Association.  
Connection to Building Structure  
Always secure the rack to the structure of the building. If your geographical area is  
subject to earthquakes, bolt the rack to the floor. For maximum stability, also secure  
Rack Requirements  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
105  
         
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
Router Environmental Tolerances  
Table 53 on page 106 specifies the environmental conditions required for normal  
Services Router operation. In addition, the site must be as dust-free as possible. Dust  
can clog air intake vents, reducing cooling system efficiency. Check vents frequently,  
cleaning them as necessary.  
Table 53: Router Environmental Tolerances  
Description  
Altitude  
Value  
No performance degradation to 10,000 ft (3048 m)  
Relative humidity  
Normal operation ensured in relative humidity range of 5% to  
90%, noncondensing  
Temperature  
Normal operation ensured in temperature range of 0°C (32°F) to  
40°C (104°F)  
Non-operating storage temperature in shipping carton:  
40°C (40°F) to 70°C (158°F)  
Seismic  
Designed to meet Telcordia Technologies Zone 4 earthquake  
requirements  
Maximum thermal output  
J2320 chassis: 1091 BTU/hour (320 W)  
J2350 chassis: 1195 BTU/hour (350 W)  
J4350 chassis: 1092 BTU/hour (320 W)  
J6350 chassis: 1126 BTU/hour (330 W)  
Fire Safety Requirements  
In the event of a fire emergency involving Services Routers and other network  
equipment, the safety of people is the primary concern. Establish procedures for  
protecting people in the event of a fire emergency, provide safety training, and  
properly provision fire-control equipment and fire extinguishers.  
In addition, establish procedures to protect your equipment in the event of a fire  
emergency. Juniper Networks products must be installed in an environment suitable  
for electronic equipment. We recommend that fire suppression equipment be available  
in the event of a fire in the vicinity of the equipment, and that all local fire, safety,  
and electrical codes and ordinances be observed when you are installing and operating  
your equipment.  
Fire Suppression  
In the event of an electrical hazard or an electrical fire, first unplug the power cord.  
106  
Router Environmental Tolerances  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                       
Chapter 5: Preparing for Router Installation  
Then, use a Type C fire extinguisher, which uses noncorrosive fire retardants, to  
extinguish the fire. For more information about fire extinguishers, see Fire  
Fire Suppression Equipment  
Type C fire extinguishers, which use noncorrosive fire retardants such as carbon  
dioxide (CO ) and Halotron, are most effective for suppressing electrical fires. Type  
2
C fire extinguishers displace the oxygen from the point of combustion to eliminate  
the fire. For extinguishing fire on or around equipment that draws air from the  
environment for cooling, use this type of inert oxygen displacement extinguisher  
instead of an extinguisher that leave residues on equipment.  
Do not use multipurpose Type ABC chemical fire extinguishers (dry chemical fire  
extinguishers) near Juniper Networks equipment. The primary ingredient in these  
fire extinguishers is monoammonium phosphate, which is very sticky and difficult  
to clean. In addition, in minute amounts of moisture, monoammonium phosphate  
can become highly corrosive and corrodes most metals.  
NOTE: To keep warranties effective, do not use a dry chemical fire extinguisher to  
control a fire at or near a Juniper Networks router. If a dry chemical fire extinguisher  
is used, the unit is no longer eligible for coverage under a service agreement.  
Any equipment in a room in which a chemical fire extinguisher has been discharged  
is subject to premature failure and unreliable operation. The equipment is considered  
to be irreparably damaged.  
We recommend that you dispose of any irreparably damaged equipment in an  
environmentally responsible manner.  
Power Guidelines, Requirements, and Specifications  
All Services Routers are available with AC power. J2350, J4350, and J6350 routers  
are also available with DC power. For information about each router's power system,  
For site wiring and power system guidelines, requirements, and specifications, see  
the following sections:  
Power Guidelines, Requirements, and Specifications  
107  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
Site Electrical Wiring Guidelines  
WARNING: Certain ports on the router are designed for use as intrabuilding  
(within-the-building) interfaces only (Type 2 or Type 4 ports as described in  
GR-1089-CORE, Issue 4) and require isolation from the exposed outside plant (OSP)  
cabling. To comply with NEBS requirements and protect against lightning surges and  
commercial power disturbances, the intrabuilding ports must not be metallically  
connected to interfaces that connect to the OSP or its wiring. The intrabuilding ports  
on the router are suitable for connection to intrabuilding or unexposed wiring or  
cabling only. The addition of primary protectors is not sufficient protection for  
connecting these interfaces metallically to OSP wiring.  
WARNING: DC-powered J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Routers are intended for  
installation only in a restricted access location.  
When planning the electrical wiring at your site, consider the factors discussed in  
the following sections.  
Signaling Limitations  
Improperly installed wires can emit radio interference. In addition, the potential for  
damage from lightning strikes increases if wires exceed recommended distances, or  
if wires pass between buildings. The electromagnetic pulse (EMP) caused by lightning  
can damage unshielded conductors and destroy electronic devices. If your site has  
previously experienced such problems, you might want to consult experts in electrical  
surge suppression and shielding.  
Radio Frequency Interference  
You can reduce or eliminate the emission of radio frequency interference (RFI) from  
your site wiring by using twisted-pair cable with a good distribution of grounding  
conductors. If you must exceed the recommended distances, use a high-quality  
twisted-pair cable with one ground conductor for each data signal when applicable.  
Electromagnetic Compatibility  
If your site is susceptible to problems with electromagnetic compatibility (EMC),  
particularly from lightning or radio transmitters, you might want to seek expert  
advice. Strong sources of electromagnetic interference (EMI) can destroy the signal  
drivers and receivers in the router and conduct power surges over the lines into the  
equipment, resulting in an electrical hazard. It is particularly important to provide a  
properly grounded and shielded environment and to use electrical surge-suppression  
devices.  
108  
Power Guidelines, Requirements, and Specifications  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                 
Chapter 5: Preparing for Router Installation  
CAUTION: To comply with intrabuilding lightning/surge requirements, intrabuilding  
wiring must be shielded, and the shield for the wiring must be grounded at both  
ends.  
Router Power Requirements  
Table 54 on page 109 and Table 55 on page 109 list the AC and DC power system  
electrical specifications for J-series Services Routers.  
Table 54: AC and DC Power System Electrical Specifications for J2320 and J2350 Routers  
Item  
Specification  
AC input voltage  
AC input line frequency  
AC system current rating  
100 to 240 VAC nominal  
50 to 60 Hz  
J2320 Services Routers: 3.2 A to 1.3 A  
J2350 Services Routers: 3.5 A to 1.5 A  
48 to 60 VDC operating range  
7.2 A  
DC input voltage  
DC system current rating  
Table 55: AC and DC Power System Electrical Specifications for J4350 and J6350 Routers  
Item  
Specification  
AC input voltage  
AC input line frequency  
AC system current rating  
100 to 240 VAC nominal  
50 to 60 Hz  
J4350 Services Routers: 6 A  
J6350 Services Routers: 8 A  
48 to 60 VDC operating range  
20 A  
DC input voltage  
DC system current rating  
AC Power, Connection, and Power Cord Specifications  
NOTE: The AC power cord for the Services Router is intended for use with the router  
only and not for any other use.  
Power Guidelines, Requirements, and Specifications  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
109  
           
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
Detachable AC power cords, each 2.5 m (approximately 8 ft) long, are supplied with  
the Services Router. The appliance coupler at the female end of the cord inserts into  
the appliance inlet on the faceplate of the AC power supply. The coupler is type C19  
as described by International Electrotechnical Commission (IEC) standard 60320.  
The plug at the male end of the power cord fits into the power source receptacle that  
is standard for your geographical location.  
NOTE: In North America, AC power cords must not exceed 4.5 m (approximately  
14.75 ft) in. length, to comply with National Electrical Code (NEC) Sections 400-8  
(NFPA 75, 5-2.2) and 210-52, and Canadian Electrical Code (CEC) Section 4-010(3).  
The cords supplied with the router are in compliance.  
Table 56 on page 110 lists AC power cord specifications provided for each country or  
region.  
Table 56: AC Power Cord Specifications  
Country  
Australia  
China  
Electrical Specifications  
250 VAC, 10 A, 50 Hz  
250 VAC, 10 A, 50 Hz  
250 VAC, 10 A, 50 Hz  
Plug Standards  
AS/NZ 31121993  
GB2099.1 1996 and GB1002 1996 (CH1-10P)  
CEE (7) VII  
Europe (except Italy and  
United Kingdom)  
Italy  
250 VAC, 10 A, 50 Hz  
CEI 2316/VII  
JIS 8303  
Japan  
125 VAC, 12 A, 50 Hz or 60 Hz  
125 VAC, 10 A, 60 Hz  
North America  
United Kingdom  
NEMA 5-15  
BS 1363A  
250 VAC, 10 A, 50 Hz  
Figure 54 on page 110 illustrates the plug on the power cord for each country or region  
listed in Table 56 on page 110.  
Figure 54: AC Plug Types  
NOTE: Power cords and cables must not block access to router components or drape  
where people might trip on them.  
110  
Power Guidelines, Requirements, and Specifications  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 5: Preparing for Router Installation  
For information about the AC power supply, see J2320 and J2350 Services Router  
To connect the power cord during initial installation, see Connecting  
DC Power, Connection, and Power Cable Specifications  
Each DC power supply has a single DC input (48 VDC and return) that requires a  
dedicated circuit breaker:  
J2350 routersminimum 15 A (48 VDC)  
J4350 and J6350 routersminimum 25 A (48 VDC)  
If the J6350 router contains redundant DC power supplies, one power supply must  
be powered by a dedicated power feed derived from feed A, and the other power  
supply must be powered by a dedicated power feed derived from feed B. This  
configuration provides the commonly deployed A/B feed redundancy for the system.  
Most sites distribute DC power through a main conduit that leads to frame-mounted  
DC power distribution panels, one of which might be located at the top of the rack  
that houses the router. A pair of cables (one input and one return) connects each set  
of terminal studs to the power distribution panel.  
CAUTION: You must ensure that power connections maintain the proper polarity.  
The power source cables might be labeled (+) and () to indicate their polarity. There  
is no standard color coding for DC power cables. The color coding used by the external  
DC power source at your site determines the color coding for the leads on the power  
cables that attach to the terminal studs on each power supply.  
WARNING: Power plant ground and chassis ground must be connected to the same  
building ground.  
CAUTION: Before router installation begins, a licensed electrician must attach a cable  
lug to the grounding and power cables that you supply. A cable with an incorrectly  
attached lug can damage the router.  
Each DC power cable (48 VDC and return) must be 14 AWG single-strand wire cable,  
or as permitted by the local code. Each lug attached to the power cables must be a  
ring-type, vinyl-insulated TV14-6R lug, or equivalent.  
Power Guidelines, Requirements, and Specifications  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
111  
     
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
NOTE: Power cords and cables must not block access to router components or drape  
where people might trip on them.  
For information about the DC power supply, see J2320 and J2350 Services Router  
To connect the DC power cable during initial installation, see Connecting DC  
Planning for Power Management  
Before you install a chassis or add a new PIM to an existing chassis, verify that the  
combination of PIMs to be installed does not exceed the power and heat capacities  
for that model. Add the low-power tokens, high-power tokens, and heat tokens  
required by each PIM, and compare them to the capacity of the chassis.  
NOTE: The low power and high power correspond to a specific voltage for that PIM.  
CAUTION: Do not install a combination of PIMs in a single chassis that exceeds the  
maximum power and heat capacity of the chassis. If J-series power management is  
enabled, PIMs that exceed the maximum power and heat capacity remain offline  
when the chassis is powered on.  
To verify that the combination of PIMs to be installed in a chassis does not exceed  
the power and heat capacities for that model:  
1. Check Table 57 on page 113 to determine the token values for low-power,  
high-power, and heat for each PIM that you plan to install in the chassis.  
2. For all PIMs to be installed in the chassis:  
a. Add the low-power tokens for all PIMs to be installed in the chassis.  
b. Add the high-power tokens for all PIMs to be installed in the chassis.  
c. Add the heat dissipation tokens for all PIMs to be installed in the chassis.  
3. Verify that the total number of low-power tokens, total number of high-power  
tokens, and the total number of heat dissipation tokens do not exceed the  
Table 57 on page 113 shows the low-power consumption, high-power consumption,  
and heat dissipation, represented in non-dimensional tokens, assigned to each J-series  
PIM and TIM.  
112  
Power Guidelines, Requirements, and Specifications  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 5: Preparing for Router Installation  
Table 57: J-series PIM Power Consumption and Heat Dissipation  
Name  
Model Number  
JXU-SFP-S  
PIM Abbreviation  
in JUNOS CLI  
Tokens  
Low Power  
High Power  
Heat  
1-Port Gigabit  
Ethernet uPIM  
8
8
1xSFP uPIM  
6xSFP uPIM  
8xGE uPIM  
6-Port Gigabit  
Ethernet uPIM  
JXU-6GE-SFP-S  
JXU-8GE-TX-S  
JXU-16GE-TX-S  
JXE-1GE-TX-S  
13  
21  
38  
6
13  
27  
36  
7
8-Port Gigabit  
Ethernet uPIM  
16-Port Gigabit  
Ethernet uPIM  
16xGE uPIM  
1xGE Copper  
1-Port Copper  
Gigabit Ethernet  
ePIM  
1-Port SFP Gigabit JXE-1GE-SFP-S  
Ethernet ePIM  
4
5
4
6
1xGE SFP  
2xSerial  
Dual-Port Serial  
PIM  
JX-2Serial-S  
Dual-Port E1 PIM  
Dual-Port T1 PIM  
JX-2E1-RJ48-S  
JX-2T1-RJ48-S  
JX-2CT1E1-RJ45-S  
6
6
5
6
5
5
2xE1  
2xT1  
Dual-Port  
2xCT1E1 / PRI  
Channelized  
T1/E1/ISDN PRI  
PIM  
E3 PIM (1 port)  
JX-1E3-S  
7
7
7
7
1xE3  
1xT3  
T3 PIM (also  
JX-1DS3-S  
known as DS3)  
Dual-Port Fast  
Ethernet PIM  
JX-2FE-TX-S  
JXE-4FE-TX-S  
JX-4BRI-S-S  
6
1
2
6
2xFE  
4-Port Fast  
Ethernet ePIM  
9
9
4xFE ePIM  
4x BRI S/T  
4x BRI U  
4-Port ISDN BRI  
S/T PIM  
4
4
4-Port ISDN BRI U JX-4BRI-U-S  
PIM  
4
6
ADSL 2/2+  
JX-1ADSL-A-S  
16  
16  
1x ADSL Annex A  
Annex A PIM  
(1 port, for POTS)  
Power Guidelines, Requirements, and Specifications  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
113  
 
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
Table 57: J-series PIM Power Consumption and Heat Dissipation (continued)  
Name  
Model Number  
PIM Abbreviation  
in JUNOS CLI  
Tokens  
Low Power  
16  
High Power  
Heat  
ADSL 2/2+  
JX-1ADSL-B-S  
2
16  
1x ADSL Annex B  
Annex B PIM  
(1 port, for ISDN)  
G.SHDSL PIM  
JX-2SHDSL-S  
Avaya  
9
10  
18  
2x SHDSL (ATM)  
(2-port two-wire  
mode or 1-port  
four-wire mode)  
TGM550  
13  
7
1x TGM550  
Telephony  
Gateway Module  
TIM508 Telephony Avaya  
Interface Module  
4
6
25  
17  
5
8x FXS TIM508  
1x DS1 TIM510  
TIM510 E1/T1  
Telephony  
Avaya  
Avaya  
Avaya  
Avaya  
Avaya  
Interface Module  
TIM514 Analog  
Telephony  
4
6
6
2
13  
19  
25  
12  
22  
20  
2
4x FXS, 4xFXO  
TIM514  
Interface Module  
TIM516 Analog  
Telephony  
16x FXS TIM516  
Interface Module  
TIM518 Analog  
Telephony  
8x FXS, 8xFXO  
TIM518  
Interface Module  
TIM521 BRI  
4x BRI TIM521  
Telephony  
Interface Module  
Table 58 on page 114 lists the maximum power tokens and maximum heat tokens  
available for each model.  
Table 58: Maximum Power and Heat Capacities of J-series Models  
Model  
Low- Power Capacity  
(tokens)  
High- Power Capacity  
(tokens)  
Heat Capacity (tokens)  
J2320  
J2350  
J4350  
J6350  
50  
50  
68  
84  
84  
84  
100  
100  
100  
100  
100  
100  
114  
Power Guidelines, Requirements, and Specifications  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 5: Preparing for Router Installation  
Network Cable Specifications  
The Services Router supports interfaces that use various kinds of network cable. For  
information about the type of cable used by each interface, see Network Cable  
ISDN Provisioning  
You might need a network termination type 1 (NT1) device to connect your ISDN  
interface to the ISDN service. Contact your service provider for details on the following  
information:  
External NT1 device and ISDN cable  
If the two items are required, where to obtain the items  
List of NT1 vendors  
Site Preparation Checklist  
The checklist in Table 59 on page 115 summarizes the tasks you need to perform  
when preparing a site for Services Router installation.  
Table 59: Site Preparation Checklist  
Item or Task  
Performed By  
Date  
Notes  
Verify that environmental factors such as  
temperature and humidity do not exceed router  
tolerances.  
Measure the distances between external power  
sources and the router installation site.  
Select the type of rack.  
Plan the rack location, including required space  
clearances.  
Secure the rack to the floor and the building  
structure.  
Acquire appropriate cables and connectors.  
Network Cable Specifications  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
115  
           
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
116  
Site Preparation Checklist  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 6  
Installing and Connecting a Services  
Router  
Make the appropriate preparations and verify the J-series equipment before installing  
a J-series Services Router and connecting it to a power source and the network.  
CAUTION: Do not install a combination of PIMs in a single chassis that exceeds the  
maximum power and heat capacity of the chassis. If J-series power management is  
enabled, PIMs that exceed the maximum power and heat capacity remain offline  
when the chassis is powered on.  
This chapter contains the following topics:  
Before You Begin  
Before you begin installation, complete the following tasks:  
Warningson page 275, with particular attention to Chassis Lifting  
Determine where to install the Services Router, and verify that the rack or  
installation site meets the requirements described in Preparing for Router  
For installation, gather the following equipment and tools:  
For J2320 and J2350 Services RoutersNumber 2 Phillips screwdriver, and  
mounting screws appropriate for your rack.  
Before You Begin  
117  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
For J4350 and J6350 Services RoutersMounting brackets and screws  
(provided), number 2 Phillips screwdriver, and mounting screws appropriate  
for your rack.  
To connect the router to power and ground, have ready a grounding cable and  
lug, as specified in Chassis Groundingon page 123, and the power cords or  
cords shipped with the router. (You must supply your own power cables if you  
have a DC-powered router. See DC Power, Connection, and Power Cable  
NOTE: The AC power cord for the Services Router is intended for use with the router  
only and not for any other use.  
To connect network interfaces, have ready a length of cable used by the interface,  
If your router has ISDN ports, you might need an NT1 device to connect to the  
ISDN service. For details, see ISDN Provisioningon page 115.  
Unpacking a J-series Services Router  
The Services Router is shipped in a cardboard carton and secured with foam packing  
material. The carton also contains an accessory box and quick start instructions.  
NOTE: The router is maximally protected inside the shipping carton. Do not unpack  
it until you are ready to begin installation.  
To unpack the router:  
1. Move the shipping carton to a staging area as close to the installation site as  
possible, but where you have enough room to remove the router.  
2. Position the carton so that the arrows are pointing up.  
3. Open the top flaps on the shipping carton.  
4. Remove the accessory box, and verify the contents against the parts inventory  
on the label attached to the carton.  
5. Pull out the packing material holding the router in place.  
6. Verify the contents of the carton against the packing list included with the router.  
7. Save the shipping carton and packing materials in case you later need to move  
or ship the router.  
118  
Unpacking a J-series Services Router  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 6: Installing and Connecting a Services Router  
Installing J2320 and J2350 Routers  
WARNING: DC-powered Services Routers are intended for installation only in a  
restricted access location.  
You can center-mount or front-mount the J2320 and J2350 Services Routers in a  
rack. In general, a center-mount rack is preferable to a front-mount rack because the  
more even distribution of weight in the center-mount rack provides greater stability.  
Many types of racks are acceptable, including four-post (telco) racks, enclosed  
cabinets, and open-frame racks. For more information about the type of rack or  
WARNING: If you are installing multiple routers in one rack, install the lowest one  
first and proceed upward in the rack. Install heavier routers in the lower part of the  
rack. The router must be mounted at the bottom of the rack if it is the only unit in  
the rack.  
WARNING: The J2320 or J2350 chassis weighs between 14.8 lb (6.7 kg) and 18.2 lb  
(8.3 kg). Read and follow the lifting guidelines in Chassis Lifting  
To install the J2320 or J2350 router into a rack:  
1. If necessary, reposition the mounting brackets. You can position the brackets in  
either the center or the front. Positioning the brackets in the center offers greater  
stability.  
J2320 and J2350 Services Routers come with mounting brackets installed on  
them (see Figure 55 on page 119).  
Figure 55: Mounting Brackets on J2320 and J2350 Routers  
2. Have one person grasp the sides of the router, lift the router, and position it in  
the rack.  
Installing J2320 and J2350 Routers  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
119  
           
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
3. Align the top hole in each mounting bracket with a hole in each rack rail as shown  
in Figure 56 on page 120 and Figure 57 on page 120, making sure the chassis is  
level.  
Figure 56: Hanging a J2320 Router in a Rack  
Figure 57: Hanging a J2350 Router in a Rack  
4. Have a second person install a mounting screw into each of the two aligned  
holes. With a number 2 Phillips screwdriver, tighten the screws.  
5. Verify that the mounting screw on one side of the rack is aligned with the  
mounting screw on the opposite side and that the router is level.  
6. Install the second screw in each mounting bracket.  
Installing J4350 and J6350 Routers  
WARNING: DC-powered Services Routers are intended for installation only in a  
restricted access location.  
120  
Installing J4350 and J6350 Routers  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Chapter 6: Installing and Connecting a Services Router  
You can center-mount or front-mount the J4350 and J6350 Services Routers in a  
rack. In general, a center-mount rack is preferable to a front-mount rack because the  
more even distribution of weight in the center-mount rack provides greater stability.  
Many types of racks are acceptable, including four-post (telco) racks, enclosed  
cabinets, and open-frame racks. For more information about the type of rack or  
WARNING: If you are installing multiple routers in one rack, install the lowest one  
first and proceed upward in the rack. Install heavier routers in the lower part of the  
rack. The router must be mounted at the bottom of the rack if it is the only unit in  
the rack.  
WARNING: The chassis weighs between 23 lb (10.4 kg) and 30.7 lb (13.9 kg). Read  
and follow the lifting guidelines in Chassis Lifting Guidelineson page 266.  
To install the J4350 and J6350 router into a rack:  
1. Attach the mounting brackets to the sides of the chassis (see  
Figure 58 on page 121). You can position the brackets either in the center or the  
front. Positioning the brackets in the center offers greater stability.  
Figure 58: Installing the Mounting Brackets  
2. Attach a screw to each rack rail in the third hole down from where you want the  
top of the router to be positioned. Screw only part way in, leaving about ¼ in.  
Installing J4350 and J6350 Routers  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
121  
     
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
Figure 59: Attaching Center Screw to the Rack  
3. Lift the router and insert the larger elliptical openings in the mounting brackets  
onto the partially inserted screws so that the router is hanging from the two  
screws (see Figure 60 on page 122).  
Figure 60: Hanging the Router in the Rack  
4. Verify that the mounting screws on one side of the rack are aligned with the  
mounting screws on the opposite side and that the router is level.  
5. Install at least two mounting screws into each mounting bracket, in addition to  
a number 2 Phillips screwdriver to tighten the screws.  
122  
Installing J4350 and J6350 Routers  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 6: Installing and Connecting a Services Router  
Figure 61: Completing the Installation  
Connecting Interface Cables to Services Routers  
You connect the interfaces installed in the Services Router to various network media.  
For more information about the network interfaces supported on the router, see the  
J-series Services Router Basic LAN and WAN Access Configuration Guide.  
1. Have ready a length of the type of cable used by the interface, as specified in  
2. Insert the cable connector into the cable connector port on the interface faceplate.  
3. Arrange the cable as follows to prevent it from dislodging or developing stress  
points:  
a. Secure the cable so that it is not supporting its own weight as it hangs to the  
floor.  
b. Place excess cable out of the way in a neatly coiled loop.  
c. Place fasteners on the loop to help maintain its shape.  
Chassis Grounding  
To meet safety and electromagnetic interference (EMI) requirements and to ensure  
proper operation, the Services Router must be adequately grounded before power  
is connected. In addition to the grounding pin on the AC power plug cord, a threaded  
insert (PEM nut), screw, and washer are provided on the rear of the chassis to connect  
the router to earth ground.  
CAUTION: Before router installation begins, a licensed electrician must attach a cable  
lug to the grounding and power cables that you supply. A cable with an incorrectly  
attached lug can damage the router (for example, by causing a short circuit).  
Connecting Interface Cables to Services Routers  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
123  
           
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
For J2320 and J2350 Services RoutersThe grounding cables must be, at  
minimum, 14 AWG single-strand wire cable. The grounding lug must be a  
ring-type, vinyl-insulated TV14-8R lug as shown in Figure 62 on page 125 and  
For J4350 and J6350 Services RoutersThe grounding cables must be, at  
minimum, 12 AWG single-strand wire cable. The grounding lug must be a  
two-hole lug as shown in Figure 64 on page 126.  
To ground the router before connecting power, you connect the grounding cable to  
earth ground and then attach the lug on the cable to the chassis grounding point,  
with the screw. (See Connecting Poweron page 124.)  
Connecting Power  
J2320, J2350 and J4350 Services Routers have a single fixed power supply. J6350  
Services Routers have one or two field-replaceable power supplies. For more  
information about the J-series power specifications, see Power Guidelines,  
WARNING: DC-powered Services Routers are intended for installation only in a  
restricted access location.  
Connecting AC Power  
The router must be connected to earth ground during normal operation. The protective  
earthing terminal on the rear of the chassis is provided to connect the router to  
ground. Additional grounding is provided to an AC-powered router when you plug  
its power supply into a grounded AC power receptacle.  
The AC power cord shipped with the router connects the router to earth ground when  
plugged into an AC grounding-type power outlet. The router must be connected to  
earth ground during normal operation.  
For power cord requirements, see AC Power, Connection, and Power Cord  
To connect AC power to the router:  
1. Attach an electrostatic discharge (ESD) grounding strap to your bare wrist, and  
connect the strap to the ESD point on the chassis. For more information about  
2. Use a grounding cable to connect the router to earth ground: (For cable  
a. Verify that a licensed electrician has attached an appropriate grounding cable  
lug to the grounding cable.  
b. Connect one end of the grounding cable to a proper earth ground, such as  
the rack in which the router is installed.  
124  
Connecting Power  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Chapter 6: Installing and Connecting a Services Router  
c. With a Phillips screwdriver, remove the screw and washer from the PEM  
nuts at the grounding point on the rear of the chassis.  
d. Place the grounding lug at the other end of the cable over the grounding  
point, as shown in Figure 62 on page 125 through Figure 64 on page 126.  
e. Secure the cable lug to the grounding point, first with the washer, then with  
the screw. On J2320 and J2350 routers, use the screw containing a captive  
washer to secure the cable lug to the grounding point.  
3. Locate the power cord or cords shipped with the router, which has a plug  
appropriate for your geographical location. For power cord specifications, see  
4. For the power supply:  
a. Insert the appliance coupler end of a power cord into the appliance inlet on  
the power supply faceplate, as shown in Figure 62 on page 125 through  
b. Insert the plug into an AC power source receptacle.  
5. Verify that the power cord does not block access to router components or drape  
where people can trip on it.  
6. On J2320 and J2350 routers, use the power cable tie as follows to relieve strain  
a. Wrap the loose end of the tie around the cable, and insert it into the opening  
on the tie.  
b. Pull the end to tighten the tie.  
To release the tie from the cable, press down the tab on the tie and loosen it.  
Figure 62: Connecting AC Power to the J2320 Services Router  
Connecting Power  
125  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
Figure 63: Connecting AC Power to the J2350 Services Router  
Figure 64: Connecting AC Power to the J4350 or J6350 Services Router  
Connecting DC Power  
CAUTION: If your J6350 Services Router includes an optional redundant DC power  
supply, connect each of the two power supplies to different input power sources.  
Failure to do so makes the router susceptible to total power failure if one of the power  
supplies fails.  
The router must be connected to earth ground during normal operation. The protective  
earthing terminal on the rear of the chassis is provided to connect the router to  
ground.  
For DC cable requirements, see DC Power, Connection, and Power Cable  
To connect DC power to the router:  
126  
Connecting Power  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Chapter 6: Installing and Connecting a Services Router  
1. Attach an electrostatic discharge (ESD) grounding strap to your bare wrist, and  
connect the strap to the ESD point on the chassis. For more information about  
2. Use a grounding cable to connect the router to earth ground: (For cable  
a. Verify that a licensed electrician has attached an appropriate grounding cable  
lug to the grounding cable.  
b. Connect one end of the grounding cable to a proper earth ground, such as  
the rack in which the router is installed.  
c. With a Phillips screwdriver, remove the screw and washer from the PEM  
nut at the grounding point on the rear of the chassis.  
d. Place the grounding lug at the other end of the cable over the grounding  
e. Secure the cable lug to the grounding point, first with the washer, then with  
the screw. On J2320 and J2350 routers, use the screw containing a captive  
washer to secure the cable lug to the grounding point.  
NOTE: A DC power supply in a Services Router becomes grounded when you connect  
a grounding cable between the router and earth ground.  
3. For each power supply:  
a. Ensure that the voltage across the DC power source cable leads is 0 V and  
that the cable leads cannot become active in any way during installation.  
CAUTION: You must ensure that power connections maintain the proper polarity.  
The power source cables might be labeled (+) and () to indicate their polarity. There  
is no standard color coding for DC power cables. The color coding used by the external  
DC power source at your site determines the color coding for the leads on the power  
cables that attach to the terminal studs on each power supply.  
b. Verify that a licensed electrician has attached the appropriate power cable  
lugs to the negative and positive DC source power cables.  
c. Use a Phillips screwdriver to remove the clear plastic cover protecting the  
terminal block.  
d. Within the terminal block, remove the two center screws next to the labels  
48 VDC and RTN.  
Each screw contains a captive washer to secure a DC source power cable  
lug to the terminal block.  
e. Using one of the removed screws, secure the positive (+) DC source power  
cable lug to the RTN terminal. Tighten the screw until snug. Do not  
Connecting Power  
127  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
overtighten. Apply between 8 lb-in. (0.9 Nm) and 9 lb-in. (1.02 Nm) of torque  
to the screw.  
f. Using the other removed screw, secure the negative () DC source power  
cable lug to the 48 VDC terminal. Tighten the screw until snug. Do not  
overtighten. Apply between 8 lb-in. (0.9 Nm) and 9 lb-in. (1.02 Nm) of torque  
to the screw.  
g. Dress the power cables appropriately.  
h. Replace the clear plastic cover over the terminal block.  
4. Verify that the power cables do not block access to router components or drape  
where people can trip on them.  
5. On J2320 and J2350 routers, use the power cable tie as follows to relieve strain  
on the cable (see Figure 65 on page 128 ):  
a. Wrap the loose end of the tie around the cable, and insert it into the opening  
on the tie.  
b. Pull the end to tighten the tie.  
To release the tie from the cable, press down the tab on the tie and loosen it.  
Figure 65: Connecting DC Power to the J2350 Services Router  
128  
Connecting Power  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 6: Installing and Connecting a Services Router  
Figure 66: Connecting DC Power to the J4350 or J6350 Services Router  
Powering a Services Router On and Off  
To power on a Services Router, press the power button. The Routing Engine boots  
as the power supply completes its startup sequence. The POWER LED lights during  
startup and remains on steadily when the router is operating normally.  
To power off a Services Router, you can shut it down in one of the following ways:  
Graceful shutdownPress and release the power button. The router begins  
gracefully shutting down the operating system and then powers itself off.  
Immediate shutdownPress the power button and hold it for more than  
5 seconds. The router immediately powers itself off without shutting down the  
operating system.  
To remove power completely from the router, unplug the AC power cord or switch  
off the DC power source. The power button on the Services Router is a standby power  
switch. If the router is connected to a power source when you press the power button  
to power the router off, the router remains in standby mode and a small amount  
(5 V and 3.3 V) of standby voltage is still available in the chassis.  
Powering a Services Router On and Off  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
129  
           
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
130  
Powering a Services Router On and Off  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 7  
Establishing Basic Connectivity  
The JUNOS software is preinstalled on the Services Router. When the router is  
powered on, it is ready to be configured. If the router does not have a configuration  
from the factory or your service provider, you must configure the software to establish  
basic connectivity.  
If you are setting up a Services Router for the first time, you can use either J-Web  
Quick Configuration or a configuration editor to configure basic connectivity. For a  
brief explanation of J-Web Quick Configuration and the J-Web and CLI configuration  
If you are setting up many Services Routers, autoinstallation can help automate the  
configuration process. For more information about autoinstallation, see the J-series  
Services Router Administration Guide.  
This chapter contains the following topics. For more information about basic  
connectivity, see the JUNOS System Basics Configuration Guide.  
Basic Connectivity Terms  
Before configuring basic connectivity, become familiar with the terms defined in  
Table 60: Basic Connectivity Terms  
Term  
Definition  
domain name  
Name that identifies the network or subnetwork of a router.  
Protocol for assigning dynamic IP addresses to devices on a network.  
Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol (DHCP)  
Basic Connectivity Terms  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
131  
         
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
Table 60: Basic Connectivity Terms (continued)  
Term  
Definition  
gateway  
Packets destined for IP addresses not identified in the routing table are  
sent to the default gateway.  
hostname  
Unique name that identifies a router on the network.  
loopback address  
IP address of a Services Router on logical interface lo0.0 that is always  
active and available to external hosts and as the source address for  
outgoing packets.  
Network Time Protocol (NTP)  
root user  
Protocol that provides a reliable way of synchronizing the system time  
of a router.  
A superuser or system administrator who can perform any task in the  
file system.  
secure shell (SSH)  
Telnet  
Protocol that provides a secured method of logging in to a remote  
network system.  
Software that allows a computer to act as a remote terminal on a  
network system.  
Basic Connectivity Overview  
To connect your Services Router to the network and establish basic connectivity,  
you enter information about your network. This overview contains the following  
topics:  
Router Identification  
The domain name defines the network or subnetwork that the Services Router belongs  
to. The hostname refers to the specific machine, while the domain name is shared  
among all the devices in a given network. Together the hostname and domain name  
identify the router in the network.  
132  
Basic Connectivity Overview  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 7: Establishing Basic Connectivity  
Root Password  
The root user has complete privileges to configure the Services Router, and manage  
files in the router's file system. Initially, the root password is not defined on the  
router. To ensure basic security, you must define the root password during initial  
configuration. If a root password is not defined, you cannot commit configuration  
settings to take effect on the router.  
If you use a plain-text password, the router displays the password as an encrypted  
string so that users viewing the configuration cannot easily see the password.  
The root password must meet the following conditions:  
The password must be at least 6 characters long.  
You can include most character classes in a password (alphabetic, numeric, and  
special characters), except control characters.  
Valid passwords must contain at least one change of case or character class.  
For Common Criteria environments only, the password must be between 10 and  
20 characters long and must include at least three of the five character classes  
(uppercase letters, lowercase letters, punctuation marks, numbers, and other special  
characters). Control characters are not recommended. For more information, see  
the Secure Configuration Guide for Common Criteria and JUNOS-FIPS.  
Time Zone and System Time  
You define the time zone for the location where you plan to operate the Services  
Router by using a designation that consists of the following information for the  
location:  
Name of the continent or oceanFor example, America or Atlantic  
Name of the major city or other geographic feature in the time zoneFor  
example, Detroit or Azores  
A Network Time Protocol (NTP) server provides accurate time across a network. The  
router synchronizes the system time with the NTP server, and periodically accesses  
the NTP server to maintain the correct time.  
The time zone and system time must be accurate so that the router schedules events  
and operations as expected.  
For Common Criteria compliance, you must configure NTP to provide accurate  
timestamps for system log messages. For more information, see the Secure  
Configuration Guide for Common Criteria and JUNOS-FIPS.  
Network Settings  
A Domain Name System (DNS) server on the network maintains a database for  
resolving hostnames and IP addresses. Network devices can query the DNS server  
by hostnames rather than IP addresses. The router accesses the DNS servers that  
Basic Connectivity Overview  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
133  
                 
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
are added to the configuration to resolve hostnames in the order in which you list  
them.  
If you plan to include your router in several domains, you can add these domains to  
the configuration so that they are included in a DNS search. When DNS searches are  
requested, the domain suffixes are appended to the hostnames.  
Default Gateway  
Backup Router  
A default gateway is a static route that is used to direct packets addressed to networks  
not explicitly listed in the routing table. If a packet arrives at the Services Router with  
an address that the router does not have routing information for, the router sends  
the packet to the default gateway. The default gateway entry is always present in  
the routing and forwarding tables.  
You can specify a backup router to take over when the routing protocol process of  
the Services Router is not running, usually when the Services Router is booting, or  
if its routing protocol process has failed. Packets arriving at a Services Router in this  
situation are routed to the backup router. When the routing protocol process starts  
up again, the address of the backup router is removed from the routing and forwarding  
tables of the Services Router. The backup router must be located on the same subnet.  
NOTE: To configure a backup router, you must use the CLI or J-Web configuration  
editor. You cannot configure a backup router with J-Web Quick Configuration.  
Loopback Address  
The loopback address is the IP address of the Services Router. The loopback address  
ensures that the router provides an IP address to management applications. Because  
it must always be available to hosts attempting to route packets to the router, the  
loopback address resides on an interface that is always active, known as the loopback  
interface (lo0.0). Setting a loopback address ensures that the router can receive  
packets addressed to the loopback address as long as the router is reachable though  
any entry (ingress) interface. In addition, applications such as NTP, RADIUS, and  
TACACS+ can use the loopback address as the source address for outgoing packets.  
If you use the J-Web Set Up Quick Configuration page, you can either set a loopback  
address of your choice or have the loopback address automatically set to 127.0.0.1  
when you click Apply or OK to commit the configuration.  
Built-In Ethernet Interface Address  
The built-in Gigabit Ethernet interfaces, ge-0/0/0 through ge-0/0/3, on the front  
panel of the Services Router, are the interfaces through which you perform initial  
router setup. The examples in this guide use the ge-0/0/0 interface as the  
management interface, but you can use any built-in Ethernet port for management.  
134  
Basic Connectivity Overview  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
               
Chapter 7: Establishing Basic Connectivity  
After the initial configuration is complete, you can attach the built-in Ethernet port  
that you are using for management purposes to the management network.  
Before initial configuration, when the factory default configuration is active, the router  
attempts to perform autoinstallation by obtaining a router configuration through all  
its connected interfaces, including ge-0/0/0. The Services Router acts as a DHCP  
client out the built-in Ethernet interfaces.  
If the Services Router does not find a DHCP server within a few seconds, it sets the  
address of ge-0/0/0 to 192.168.1.1/24 and becomes a DHCP server out the ge-0/0/0  
interface.  
NOTE: If the ge-0/0/1 interface is being used, it is set to 192.168.2.1/24.  
With the router temporarily acting as a DHCP server, you can manually configure it  
with the J-Web interface. Any DHCP client host, for example, a PC or laptop computer,  
directly connected to ge-0/0/0 receives an address on the 192.168.1.1/24 network.  
NOTE: The DHCP functionality for initial setup is different from the configurable  
DHCP server functionality of the Services Router during operation. To configure the  
Services Router as a DHCP server, see the J-series Services Router Administration  
Guide.  
Once you connect your laptop or PC to ge-0/0/0, you can use a Web browser to visit  
the address 192.168.1.1/24, access the J-Web Set Up Quick Configuration page, and  
complete the initial configuration of the router.  
After you perform the initial configuration and commit it by clicking Apply or OK  
on the Set Up page, the configured router can no longer act as a DHCP server.  
Therefore, in order to continue using it as a management interface you should  
configure the IP address of the interface as part of the initial configuration.  
Management Access  
Telnet allows you to connect to the Services Router and access the CLI to execute  
commands from a remote system. Telnet connections are not encrypted and therefore  
can be intercepted.  
Telnet access to the root user is prohibited. You must use more secure methods,  
such as SSH, to log in as root.  
If you are using a JUNOScript server to configure and monitor routers, you can activate  
clear-text access on the router to allow unencrypted text to be sent directly over a  
TCP connection without using any additional protocol (such as SSH, SSL, or Telnet).  
Information sent in clear text is not encrypted and therefore can be intercepted. For  
more information about the JUNOScript application programming interface (API),  
see the JUNOScript API Guide.  
Basic Connectivity Overview  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
135  
       
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
If the router is operating in a Common Criteria environment, see the Secure  
Configuration Guide for Common Criteria and JUNOS-FIPS.  
SSH also allows you to connect to the router and access the CLI to execute commands  
from a remote system. However, unlike Telnet, SSH encrypts traffic so that it cannot  
be intercepted.  
SSH can be configured so that connections are authenticated by a digital certificate.  
SSH uses public-private key technology for both connection and authentication. The  
SSH client software must be installed on the machine where the client application  
runs. If the SSH private key is encrypted (for greater security), the SSH client must  
be able to access the passphrase used to decrypt the key.  
For information about obtaining SSH software, see http://www.ssh.com and  
Before You Begin  
Before you begin initial configuration, complete the following tasks:  
Install the Services Router in its permanent location, as described in Installing  
Gather the following information:  
Hostname for the router on the network  
Domain that the router belongs to on the network  
Password for the root user  
Time zone where the router is located  
IP address of an NTP server (if NTP is used to set the time on the router)  
IP address of a DNS server  
List of domains that can be appended to hostnames for DNS resolution  
IP address of the default gateway  
IP address to be used for the loopback interface  
IP address of the built-in Ethernet interface that you will use for management  
purposes. The examples in this guide use the ge-0/0/0 interface.  
If you are performing the initial configuration with the J-Web interface, collect  
the following equipment:  
A management device, such as a laptop, with an Ethernet port  
An Ethernet cable (provided)  
If you are performing the initial configuration with the CLI, collect the following  
equipment:  
136  
Before You Begin  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 7: Establishing Basic Connectivity  
A management device, such as a PC or laptop, with a serial port and an  
asynchronous terminal application (such as Microsoft Windows  
Hyperterminal)  
An RJ-45 to DB-9 serial port adapter (provided)  
An Ethernet cable (provided)  
For a remote connection, two dial-up modems  
For a remote modem connection, a DB-9 female to DB-25 male adapter, or  
other adapter appropriate for your modem (not provided)  
Connecting to a Services Router  
You can connect to the Services Router using the J-Web or CLI interface.  
This section contains the following topics:  
Connecting to the J-Web Interface  
If you plan to use the J-Web interface to configure the Services Router, you must  
connect through one of the built-in Ethernet management ports, as shown in  
When the Services Router is powered on for the first time, the system looks for a  
DHCP server, and if it does not find one, it assigns an IP address within the  
192.168.1.0/24 subnetwork to any devices connected to it.  
1. On the management device, such as a PC or laptop, you use to access the J-Web  
interface, verify that the address of the port that you connect to the router is set  
to one of the following:  
An Ethernet address on the 192.168.1/24 subnetwork other than  
192.168.1.1  
An Ethernet address from a DHCP server  
2. Turn off the power to the management device.  
3. Plug one end of the Ethernet cable into the Ethernet port on the management  
device.  
4. Connect the other end of the Ethernet cable to the built-in Ethernet port on the  
router.  
5. Power on the router by pressing the power button on the front panel.  
6.  
Wait until the STATUS LED on the front panel turns solid green.  
Connecting to a Services Router  
137  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
7. Turn on the power to the management device. The router assigns an IP address  
to the management device within the 192.168.1.0/24 subnetwork if the device  
is configured to use DHCP.  
8. From the management device, open a Web browser and enter the IP address  
192.168.1.1 in the address field. The Set Up Quick Configuration page appears.  
NOTE: You must manually configure the IP address for the management port you  
are using before you save your initial configuration. When you save the configuration  
for the first time, you will lose the connection to the router if you have not manually  
configured the IP address. If you lose connection through the management interface,  
you must connect through the console port.  
Figure 67: Connecting to the Gigabit Ethernet Port on J2320 and J2350 Routers  
138  
Connecting to a Services Router  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 7: Establishing Basic Connectivity  
Figure 68: Connecting to the Gigabit Ethernet Port on J4350 and J6350 Routers  
Connecting to the CLI Locally  
If you plan to use the CLI to configure the router, you must connect through the  
console port, as shown in Figure 69 on page 140 and Figure 70 on page 141.  
NOTE: Figure 69 on page 140 and Figure 70 on page 141 show a connection to a local  
management device. A remote connection to the router through a modem requires  
the cable and connector shown (provided in the routers accessory box), plus a DB-9  
female to DB-25 male (or similar) adapter for your modem, which you must purchase  
separately.  
To connect to the CLI using a local management device through the console port on  
the router:  
1. Turn off power to the router.  
2. Turn off the power to the management device, such as a PC or laptop computer,  
that you are using to access the CLI.  
3. Plug one end of the Ethernet cable supplied with your router into the RJ-45 to  
DB-9 serial port adapter supplied with your router (see Figure 69 on page 140  
4. Plug the RJ-45 to DB-9 serial port adapter into the serial port on the management  
5. Connect the other end of the Ethernet cable to the console port on the router  
6. Turn on the power to the management device.  
7. Start your asynchronous terminal emulation application (such as Microsoft  
Windows Hyperterminal) and select the appropriate COM port to use (for example,  
COM1).  
Connecting to a Services Router  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
139  
           
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
8. Configure the port settings as follows:  
Bits per second: 9600  
Data bits: 8  
Parity: None  
Stop bits: 1  
Flow control: None  
9. Power on the router by pressing the power button on the front panel. Verify that  
the POWER LED on the front panel turns green.  
The terminal emulation screen on your management device displays the boot  
sequence. When the router has finished booting, a login prompt appears.  
10. Log in as the user root. No password is required at initial connection, but you  
must assign a root password before committing any configuration settings.  
Figure 69: Connecting to the Console Port on J2320 and J2350 Routers  
140  
Connecting to a Services Router  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 7: Establishing Basic Connectivity  
Figure 70: Connecting to the Console Port on J4350 and J6350 Routers  
Connecting to the CLI Remotely  
You can connect to the CLI from a remote location through two dial-up modems: a  
modem that is connected to the console port on the Services Router and a second  
modem connected to a remote management device. The modem connection allows  
you to remotely perform the same console operations you can perform locally.  
This section contains the following topics:  
Configuring the Modem at the Router End  
NOTE: These instructions use Hayes-compatible modem commands to configure the  
modem. If your modem is not Hayes-compatible, refer to the documentation for  
your modem and enter equivalent modem commands.  
Before you can connect a dial-up modem to the console port on the Services Router,  
you must configure the modem to accept a call on the first ring and accept Data  
Terminal Ready (DTR) signals. You must also disable flow control on the modem.  
To configure the modem on the router end:  
1. Connect the modem to a PC or laptop computer.  
2. Power on the modem.  
Connecting to a Services Router  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
141  
         
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
3. From the PC or laptop computer, start your asynchronous terminal emulation  
application (such as Microsoft Windows Hyperterminal) and select the COM port  
to which the modem is connected (for example, COM1).  
4. Configure the port settings as follows:  
Bits per second: 9600  
Data bits: 8  
Parity: None  
Stop bits: 1  
Flow control: None  
5.  
6.  
In the HyperTerminal window, enter AT.  
An OK response verifies that the modem communicates successfully with the  
COM port on the PC or laptop.  
To configure the modem to answer a call on the first ring, enter ATS0=1.  
7. To configure the modem to accept modem control Data Terminal Ready (DTR)  
signals, enter AT&D1.  
8.  
9.  
To disable flow control, enter AT&K0.  
To save modem settings, enter AT&W.  
Connecting the Modem to the Console Port  
NOTE: Most modems have an RS-232 DB-25 connector. You must separately purchase  
an adapter to connect your modem to the RJ-45 to DB-9 adapter and Ethernet cable  
supplied with the router.  
To connect the dial-up modem to the console port on the router:  
1. Turn off power to the router.  
2. Turn off the power to the modem.  
3. Plug one end of the Ethernet cable supplied with your router into the console  
port on the router.  
4. Plug the other end of the Ethernet cable into the RJ-45 to DB-9 serial port adapter  
supplied with your router.  
5. Connect the serial port adapter to a separately purchased DB-9 female to DB-25  
male adapter, or other adapter appropriate for your modem.  
6. Plug the modem adapter into the DB-25 connector on the modem.  
7. Connect the modem to your telephone network.  
8. Turn on the power to the modem.  
9. Power on the router by pressing the power button on the front panel. Verify that  
the POWER LED on the front panel turns green.  
142  
Connecting to a Services Router  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                       
Chapter 7: Establishing Basic Connectivity  
Connecting to the CLI at the User End  
To remotely connect to the CLI through a dial-up modem connected to the console  
port on the router:  
1. At your remote location, connect a modem to a management device such as a  
PC or laptop computer.  
2. On the PC or laptop computer, start your asynchronous terminal emulation  
application (such as Microsoft Windows Hyperterminal).  
3.  
4. Configure the port settings as follows:  
Select the COM port to which the modem is connected (for example, COM1).  
Bits per second: 9600  
Data bits: 8  
Parity: None  
Stop bits: 1  
Flow control: None  
5.  
In the HyperTerminal window, enter AT.  
An OK response verifies that the modem communicates successfully with the  
COM port on the PC or laptop.  
6. To dial the modem that is connected to the console port on the router, enter  
ATDT remote-modem-number. For example, if the number of the modem connected  
to the console port on the router is 0013033033030, enter ATDT 0013033033030.  
The router login prompt appears.  
7.  
Log in as the user root. No password is required at initial connection, but you  
must assign a root password before committing any configuration settings.  
Configuring Basic Settings with J-Web Quick Configuration  
144 shows the Quick Configuration page for basic setup.  
Configuring Basic Settings with J-Web Quick Configuration  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
143  
                 
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
Figure 71: Set Up Quick Configuration Page  
Before you configure the router, gather the information described in Before You  
To configure basic settings with J-Web Quick Configuration:  
1.  
If you have not already done so, connect a management device to the ge-0/0/0  
interface on port 0/0. For instructions, see Connecting to the J-Web  
2. If the Set Up Quick Configuration page is not displayed, select  
Configuration>Quick Configuration >Set Up.  
3. Enter information into the Set Up Quick Configuration page, as described in  
4. Click one of the following buttons:  
To apply the configuration and stay in the Set Up Quick Configuration page,  
click Apply.  
To apply the configuration and return to the Quick Configuration page, click  
OK.  
144  
Configuring Basic Settings with J-Web Quick Configuration  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 7: Establishing Basic Connectivity  
To cancel your entries and return to the Quick Configuration page, click  
Cancel.  
NOTE: After initial configuration is complete, the Services Router stops functioning  
as a DHCP server. If you change the IP address of ge-0/0/0 and have the management  
device configured to use DHCP, you lose your DHCP lease and your connection to  
the router through the J-Web interface. To reestablish a connection, either set the IP  
address on the management device manually, or connect ge-0/0/0 to the  
management network and access the router another wayfor example, through the  
console port.  
5. To check the configuration, see Displaying Basic Connectivity  
Table 61: Set Up Quick Configuration Summary  
Field  
Function  
Your Action  
Identification  
Host Name  
(required)  
Defines the hostname of the router.  
Type the hostname.  
Domain Name  
Defines the network or subnetwork that the  
machine belongs to.  
Type the domain name.  
Root Password  
(required)  
Sets the root password that user rootcan  
use to log in to the router.  
Type a plain-text password that the system encrypts.  
NOTE: After a root password has been defined, it is  
required when you log in to the J-Web user interface  
or the CLI.  
Verify Root Password Verifies the root password has been typed  
Retype the password.  
(required)  
correctly.  
Time  
Time Zone  
Identifies the time zone that the router is  
located in.  
From the list, select the appropriate time zone.  
NTP Servers  
Specify an NTP server that the router can  
reach to synchronize the system time.  
To add an IP address, type it in the box to the left of  
the Add button, then click Add.  
To delete an IP address, click on it in the box above  
the Add button, then click Delete.  
Configuring Basic Settings with J-Web Quick Configuration  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
145  
             
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
Table 61: Set Up Quick Configuration Summary (continued)  
Field  
Function  
Your Action  
To immediately set the time using the NTP server,  
Current System Time Synchronizes the system time with the NTP  
server, or manually set the system time and  
date.  
click Set Time via NTP. The router sends a  
request to the NTP server and synchronizes the  
system time.  
NOTE: If you are configuring other settings on this  
page, the router also synchronizes the system time  
using the NTP server when you click Apply or OK.  
To set the time manually, click Set Time  
Manually. A pop-up window allows you to select  
the current date and time from lists.  
Network  
DNS Name Servers  
Specify a DNS server that the router can use  
to resolve hostnames into addresses.  
To add an IP address, type it in the box to the left of  
the Add button, then click Add.  
To delete an IP address, click on it in the box above  
the Add button, then click Delete.  
Domain Search  
Adds each domain name that the router is  
included in to the configuration so that they  
are included in a DNS search.  
To add a domain name, type it in the box to the left  
of the Add button, then click Add.  
To delete a domain name, click on it in the box above  
the Add button, then click Delete.  
Default Gateway  
Loopback Address  
ge-0/0/0 Address  
Defines a default gateway through which to  
direct packets addressed to networks not  
explicitly listed in the routing table.  
Type a 32-bit IP address, in dotted decimal notation.  
Defines a reserved IP address that is always  
available on the router. If no address is  
entered, this address is set to 127.0.0.1/32.  
Type a 32-bit IP address and prefix length, in dotted  
decimal notation.  
Defines the IP address and prefix length of  
ge-0/0/0. The interface ge-0/0/0 is typically  
used as the management interface for  
accessing the router. The DHCP client sets this  
address to 192.168.1.1/24 if no DHCP server  
is found.  
Type a 32-bit IP address and prefix length, in dotted  
decimal notation.  
NOTE: You must enter the ge-0/0/0 address on the  
Quick Configuration Set Up page before you click  
Apply or OK. If you do not manually configure this  
address, you will lose your connection to the J-Web  
interface when you click Apply or OK.  
Management Access  
Allow Telnet Access  
Allows remote access to the router using  
Telnet.  
To enable Telnet access, select the check box.  
Allow JUNOScript  
over Clear-Text  
Access  
Allows JUNOScript to access the router using To enable JUNOScript access over clear text, select the  
a protocol for sending unencrypted text over check box.  
a TCP connection.  
Allow SSH Access  
Allows remote access to the router using SSH. To enable SSH access, select the check box.  
146  
Configuring Basic Settings with J-Web Quick Configuration  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                 
Chapter 7: Establishing Basic Connectivity  
Configuring Basic Settings with a Configuration Editor  
To establish basic connectivity on a Services Router, you identify the router, connect  
the router to the network, and specify basic network settings.  
In a typical network, the Services Router has the basic settings listed in  
Table 62 on page 147. Determine the values to set on the Services Router in your  
network.  
Table 62: Sample Settings on a Services Router  
Services Router Property  
Services Router hostname  
Access for user root”  
Sample Value  
routera  
SSH RSA public key  
10.148.2.21  
IP address of the NTP server used to synchronize system time  
on the Services Router  
Services Router location  
Sunnyvale, California, USA, which is in the  
America/Los_Angeles time zone  
IP address of the DNS server to which DNS requests are sent  
Domains to which the Services Router belongs  
10.148.2.32  
lab.router.net and router.net  
192.168.2.12/24  
IP address of a backup router to use while the Services Router  
is booting or if the routing protocol processes fail to start  
Loopback IP address and prefix length for the Services Router  
172.16.1.24/32  
lo0 interface  
IP address and prefix length for the Services Router ge-0/0/0 192.168.1.1/24  
interface  
You can configure basic settings in the J-Web interface from a device attached to the  
ge-0/0/0 interface on port 0. For instructions, see Connecting to the J-Web  
Interfaceon page 137. You can also connect to the CLI to configure basic settings.  
To use a configuration editor to configure basic settings:  
1. Navigate to the top of the configuration hierarchy in either the J-Web or CLI  
configuration editor.  
2. To configure basic settings, perform the configuration tasks described in  
Configuring Basic Settings with a Configuration Editor  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
147  
     
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
3. If you are using the J-Web interface, click Commit to view a summary of your  
changes, then click OK to commit the configuration. If you are using the CLI,  
commit the configuration by entering the commit command.  
4. To check the configuration, see Displaying Basic Connectivity  
Table 63: Configuring Basic Settings  
Task  
J-Web Configuration Editor  
CLI Configuration Editor  
Navigate to the System  
level in the configuration  
hierarchy.  
In the J-Web interface, select Configuration>View  
and Edit> Edit Configuration.  
1.  
2.  
From the [edit] hierarchy level,  
enter  
Next to System, click Configure or Edit.  
edit system  
Define the hostname of  
the router.  
In the Host name box, type the hostname of the routerfor Set the hostname. For example:  
example, routera.  
set host-name routera  
Name the domain in  
which the router is  
located.  
In the Domain name box, type the domain name of the  
routerfor example, lab.router.net.  
Set the domain name. For example:  
set domain-name lab.router.net  
Allow SSH remote access.  
In the Nested configuration section, next to Services, Set remote access for SSH:  
click Configure or Edit.  
1.  
set services ssh  
Next to Ssh, click Configure or Edit.  
2.  
3.  
4.  
Click OK.  
Click OK a second time to return to the System level  
in the configuration editor hierarchy.  
Define root authentication  
for access to the router.  
In the Nested configuration section, next to Root  
authentication, click Configure or Edit.  
Set the root password. For  
example:  
1.  
Next to Ssh rsa, click Add New Entry.  
2.  
3.  
NOTE: For readability, the  
entire key is not shown.  
set root-authentication ssh-rsa  
ssh-rsa  
AAAAB3Nza...D9Y2gXF9ac==  
In the Authorized key box, type the RSA passwordfor  
example, ssh-rsa AAAAB3Nza...D9Y2gXF9ac==  
Click OK.  
4.  
5.  
Click OK a second time to return to the System level  
in the configuration editor hierarchy.  
Define the time zone the  
router is located in.  
In the Time zone list, select the time zone for your  
routerfor example, America/Los_Angeles.  
Set the time zone. For example:  
set time-zone America/Los_Angeles  
148  
Configuring Basic Settings with a Configuration Editor  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Chapter 7: Establishing Basic Connectivity  
Table 63: Configuring Basic Settings (continued)  
Task  
J-Web Configuration Editor  
CLI Configuration Editor  
Define the NTP server that  
NTP requests can be sent  
to.  
In the Nested configuration section, next to Ntp, click Set the address of the NTP server.  
1.  
Configure or Edit.  
For example:  
Next to Server, click Add New Entry.  
2.  
3.  
set ntp server 10.148.2.21  
In the Address box, type the NTP server's IP  
addressfor example, 10.148.2.21  
Click OK.  
4.  
5.  
Click OK a second time to return to the System level  
in the configuration editor hierarchy.  
Define the DNS server that  
receives DNS requests.  
Next to Name server, click Add New Entry.  
Set the address of the DNS server.  
For example:  
1.  
2.  
In the Address box, type the address of the DNS  
serverfor example, 10.148.2.32.  
set name-server 10.148.2.32  
Click OK.  
3.  
Add each domain that the  
router belongs to.  
Next to Domain search, click Add New Entry.  
Set the domains to be searched. For  
example:  
1.  
2.  
In the Value box, type the name of the domain in  
which the router is locatedfor example, lab.router.net.  
set domain-search lab.router.net  
set domain-search router.net  
Click OK.  
3.  
4.  
5.  
Next to Domain search, click Add New Entry.  
In the Value box, type the name of another domain  
that the router belongs tofor example, router.net.  
Click OK.  
6.  
Define the backup router  
to be used when the  
router is booting or the  
routing protocol processes  
are not running.  
In the Backup router section, next to Address, type the IP  
address of the backup routerfor example, 192.168.2.44.  
Set the address for the backup  
router. For example:  
set backup router address  
192.168.2.44  
Define the IP address for  
lo0.0.  
In the configuration editor hierarchy, next to Interfaces,  
click Configure or Edit.  
1.  
1. From the [edit] hierarchy level,  
enter  
2. In the Interface table, locate the lo0 row and click Unit.  
edit interfaces  
In the Unit table, click 0, and in the Family section  
next to Inet, click Configure or Edit.  
3.  
Delete the existing IP address:  
2.  
3.  
To delete the existing IP address, click the Discard  
button. Select the Delete Configuration Below This  
Point option button from the next display.  
4.  
delete lo0 unit 0 family inet  
address  
Set the IP address and prefix  
length of lo0.0. For example:  
Next to Address, click Add new entry.  
5.  
6.  
In the Source box, type the address and prefix length  
for the loopback interfacefor example,  
172.16.1.24/32.  
set lo0 unit 0 family inet  
address 172.16.1.24/32  
Click OK.  
7.  
Configuring Basic Settings with a Configuration Editor  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
149  
         
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
Table 63: Configuring Basic Settings (continued)  
Task  
J-Web Configuration Editor  
CLI Configuration Editor  
Define the IP address for  
ge-0/0/0.  
In the configuration editor hierarchy, next to Interfaces,  
click Configure or Edit.  
Delete the existing IP address:  
1.  
1.  
delete ge-0/0/0 unit 0 family  
inet address.  
2. In the Interface table, locate the ge-0/0/0 row and click  
Unit.  
Set the IP address and prefix  
length of ge-0/0/0. For  
example:  
2.  
In the Unit table, click 0, and in the Family section  
next to Inet, click Configure or Edit.  
3.  
To delete the existing IP address, click the Discard  
button. Select the Delete Configuration Below This  
Point option button from the next display.  
4.  
set ge-0/0/0 unit 0 family inet  
address 192.168.1.1/24  
Next to Address, click Add new entry.  
5.  
6.  
In the Source box, type the address and prefix length  
for the management interfacefor example,  
192.168.1.1/24.  
Click OK.  
7.  
Verifying Basic Connectivity  
To verify that the Services Router has the settings you configured, perform the  
following task:  
Displaying Basic Connectivity Configurations  
Purpose Verify the configuration of basic connectivity. Because the basic connectivity settings  
appear in different places in the configuration hierarchy, displaying the entire  
configuration at once makes viewing the settings easier.  
Action From the J-Web interface, select  
Configuration>View and Edit>View Configuration Text. Alternatively, from  
configuration mode in the CLI, enter the show command. The following sample output  
the values you set.  
[edit]  
user@host# show  
system {  
host-name routera;  
domain-name lab.router.net;  
domain-search [ lab.router.net router.net ];  
backup-router 192.168.2.44;  
time-zone America/Los_Angeles;  
root-authentication {  
ssh-rsa "ssh-rsa [email protected]";  
}
name-server {  
10.148.2.32;  
150  
Verifying Basic Connectivity  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Chapter 7: Establishing Basic Connectivity  
}
services {  
}
ntp {  
server 10.148.2.21;  
}
}
interfaces {  
ge-0/0/0 {  
unit 0 {  
family inet {  
address 192.168.1.1/24;  
}
}
}
lo0 {  
unit 0 {  
family inet {  
address 172.16.1.24/32;  
}
}
}
}
Meaning The output shows the configuration of basic connectivity. Verify that the values  
displayed are correct for your Services Router.  
Related Topics For more information about the format of a configuration file, see the J-series Services  
Router Basic LAN and WAN Access Configuration Guide.  
Displaying Basic Connectivity Configurations  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
151  
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
152  
Displaying Basic Connectivity Configurations  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 8  
Configuring Secure Web Access  
You can manage a Services Router remotely through the J-Web interface. To  
communicate with the router, the J-Web interface uses Hypertext Transfer Protocol  
(HTTP). HTTP allows easy Web access but no encryption. The data that is transmitted  
between the Web browser and the router by means of HTTP is vulnerable to  
interception and attack. To enable secure Web access, a router supports Hypertext  
Transfer Protocol over Secure Sockets Layer (HTTPS). You can enable HTTP or HTTPS  
access on specific interfaces and ports as needed.  
You can use J-Web Quick Configuration, the J-Web configuration editor, or the CLI  
configuration editor to configure secure Web access.  
This chapter contains the following topics. For more information about the J-Web  
interface, see the J-Web Interface User Guide.  
Secure Web Access Terms  
Before configuring secure Web access, become familiar with the terms defined in  
Table 64: Secure Web Access Terms  
Term  
Definition  
certificate authority (CA)  
Third-party organization or company that issues digital certificates used to create  
digital signatures and public-private key pairs. The CA guarantees the identity of the  
individual or device that presents the digital certificate.  
Hypertext Transfer  
Protocol (HTTP)  
Protocol used to publish and receive information on the Web, such as text and graphics  
files.  
Secure Web Access Terms  
153  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
Table 64: Secure Web Access Terms (continued)  
Term  
Definition  
Hypertext Transfer  
Protocol over Secure  
Sockets Layer (HTTPS)  
Protocol similar to HTTP with an added encryption layer that encrypts and decrypts  
user page requests and pages that are returned by a Web server. HTTPS is used for  
secure communication, such as payment transactions.  
Privacy-Enhanced Mail  
(PEM)  
Technique for securely exchanging electronic mail over a public medium. PEM is based  
upon public key infrastructure (PKI) standards like X.509 certificates. SSL certificates  
are partly based on PEM and end in the suffix .pem.  
RSA  
Public key cipher that can be used for encrypting messages and making digital  
signatures. RSA uses a well-known encryption and authentication algorithm that is a  
part of popular Web browsers.  
Secure Sockets Layer (SSL) Protocol that encrypts security information before transmitting data across a network.  
SSL requires two keys to encrypt dataa public key known to everyone and a private  
or secret key known only to the recipient of the messageand an authentication  
certificate. Most popular Web browsers support SSL.  
SSL certificate  
Secure electronic identifier conforming to the X.509 standard, definitively identifying  
an individual, system, company, or organization. In addition to identification data,  
the digital certificate contains a serial number, a copy of the certificate holders public  
key, the identity and digital signature of the issuing certificate authority (CA), and an  
expiration date.  
Secure Web Access Overview  
A Services Router uses the Secure Sockets Layer (SSL) protocol to provide secure  
management of Services Routers through the Web interface. SSL uses public-private  
key technology that requires a paired private key and an authentication certificate  
for providing the SSL service. SSL encrypts communication between your router and  
the Web browser with a session key negotiated by the SSL server certificate.  
An SSL certificate includes identifying information such as a public key and a signature  
made by a certificate authority (CA). When you access the router through HTTPS, an  
SSL handshake authenticates the server and the client and begins a secure session.  
If the information does not match or the certificate has expired, you are not able to  
access the router through HTTPS.  
Without SSL encryption, communication between your router and the browser is  
sent in the open and can be intercepted. We recommend that you enable HTTPS  
access on your WAN interfaces.  
On J-series Services Routers, HTTP access is enabled by default on the built-in  
management interfaces. By default, HTTPS access is supported on any interface with  
an SSL server certificate.  
Before You Begin  
Before you begin initial configuration, complete the following tasks:  
154  
Secure Web Access Overview  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Chapter 8: Configuring Secure Web Access  
Obtain an SSL certificate from a trusted signing authority. See Generating SSL  
Generating SSL Certificates  
To enable secure Web access, you must first generate a digital SSL certificate, and  
then enable HTTPS access on the Services Router.  
To generate an SSL certificate:  
1.  
Enter the following openssl command in your Secure Shell command-line  
interface. The openssl command generates a self-signed SSL certificate in the  
privacy-enhanced mail (PEM) format. It writes the certificate and an unencrypted  
1024-bit RSA private key to the specified file.  
% openssl req x509 nodes newkey rsa:1024 keyout filename.pem -out  
filename.pem  
Replace filename with the name of a file in which you want the SSL certificate  
to be writtenfor example, new.pem.  
2. When prompted, type the appropriate information in the identification form.  
For example, type US for the country name.  
3.  
Display the contents of the file new.pem.  
cat new.pem  
Copy the contents of this file for installing the SSL certificate.  
You can use either J-Web Quick Configuration or a configuration editor to install the  
SSL certificate and enable HTTPS.  
Configuring Secure Web Access  
Navigate to the Secure Access Quick Configuration page by selecting  
Configuration>Quick Configuration>Secure Access. On this page, you can enable  
HTTP and HTTPS access on interfaces for managing Services Routers through the  
Web interface. You can also install SSL certificates and enable JUNOScript over SSL  
with the Secure Access page.  
Figure 72 on page 156 shows the Secure Access Quick Configuration page.  
Configuring Secure Web Access  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
155  
       
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
Figure 72: Quick Configuration Secure Access Page  
To configure Web access settings in the J-Web interface:  
1. Enter information into the Secure Access Quick Configuration page, as described  
2. Click one of the following buttons:  
To apply the configuration and stay on the Quick Configuration page, click  
Apply.  
To apply the configuration and return to the Quick Configuration page, click  
OK.  
To cancel your entries and return to the Quick Configuration page, click  
Cancel.  
156  
Configuring Secure Web Access  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 8: Configuring Secure Web Access  
3. To verify that Web access is enabled correctly, connect to the router using one  
of the following methods:  
For HTTP accessIn your Web browser, type http://URL or http://IP address.  
For HTTPS accessIn your Web browser, type https://URL or https://IP  
address.  
For SSL JUNOScript accessA JUNOScript client such as JUNOScope is  
required. For information about how to log in to JUNOScope, see the  
JUNOScope Software User Guide.  
4. To verify the secure Web access configuration, see Verifying Secure Web  
Table 65: Secure Access Quick Configuration Summary  
Field  
Function  
Your Action  
Certificates  
Certificates  
Displays digital certificates required for SSL To add a certificate:  
access to the Services Router.  
Click Add. Opens the Add a Local Certificate page.  
1.  
2.  
Allows you to add and delete SSL  
certificates.  
Type a name in the Certificate Name boxfor  
example, new.  
Paste the generated certificate and RSA private  
key in the Certificate box.  
3.  
For information about how to generate an  
SSL certificate, see Generating SSL  
To delete a certificate, select it and click Delete.  
HTTP Web Access  
Enable HTTP Access  
Enables HTTP access on interfaces.  
To enable HTTP access, select the Enable HTTP access  
check box.  
Enable HTTP on All  
Interfaces  
Enables HTTP access on all interfaces at  
one time.  
To enable HTTP access on all interfaces, select the  
Enable HTTP on All Interfaces check box.  
HTTP-Enabled  
Interfaces  
Specifies interfaces on which you want to  
enable HTTP access.  
Select and deselect interfaces by clicking the direction  
arrows:  
To enable HTTP access on an interface, add the  
interface to the HTTP Interfaces list.  
To disable HTTP access on an interface, add the  
interface to the Logical Interfaces list.  
HTTPS Web Access  
Enable HTTPS Access  
Enables HTTPS access on interfaces.  
To enable HTTPS access, select the Enable HTTPS  
access check box.  
HTTPS Certificate  
Specifies SSL certificates to be used for  
encryption.  
To specify the HTTPS certificate, select a certificate  
from the HTTPS Certificate listfor example, new.  
This field is available only after you have  
created an SSL certificate.  
Configuring Secure Web Access  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
157  
   
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
Table 65: Secure Access Quick Configuration Summary (continued)  
Field  
Function  
Your Action  
Enable HTTPS on All  
Interfaces  
Enables HTTPS on all interfaces at one  
time.  
To enable HTTPS on all interfaces, select the Enable  
HTTPS on All Interfaces check box.  
HTTPS-Enabled  
Interfaces  
Allows you to specify interfaces on which  
you want to enable HTTPS access.  
Select and deselect interfaces by clicking the direction  
arrows:  
To enable HTTPS access on an interface, add the  
interface to the HTTPS Interfaces list.  
To disable HTTPS access on an interface, add the  
interface to the Logical Interfaces list.  
JUNOScript over SSL  
Enable SSL JUNOScript Enables secured SSL access to the  
To enable SSL access, select the Enable SSL JUNOScript  
access check box.  
access  
JUNOScript XML scripting API.  
JUNOScript SSL  
Certificate  
Specifies SSL certificates to be used for  
encryption.  
To enable an SSL certificate, select a certificate from  
the JUNOScript SSL Certificate listfor example, new.  
This field is available only after you create  
at least one SSL certificate.  
Configuring Secure Web Access with a Configuration Editor  
You can manage your Services Router using a secure Web connection by enabling  
HTTPS.  
To enable HTTPS on your Services Router:  
1. Navigate to the top of the configuration hierarchy in either the J-Web or CLI  
configuration editor.  
2. Perform the configuration tasks described in Table 66 on page 158.  
3. If you are finished configuring the router, commit the configuration.  
4. To check the configuration, see Verifying Secure Web Accesson page 159.  
Table 66: Configuring a Secure Web Access  
Task  
J-Web Configuration Editor  
CLI Configuration Editor  
From the [edit] hierarchy level, enter  
edit security  
Navigate to the Security  
level in the configuration  
hierarchy.  
In the J-Web interface, select  
Configuration>View and Edit>Edit  
Configuration.  
1.  
Next to Security, click Configure or Edit.  
2.  
158  
Configuring Secure Web Access with a Configuration Editor  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 8: Configuring Secure Web Access  
Table 66: Configuring a Secure Web Access (continued)  
Task  
J-Web Configuration Editor  
CLI Configuration Editor  
Import the SSL certificate  
that you have  
generatedfor example,  
Next to Certificates, click Configure.  
Next to Local, click Add new entry.  
Enter  
1.  
2.  
3.  
set certificates local new load-key-filepath  
new.  
In the Name box, type a name for the  
certificate to be importedfor example,  
new.  
Replace path with a path or URL to the file  
containing an SSL certificate and private key  
in PEM formatfor example,  
For information about  
generating SSL certificates,  
In the Certificate box, paste the generated  
SSL certificate and private key.  
4.  
5.  
1.  
2.  
/var/tmp/new.pem  
Click OK.  
Enable HTTPS access and  
specify the SSL certificate  
to be used for  
On the main Configuration page next to  
System, click Configure or Edit.  
From the [edit system] hierarchy level, enter  
set services web-management https  
local-certificate new port 8443  
Select the Services check box and click  
Edit next to it.  
authentication.  
Specify the port on which  
HTTPS access is to be  
enabledfor example, TCP  
port 8443.  
Next to Web management, click Edit.  
3.  
4.  
Select the Https check box and click Edit  
next to it.  
In the Local certificate box, type the name  
of the certificatefor example, new.  
5.  
NOTE: You can enable  
HTTPS access on specified  
interfaces also. If you  
enable HTTPS without  
specifying an interface,  
HTTPS is enabled on all  
interfaces.  
6. In the Port box, type 8443.  
Click OK.  
7.  
Verifying Secure Web Access  
To verify that the Services Router has the secure access settings you configured,  
perform the following tasks:  
Displaying an SSL Certificate Configuration  
Purpose Display the SSL certificate configuration.  
Action From the J-Web interface, select  
Configuration>View and Edit>View Configuration Text. Alternatively, from  
configuration mode in the CLI, enter the show security command.  
The following sample output displays an SSL certificate generated with instructions  
[edit]  
user@R0# show security  
certificates {  
Verifying Secure Web Access  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
159  
         
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
local {  
new {  
"-----BEGIN RSA PRIVATE KEY-----\nMIICXQIBAAKBgQC/C5UI4frNqbi  
qPwbTiOkJvqoDw2YgYse0Z5zzVJyErgSg954T\nEuHM67Ck8hAOrCnb0YO+SY  
Y5rCXLf4+2s8k9EypLtYRw/Ts66DZoXI4viqE7HSsK\n5sQw/UDBIw7/MJ+OpA  
... KYiFf4CbBBbjlMQJ0HFudW6ISVBslONkzX+FT\ni95ddka6iIRnArEb4VFCRh+  
e1QBdp1UjziYf7NuzDx4Z\n -----END RSA PRIVATE KEY-----\n-----BEGIN  
CERTIFICATE----- \nMIIDjDCCAvWgAwIBAgIBADANBgkqhkiG9w0BAQQ ...  
FADCBkTELMAkGA1UEBhMCdXMx\nCzAJBgNVBAgTAmNhMRIwEAYDVQQHEwlzdW5ue  
HB1YnMxDTALBgNVBAMTBGpucHIxJDAiBgkqhkiG\n9w0BCQEWFW5iaGFyZ2F2YUB  
fLUYAnBYmsYWOH\n -----END CERTIFICATE-----\n"; ## SECRET-DATA  
}
}
}
Meaning The output shows the intended secure access configuration.  
Related Topics For more information about the format of a configuration file, see the J-series Services  
Router Basic LAN and WAN Access Configuration Guide.  
Displaying a Secure Access Configuration  
Purpose Verify the secure access configuration.  
Action From the J-Web interface, select  
Configuration>View and Edit>View Configuration Text. Alternatively, from  
configuration mode in the CLI, enter the show system services command.  
The following sample output displays the sample values for secure Web access as  
configured in Table 66 on page 158.  
[edit]  
user@R0# show system services  
web-management {  
http;  
https {  
port 8443;  
local-certificate new;  
}
}
Meaning The output shows the intended secure access configuration.  
Related Topics For more information about the format of a configuration file, see the J-series Services  
Router Basic LAN and WAN Access Configuration Guide.  
160  
Displaying a Secure Access Configuration  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 9  
Installing and Managing J-series Licenses  
To enable some JUNOS software features on a J-series Services Router, you must  
purchase, install, and manage separate software licenses. The presence on the router  
of the appropriate software license keys (passwords) determines the features you  
can configure and use. For those features that require a license, the presence on the  
router of the appropriate software license keys (passwords) determines whether you  
can use the feature.  
For information about how to purchase J-series software licenses, contact your Juniper  
Networks sales representative.  
This chapter contains the following topics:  
J-series License Overview  
Each J-series feature license is valid for only a single Services Router. To manage the  
licenses, you must understand the components of a license key.  
This section contains the following topics:  
License Enforcement  
For features that require a license, you must install and properly configure the license  
to use the feature. Although the router allows you to commit a configuration that  
specifies a feature requiring a license when the license is not present, you are  
prohibited from actually using the feature.  
Successful commitment of a configuration does not imply that the required licenses  
are installed. If a required license is not present, the system provides a warning  
J-series License Overview  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
161  
         
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
message after it commits the configuration rather than failing to commit it because  
of a license violation.  
Software Feature Licenses  
Each feature license is tied to exactly one software feature, and that license is valid  
for exactly one Services Router. Table 67 on page 162 lists the Services Router software  
features that require licenses.  
Table 67: J-series Services Router Software Feature Licenses  
Licensed Software Feature  
License Name  
Traffic Analysis  
J-Flow traffic analysisall configuration statements within the J-series Services Router Software License for J-Flow Traffic  
Analysis  
[edit forwarding-options sampling] and [edit forwarding-options  
accounting] hierarchies.  
BGP Route Reflectors  
Advanced Border Gateway Protocol (BGP) features that enable J-series Services Router Software License for Advanced Border  
Router Protocol Support  
route reflectorsall configuration statements within the [edit  
protocols bgp cluster] hierarchy. BGP clusters allow routers to  
act as route reflectors by enabling the readvertising of BGP  
routes to internal peers.  
License Key Components  
A license key consists of two parts:  
License IDAlphanumeric string that uniquely identifies the license key. When  
a license is generated, it is given a license ID.  
License dataBlock of binary data that defines and stores all license key objects.  
For example, in the following typical license key, the string li29183743 is the license  
ID, and the trailing block of data is the license data:  
li29183743 4ky27y acasck 82fsj6 jzsn4q ix8i8d adj7kr  
8uq38t ix8i8d jzsn4q ix8i8d 4ky27y acasck  
82fsj6 ii8i7e adj7kr 8uq38t ks2923 a9382e  
The license data defines the device ID for which the license is valid and the version  
of the license.  
Before You Begin  
Before you begin managing the J-series licenses, complete the following tasks:  
Purchase the licenses you require.  
162  
Before You Begin  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
               
Chapter 9: Installing and Managing J-series Licenses  
Managing J-series Licenses with the J-Web Interface  
To manage licenses with the J-Web interface, you perform the following tasks:  
The Licenses page displays a summary of licensed features that are configured on  
the Services Router and a list of licenses that are installed on the routers. The  
Table 68: Summary of License Management Fields  
Field Name  
Definition  
Feature Summary  
Feature  
Name of the licensed feature:  
J-series licenses listed in Table 67 on page 162.  
All featuresAll-inclusive licenses  
Licenses Used  
Number of licenses currently being used on the router. Usage is determined by the  
configuration on the router. If a feature license exists and that feature is configured, the  
license is considered used.  
Licenses Installed  
Licenses Needed  
Number of licenses installed on the router for the particular feature.  
Number of licenses required for legal of use the feature. Usage is determined by the  
configuration on the router: If a feature is configured and the license for that feature is not  
installed, a single license is needed.  
Installed Licenses  
ID  
Unique alphanumeric ID of the license.  
State  
ValidThe installed license key is valid.  
InvalidThe installed license key is not valid.  
Numeric version number of the license key.  
Version  
Group  
If the license defines a group license, this field displays the group definition.  
If the license requires a group license, this field displays the required group definition.  
NOTE: Because group licenses are currently unsupported, this field is always blank.  
Enabled Features  
Expiry  
Name of the feature that is enabled with the particular license.  
Expiration information for the license is correct.  
For J-series, only permanent licenses are supported. If a license has expired, it is shown as  
invalid.  
Managing J-series Licenses with the J-Web Interface  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
163  
               
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
Adding New Licenses with the J-Web Interface  
To add a new license key on a Services Router with the J-Web license manager:  
1. In the J-Web interface, select Manage>Licenses.  
2. Under Installed Licenses, click Add to add a new license key.  
3. Do one of the following, using a blank line to separate multiple license keys:  
In the License File URL box, type the full URL to the destination file containing  
the license key to be added.  
In the License Key Text box, paste the license key text, in plain-text format,  
for the license to be added.  
4. Click OK to add the license key.  
Deleting Licenses with the J-Web Interface  
To delete one or more license keys from a Services Router with the J-Web license  
manager:  
1. In the J-Web interface, select Manage>Licenses.  
2. Select the check box of the license or licenses you want to delete.  
3. Click Delete.  
Displaying License Keys with the J-Web Interface  
To display the license keys installed on a Services Router with the J-Web license  
manager:  
1. In the J-Web interface, select Manage>Licenses.  
2. Under Installed Licenses, click Display Keys to display all the license keys installed  
on the router.  
A screen displaying the license keys in text format appears. Multiple licenses are  
separated by a blank line.  
Downloading Licenses with the J-Web Interface  
To download the license keys installed on the Services Router with the J-Web license  
manager:  
1. In the J-Web interface, select Manage>Licenses.  
2. Under Installed Licenses, click Download Keys to download all the license keys  
installed on the router to a single file.  
164  
Managing J-series Licenses with the J-Web Interface  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
               
Chapter 9: Installing and Managing J-series Licenses  
3. Select Save it to disk and specify the file to which the license keys are to be  
written.  
Managing J-series Licenses with the CLI  
To manage the J-series licenses with the CLI, perform the following tasks.  
Adding New Licenses with the CLI  
To add a new license key to the Services Router with the CLI:  
1. Enter operational mode in the CLI.  
2. Enter one of the following CLI commands:  
To add a license key from a file or URL, enter the following command,  
specifying the filename or the URL where the key is located:  
request system license add filename | url  
To add a license key from the terminal, enter the following command:  
request system license add terminal  
3. When prompted, enter the license key, separating multiple license keys with a  
blank line.  
If the license key you enter is invalid, an error is generated when you press Ctrl-D  
to exit license entry mode.  
Deleting a License with the CLI  
To delete a license key from the Services Router with the CLI:  
1. Enter operational mode in the CLI.  
2. Enter the following command for each license, specifying the license ID. You  
can delete only one license at a time.  
request system license delete license-id  
Managing J-series Licenses with the CLI  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
165  
                 
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
Saving License Keys with the CLI  
To save the licenses installed on the Services Router to a file with the CLI:  
1. Enter operational mode in the CLI.  
2. To save the installed license keys to a file or URL, enter the following command:  
request system license save filename | url  
For example, the following command saves the installed license keys to a file  
named license.config:  
request system license save ftp://user@host/license.conf  
Verifying J-series License Management  
To verify J-series license management, perform the tasks explained in these sections:  
Displaying Installed Licenses  
Purpose Verify that the expected licenses are installed and active on the Services Router.  
Action From the CLI, enter the show system license command.  
user@router> show system license  
License usage:  
Licenses  
Licenses  
installed  
Licenses  
needed  
Expiry  
Feature name  
j-flow  
bgp-reflection  
used  
0
0
1
1
0 permanent  
0 permanent  
Licenses installed:  
License identifier: G03000002223  
License version: 2  
Valid for device: JN001875AB  
Features:  
bgp-reflection  
- Border Gateway Protocol route reflection  
License identifier: G03000002225  
License version: 2  
Valid for device: JN001875AB  
Features:  
j-flow  
- J-FLOW traffic analysis (CFLOW reporting)  
Meaning The output shows a list of the license usage and a list of the licenses installed on the  
Services Router and when they expire. Verify the following information:  
166  
Verifying J-series License Management  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                 
Chapter 9: Installing and Managing J-series Licenses  
Each license is present. Licenses are listed in ascending alphanumeric order by  
license ID.  
The feature for each license is the expected feature. The features enabled are  
listed by license. An all-inclusive license has All features listed.  
All configured features have the required licenses installed. The Licenses needed  
column must show that no licenses are required.  
The expiration information for the license is correct. For J-series, only permanent  
licenses are supported.  
Displaying License Usage  
Purpose Verify that the licenses fully cover the feature configuration on the Services Router.  
Action From the CLI, enter the show system license usage command.  
user@router> show system license usage  
Licenses  
Licenses  
Licenses  
Expiry  
Feature name  
j-flow  
bgp-reflection  
used  
installed  
needed  
1
0
0
1
0
1
permanent  
Meaning The output shows a list of the licenses installed on the Services Router and how they  
are used. Verify the following information:  
Each license is present. Features are listed in ascending alphabetical order by  
license name. The number of licenses is shown in the third column. Verify that  
the appropriate number of licenses are installed.  
The number of used licenses matches the number of configured features. If a  
licensed feature is configured, the feature is considered used. The sample output  
shows that the BGP route reflection feature is configured.  
A license is installed on the Services Router for each configured feature. For  
every feature configured that does not have a license, one license is needed.  
For example, the sample output shows that the user has configured the J-Flow  
traffic analysis feature but has not purchased the license for it. An additional  
license is required to be in compliance with license agreements.  
The expiration information for the license is correct. For J-series, only permanent  
licenses are supported.  
Displaying Installed License Keys  
Purpose Verify the license keys installed on the Services Router.  
Action From the CLI, enter the show system license keys command.  
user@router> show system license keys  
G03000002223 aeaqea qkjjhd ambrha 3tkqkc ayareb zicik6  
nv6jck btlxao 2trfyq 65cdou r5tbbb xdarpg  
Displaying License Usage  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
167  
             
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
qq53lu qcx4vm ydakcs t3yyh2 v5mq  
G03000002224 aeaqea qkjjhd ambrha 3tkqkc ayargb zicik6  
nv6jck btlxao 2trfyq 65cdou r5tbof l4uon5  
7rokz7 wgdocl r4q32p 2wu4zf zrxa  
G03000002225 aeaqea qkjjhd ambrha 3tkqkc ayarab zicik6  
nv6jck btlxao 2trfyq 65cdou r5tbiu jr6ui2  
lmqgqj ouzq5a aiokdn 4tr4u2 wmcq  
Meaning The output shows a list of the license keys installed on the Services Router. Verify  
that each expected license key is present.  
168  
Displaying Installed License Keys  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Part 3  
Maintaining Services Router Hardware  
Maintaining Services Router Hardware  
169  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
170  
Maintaining Services Router Hardware  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 10  
Replacing Hardware Components  
Because many of the Services Router's hardware components are field-replaceable  
units (FRUs), you can remove and replace them yourself. When you need to replace  
a router component, contact your customer support or sales representative to order  
the field-replaceable unit (FRU) that contains the component. For instructions, see  
This chapter contains the following topics:  
Tools and Parts Required  
To replace hardware components, you need the tools and parts listed in  
Tools and Parts Required  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
171  
       
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
Table 69: Tools and Parts Required  
Tool or Part  
Components  
Electrostatic bag or antistatic mat  
All  
All  
Electrostatic discharge (ESD)  
grounding wrist strap  
Flat-blade screw-blade screwdriver,  
approximately 1/4 in. (6 mm)  
PIM  
Phillips (+) screwdriver, number 1  
and number 2  
Chassis cover  
Compact flash  
Crypto Accelerator Module  
DRAM modules  
PIM  
Power system components  
Replacing the Console Port Cable  
The RJ-45 port labeled CONSOLE on the Services Router's front panel allows you to  
connect the router to an external management device, such as a laptop or a terminal  
server. For cable specifications, see Chassis Console Port Pinoutson page 234.  
To replace the console port cable:  
1. Locate an appropriate replacement cable and connector.  
2. Plug the Ethernet connector at either end of the cable into the console port on  
the front panel (see Figure 69 on page 140 and Figure 70 on page 141).  
3. Plug the connector at the other end of the cable into the external management  
device. If you are connecting to a DB-9 serial port, use the provided RJ-45 to  
DB-9 serial port adapter.  
Replacing a PIM  
To remove or install field-replaceable Physical Interface Modules (PIMs) in a Services  
Router, you must first power off the router. This section contains the following topics:  
Removing a PIM  
The PIMs are installed in the front of the Services Router. A PIM weighs less than  
1 lb (0.5 kg).  
172  
Replacing the Console Port Cable  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Chapter 10: Replacing Hardware Components  
CAUTION: Do not hot-swap PIMs. Failure to power off the router before removing  
or installing a PIM might result in damage to the hardware.  
Figure 73: Removing a PIM  
To remove a PIM (see Figure 73 on page 173):  
1. Place an electrostatic bag or antistatic mat on a flat, stable surface to receive the  
PIM.  
2. Attach an electrostatic discharge (ESD) grounding strap to your bare wrist and  
connect the strap to the ESD point on the chassis, or to an outside ESD point if  
the Services Router is disconnected from earth ground. For more information  
3.  
Press and release the power button to power off the router. Verify that the POWER  
LED blinks and then turns off.  
4. Label the cables connected to the PIM so that you can later reconnect each cable  
to the correct PIM.  
5. Disconnect the cables from the PIM.  
6. If necessary, arrange the cables to prevent them from dislodging or developing  
stress points:  
Secure each cable so that it is not supporting its own weight as it hangs to  
the floor.  
Place excess cable out of the way in a neatly coiled loop.  
Use fasteners to maintain the shape of cable loops.  
7. Loosen the captive screws on each side of the PIM faceplate.  
8. Grasp the handles on each side of the PIM faceplate, and slide the PIM out of the  
router. Place it in the electrostatic bag or on the antistatic mat.  
9. If you are not reinstalling a PIM into the emptied slot, install a blank PIM panel  
over the slot to maintain proper airflow.  
Replacing a PIM  
173  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
Installing a PIM  
CAUTION: Do not hot-swap PIMs. Failure to power off the router before removing  
or installing a PIM might result in damage to the hardware.  
Figure 74: Installing a PIM  
CAUTION: Do not install a combination of PIMs in a single chassis that exceeds the  
maximum power and heat capacity of the chassis. If J-series power management is  
enabled, PIMs that exceed the maximum power and heat capacity remain offline  
when the chassis is powered on.  
To verify that the combination of PIMs to be installed in a chassis do not exceed the  
power and heat capacities for the J4350 or J6350 router, see Planning for Power  
To install a PIM (see Figure 74 on page 174):  
1. Attach an electrostatic discharge (ESD) grounding strap to your bare wrist and  
connect the strap to the ESD point on the chassis, or to an outside ESD point if  
the Services Router is disconnected from earth ground. For more information  
2.  
Press and release the power button to power off the router. Verify that the POWER  
LED blinks and then turns off.  
3. Align the notches in the connector at the rear of the PIM with the notches in the  
PIM slot in the Services Router, and slide the PIM in until it lodges firmly in the  
router.  
CAUTION: Slide the PIM straight into the slot to avoid damaging the components on  
the PIM.  
4. Tighten the captive screws on each side of the PIM faceplate.  
5. Insert the appropriate cables into the cable connectors on the PIM.  
174  
Replacing a PIM  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 10: Replacing Hardware Components  
6. If necessary, arrange the cables to prevent them from dislodging or developing  
stress points:  
Secure each cable so that it is not supporting its own weight as it hangs to  
the floor.  
Place excess cable out of the way in a neatly coiled loop.  
Use fasteners to maintain the shape of cable loops.  
7.  
Press and release the power button to power on the router. Verify that the POWER  
LED lights steadily.  
Replacing PIM Cables  
Removing and installing PIM cables does not affect Services Router function, except  
that a PIM does not receive or transmit data while its cable is disconnected. To replace  
a PIM cable, perform the following procedures:  
Removing PIM Cables  
To remove a PIM cable:  
1. If you are removing all cables connected to the PIM, issue the following CLI  
command to take the PIM offline:  
user@host> request chassis fpc slot pim-slot offline  
For example, to take the PIM in slot 4 offline, enter the following command:  
user@host> request chassis fpc slot 4 offline  
For more information about the command, see the JUNOS System Basics and  
Services Command Reference.  
2. Unplug the cable from the cable connector port.  
3. Detach the cable from the destination port.  
Installing PIM Cables  
To install a PIM cable:  
1. Have ready a length of the type of cable used by the PIM. For cable specifications,  
2. Insert the cable connector into the cable connector port on the PIM faceplate.  
Replacing PIM Cables  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
175  
               
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
3. Arrange the cable as necessary to prevent it from dislodging or developing stress  
points:  
Secure the cable so that it is not supporting its own weight as it hangs to the  
floor.  
Place excess cable out of the way in a neatly coiled loop.  
Use fasteners to maintain the shape of cable loops.  
4. Insert the other end of the cable into the destination port.  
5. Repeat the previous steps for any additional cables.  
6. If the PIM is offline (its status LED is steadily red), issue the following CLI  
command to bring the PIM online:  
user@host> request chassis fpc slot pim-slot online  
For example, to bring the PIM in slot 4 online, enter the following command:  
user@host> request chassis fpc slot 4 online  
For more information about the command, see the JUNOS System Basics and  
Services Command Reference.  
7. Verify that the PIM status LED shines steadily green to confirm that the PIM is  
online.  
You can also verify correct PIM functioning by issuing the show chassis fpc  
pic-status command described in the JUNOS System Basics and Services Command  
Reference.  
NOTE: In the show chassis fpc pic-status command, the PIM slot number is reported  
as an FPC number and the PIM number (always 0) is reported as a PIC number. For  
more information about network interface naming, see J-series Services Router Basic  
LAN and WAN Access Configuration Guide.  
Removing and Replacing the Chassis Cover on J2320 and J2350 Routers  
On J2320 and J2350 routers, the chassis cover fits tightly on the chassis. To remove  
the cover from the chassis:  
1.  
Press and release the power button to power off the router. Wait for the POWER  
LED to turn off.  
2. Remove the power cable from the power source receptacle.  
3. With a Phillips screwdriver remove the grounding screw.  
4. Remove the router from the rack.  
176  
Removing and Replacing the Chassis Cover on J2320 and J2350 Routers  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 10: Replacing Hardware Components  
5. With a Phillips screwdriver remove the flat head screws from the rear and sides  
of the chassis.  
6. Position the router so that you face the front panel.  
7. Place your hands on the cover and press down while pushing the cover back  
until the two front tabs disengage from the chassis base (see  
Figure 75: Sliding the Chassis Cover  
8. Lift the cover upward and pull it away from the tabs on the rear of the chassis  
Figure 76: Removing and Replacing the Chassis Cover  
To replace the cover on the J2320 and J2350 chassis:  
1. Lower the cover onto the chassis so that the front edge of the cover is a few  
2. Tilt the cover and align the rear tabs with the slots at the bottom of the chassis  
Removing and Replacing the Chassis Cover on J2320 and J2350 Routers  
177  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
Figure 77: Matching the Chassis Slots and Tabs  
3. Lower the cover fully onto the base, and slide it so that the front tabs match the  
front slots and the chassis cover and base edges align completely.  
4. Insert and tighten the flat head screws with a Phillips screwdriver.  
5. Return the router to its installation site, and attach the grounding cable and the  
power cables. (See Connecting Poweron page 124.)  
6.  
Press and release the power button to power on the router. Verify that the POWER  
LED lights steadily.  
Replacing Internal Compact Flashes on J2320 and J2350 Routers  
The internal compact flash provides primary storage for the router and is installed  
can accommodate software images, configuration files, and microcode. For  
information about configuring the internal compact flash, see the J-series Services  
Router Administration Guide.  
NOTE: Use only compact flash cards purchased from Juniper Networks for your  
J-series platform and model.  
178  
Replacing Internal Compact Flashes on J2320 and J2350 Routers  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 10: Replacing Hardware Components  
Figure 78: Location of J2320 and J2350 Internal Compact Flash  
To replace the internal compact flash:  
1. Place an electrostatic bag or antistatic mat on a flat, stable surface.  
2. Attach an electrostatic discharge (ESD) grounding strap to your bare wrist and  
connect the strap to the ESD point on the chassis, or to an outside ESD point if  
the router is disconnected from earth ground. For more information about ESD,  
3.  
Press and release the power button to power off the router. Wait for the POWER  
LED to turn off.  
4. Remove the power cable from the power source receptacle.  
WARNING: If the fans are still rotating, wait until they stop before proceeding with  
the next step.  
6. With a Phillips screwdriver, loosen the pan head screws that secure the internal  
compact flash slot cover.  
7. Remove the compact flash slot cover.  
8. Gently grasp the compact flash, and slide it out of the compact flash slot (see  
Replacing Internal Compact Flashes on J2320 and J2350 Routers  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
179  
   
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
Figure 79: Removing the J2320 or J2350 Internal Compact Flash  
9. Place the compact flash on the antistatic mat or in the electrostatic bag.  
10. With the vendor name and memory size facing up and the arrow pointing towards  
the router, insert the new compact flash into the compact flash slot (see  
Figure 80: Inserting the J2320 or J2350 Internal Compact Flash  
11. Replace the compact flash slot cover.  
12. Tighten the pan head screws that secure the compact flash slot cover.  
13. Slide the chassis cover onto the chassis.  
14. Replace the chassis cover. (See Removing and Replacing the Chassis Cover on  
15. Replace the power cable.  
16.  
Press and release the power button to power on the router. Verify that the POWER  
LED lights steadily.  
180  
Replacing Internal Compact Flashes on J2320 and J2350 Routers  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 10: Replacing Hardware Components  
Replacing Internal Compact Flashes on J4350 and J6350 Routers  
The internal compact flash is installed in a slot on the bottom of the J4350 or J6350  
chassis (see Figure 81 on page 181).  
NOTE: Use only compact flash cards purchased from Juniper Networks for your  
J-series platform and model.  
Figure 81: Location of J4350 and J6350 Compact Flash  
On some J4350 and J6350 Services Routers, the compact flash is in a horizontal  
alternative horizontal orientation of the compact flash.  
Replacing Internal Compact Flashes on J4350 and J6350 Routers  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
181  
     
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
Figure 82: Alternative Horizontal Orientation of J4350 and J6350 Compact Flash  
To replace the compact flash:  
1. Place an electrostatic bag or antistatic mat on a flat, stable surface.  
2. Attach an electrostatic discharge (ESD) grounding strap to your bare wrist and  
connect the strap to the ESD point on the chassis, or to an outside ESD point if  
the router is disconnected from earth ground. For more information about ESD,  
3.  
Press and release the power button to power off the router. Wait for the POWER  
LED to turn off.  
4. Remove the power cord or cable from the power source receptacle.  
5. Remove the screws from the sides and top of the chassis that secure the cover  
to the chassis.  
6. Slide the cover off the chassis.  
WARNING: If the fans are still rotating, wait until they stop before proceeding with  
the next step, especially if your compact flash is in the horizontal position (flat against  
the system board).  
7. Slide the compact flash out of its slot, as shown in Figure 83 on page 183.  
182  
Replacing Internal Compact Flashes on J4350 and J6350 Routers  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 10: Replacing Hardware Components  
Figure 83: Removing the J4350 or J6350 Compact Flash  
8. Place the compact flash on the antistatic mat or in the electrostatic bag.  
9. Slide the new compact flash into the slot and press down, as shown in  
Figure 84: Inserting the J4350 or J6350 Compact Flash  
NOTE: On some Services Routers the compact flash is in a horizontal position. If the  
compact flash connection is horizontal, lay the compact flash behind the slot and  
slide it forward until it clicks into place.  
10. Slide the cover onto the chassis.  
11. Replace and tighten the screws on the sides and top of the chassis that secure  
the cover to the chassis.  
Replacing Internal Compact Flashes on J4350 and J6350 Routers  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
183  
   
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
12. Replace the power cord or cable.  
13.  
Press and release the power button to power on the router. Verify that the POWER  
LED lights steadily.  
Replacing External Compact Flashes  
The external compact flash is an optional component on J2320 and J2350 Services  
Routers. It provides secondary storage for the router and can accommodate software  
images, configuration files, and microcode. If the internal compact flash fails on  
startup, the router boots from the external compact flash.  
For information about configuring the external compact flash, see the J-series Services  
Router Administration Guide.  
NOTE: Depending on your configuration, the Services Router might not have an  
external compact flash. If no external compact flash is installed, proceed directly to  
Step 10 to install the compact flash.  
The external compact flash is installed in a slot on the rear of the J2320 or J2350  
chassis.  
To replace the external compact flash:  
1.  
Verify the device that the router used to boot by running the show system storage  
command from the CLI. For example:  
user@host> show system storage  
Filesystem  
/dev/ad0s1a  
512-blocks  
218254  
Used  
175546  
Avail Capacity Mounted on  
40526 81% / ...  
The boot device is mounted on /. The internal compact flash is located at ad0.  
The external compact flash is located at ad2. The USB storage device is located  
at da0. This example shows that the router booted from the internal compact  
flash.  
If the show system storage output indicates that the router booted from the  
external compact flash, you need to power off the router before replacing the  
compact flash.  
2. Place an electrostatic bag or antistatic mat on a flat, stable surface.  
3. Attach an electrostatic discharge (ESD) grounding strap to your bare wrist and  
connect the strap to the ESD point on the chassis, or to an outside ESD point if  
the router is disconnected from earth ground. For more information about ESD,  
4.  
Press and release the power button to power off the router. Wait for the POWER  
LED to turn off before you remove the compact flash.  
184  
Replacing External Compact Flashes  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 10: Replacing Hardware Components  
Skip this step, if the router did not boot from the external compact flash (see  
step 1).  
5. With a Phillips screwdriver, loosen the pan head screws that secure the external  
compact flash cover to the rear of the chassis (see Figure 85 on page 185).  
Figure 85: Removing the External Compact Flash Cover  
6. Remove the compact flash cover.  
7. Eject the external compact flash by pressing the ejector button to the left of the  
compact flash slot once to unlock the button, and again to eject the compact  
flash (see Figure 86 on page 185).  
Figure 86: Removing the External Compact Flash  
8. Gently grasp the compact flash, and slide it out of the slot.  
9. Place the compact flash on the antistatic mat or in the electrostatic bag.  
10. With the vendor name and memory size facing up and the arrow pointing towards  
the router, insert the new compact flash in the external compact flash slot (see  
Figure 87: Inserting the External Compact Flash  
11. Replace the compact flash slot cover.  
Replacing External Compact Flashes  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
185  
       
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
12. Tighten the pan head screws that secures the compact flash slot cover to the  
rear of the chassis.  
13. Plug the power cord into the power supply.  
14.  
Press and release the power button to power on the router. Verify that the POWER  
LED lights steadily.  
Replacing USB Storage Devices  
USB storage devices are optional components on J-series Services Routers. If installed,  
a USB storage device provides secondary storage for the router. It can accommodate  
software images, configuration files, and microcode. If the internal compact flash  
fails on startup, and the external compact flash is not installed or fails, the router  
boots from the USB storage device.  
For information about configuring the USB storage device, see the J-series Services  
Router Administration Guide.  
NOTE: For a list of supported USB storage devices, see the J-series Services Router  
Release Notes at http://www.juniper.net.  
To remove and install a USB storage device, perform the following procedures:  
Removing the USB Storage Device  
NOTE: Depending on your configuration, the Services Router might not have a USB  
storage device. If no USB storage device is installed, proceed directly to Installing  
The USB storage device is installed into the USB port on the front panel of the Services  
Router. To remove the USB storage device:  
186  
Replacing USB Storage Devices  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 10: Replacing Hardware Components  
1.  
Verify the device that the router used to boot, by running the show system storage  
command from the CLI. For example:  
user@host> show system storage  
Filesystem  
/dev/ad0s1a  
512-blocks  
218254  
Used  
175546  
Avail Capacity Mounted on  
40526 81% / ...  
The boot device is mounted on /. The internal compact flash is located at ad0.  
The external compact flash is located at ad2. The USB storage device is located  
at da0. This example shows that the router booted from the internal compact  
flash.  
If the show system storage output indicates that the router booted from the  
external compact flash, you need to power off the router before replacing the  
compact flash.  
2. Place an electrostatic bag or antistatic mat on a flat, stable surface.  
3. Attach an electrostatic discharge (ESD) grounding strap to your bare wrist and  
connect the strap to the ESD point on the chassis, or to an outside ESD point if  
the router is disconnected from earth ground. For more information about ESD,  
4.  
Press and release the power button to power off the router. Wait for the POWER  
LED to turn off before you remove the compact flash.  
Skip this step, if the router did not boot from the external compact flash (see  
Step 1).  
5. Gently grasp the USB storage device and slide it out of the USB port.  
6. Place the USB storage device on the antistatic mat or in the electrostatic bag.  
Installing the USB Storage Device  
To install the USB storage device:  
NOTE: For a list of supported USB storage devices, see the J-series Services Router  
Release Notes at http://www.juniper.net.  
1. Attach an electrostatic discharge (ESD) grounding strap to your bare wrist and  
connect the strap to the ESD point on the chassis, or to an outside ESD point if  
the router is disconnected from earth ground. For more information about ESD,  
2. Orient the USB storage device with the USB port on the front panel of the router.  
Replacing USB Storage Devices  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
187  
   
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
3. Insert the USB storage device into the USB port. If the USB storage device does  
not easily slide into the port, it might not be oriented correctly. Turn the USB  
storage device upside-down and try again.  
4.  
To configure the USB storage device with the request system snapshot command,  
see the J-series Services Router Administration Guide.  
Replacing DRAM Modules  
The DRAM installed on the Routing Engine provides storage for the routing and  
forwarding tables and for other Routing Engine processes. The design of the Routing  
Engine allows you to modify the DRAM configuration by adding DRAM modules to  
the system board, or removing DRAM modules from the board.  
The DRAM modules are located on the top of the system board, as shown in  
Figure 88 on page 188 and Figure 89 on page 189. Two pairs of slots are available for  
installing DRAM modules. Installing DRAM modules in slots away from each other  
provides better performance than installing them in two adjacent slots.  
NOTE: Use only DRAM modules purchased through Juniper Networks specifically for  
your model.  
Figure 88: J2320 and J2350 DRAM Location  
188  
Replacing DRAM Modules  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 10: Replacing Hardware Components  
Figure 89: J4350 and J6350 DRAM Location  
To modify the DRAM configuration, use the following procedures:  
Removing a DRAM Module  
To remove a DRAM module:  
1. Place an electrostatic bag or antistatic mat on a flat, stable surface.  
2. Attach an electrostatic discharge (ESD) grounding strap to your bare wrist and  
connect the strap to the ESD point on the chassis, or to an outside ESD point if  
the router is disconnected from earth ground. For more information about ESD,  
see the Getting Started Guide for your router.  
3.  
Press and release the power button to power off the router. Wait for the POWER  
LED to turn off.  
4. Unplug the power cord or cable from the power source receptacle.  
5. Remove the screws from the sides and top of the chassis that secure the cover  
to the chassis.  
7. To release the DRAM module, press the plastic ejectors on both sides of the  
module (see Figure 90 on page 190).  
8. Grasp the DRAM module, being careful not to touch any electrical components  
on the module, and firmly pull it out of the slot on the system board.  
9. Place the DRAM module on the antistatic mat or in the electrostatic bag.  
Replacing DRAM Modules  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
189  
     
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
Figure 90: Installing or Replacing DRAM Modules  
Installing a DRAM Module  
J2320, J2350, J4350 and J6350 Services Routers support 256-MB and 512-MB DRAM  
modules. Use only DRAM modules purchased from Juniper Networks specifically for  
your model.  
NOTE: If you are installing a second DRAM module, do not install it in a slot adjacent  
to the first module. For example, if the first DRAM module is installed in slot 1, install  
To install a DRAM module:  
1. Take the following steps if you have not already done so:  
a. Attach an electrostatic discharge (ESD) grounding strap to your bare wrist  
and connect the strap to the ESD point on the chassis, or to an outside ESD  
point if the router is disconnected from earth ground. For more information  
about ESD, see the Getting Started Guide for your router.  
b. Press and release the power button to power off the router. Wait for the  
POWER LED to turn off.  
c. Unplug the power cord or cable from the power source receptacle.  
d. Remove the screws from the sides and top of the chassis that secure the  
cover to the chassis.  
2. Remove the DRAM module from its electrostatic bag.  
3. Press the plastic ejectors on both sides of the DRAM slot to open it (see  
4. Grasp the DRAM module by the edges, being careful not to touch any electrical  
components.  
190  
Replacing DRAM Modules  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 10: Replacing Hardware Components  
5. Pressing firmly on both ends, push the module into the slot until the ejectors  
click into the closed position (see Figure 90 on page 190).  
6. Slide the cover onto the chassis.  
7. Replace and tighten the screws on the sides and top of the chassis that secure  
the cover to the chassis.  
8. Replace the power cord or cable.  
9.  
Press and release the power button to power on the router. Verify that the POWER  
LED lights steadily.  
10. To view the DRAM configuration and verify that it was installed correctly, issue  
the show chassis routing-engine command, described in the JUNOS System Basics  
and Services Command Reference. This command shows the total memory  
installed.  
Replacing Power System Components  
The power cords on all Services Routers are replaceable.  
You can add a second power supply to the J6350 Services Router that is of the same  
type as the first (either AC or DC). The power supplies are located at the right rear  
of the chassis (see Figure 15 on page 28 and Figure 17 on page 29). Each J6350  
power supply provides power to all components in the router. The J6350 power  
supplies are fully redundant. If one power supply fails or is removed, the remaining  
power supply instantly assumes the entire electrical load. One power supply can  
provide full power for as long as the router is operational.  
Each J6350 power supply is hot-insertable and hot-removable.  
CAUTION: Do not leave a power supply slot empty for more than a short time while  
the Services Router is operational. The power supply or a blank power supply panel  
must remain in the chassis for proper airflow.  
To replace power system components, use the following procedures:  
Replacing AC Power Supply Cords  
To replace the AC power cord for a redundant power supply:  
Replacing Power System Components  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
191  
           
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
1. Locate a replacement power cord with the type of plug appropriate for your  
2. Attach an electrostatic discharge (ESD) grounding strap to your bare wrist and  
connect the strap to the ESD point on the chassis, or to an outside ESD point if  
the router is disconnected from earth ground. For more information about ESD,  
3.  
Press and release the power button to power off the router. Wait for the POWER  
LED to turn off.  
NOTE: If the power supply is a redundant power supply in a J6350 Services Router,  
you can leave the router powered on and power flowing in the other power supply.  
4. Unplug the power cord from the power source receptacle.  
5. Unplug the power cord from the appliance inlet on the power supply faceplate.  
6. Insert the appliance coupler end of the replacement power cord into the appliance  
inlet on the power supply faceplate.  
7. Insert the power cord plug into an AC power source receptacle.  
NOTE: Each power supply must be connected to a dedicated AC power feed. For  
information about connecting to AC power sources, see Connecting  
8. Verify that the power cord does not block access to Services Router components  
or drape where people might trip on it.  
9.  
Press and release the power button to power on the router. Verify that the POWER  
LED lights steadily.  
Removing an AC Power Supply from J6350 Routers  
The power supplies are located at the right rear of the chassis. A power supply weighs  
2.4 lb (1.1 kg).  
To remove an AC power supply from a J6350 Services Router (see  
1. Attach an electrostatic discharge (ESD) grounding strap to your bare wrist and  
connect the strap to the ESD point on the chassis, or to an outside ESD point if  
the router is disconnected from earth ground. For more information about ESD,  
2. Press and release the power button to power off the Services Router. Wait for  
the POWER LED to turn off.  
192  
Replacing Power System Components  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 10: Replacing Hardware Components  
NOTE: If the power supply is a redundant power supply in a J6350 Service Router,  
you can leave the router powered on and power flowing in the other power supply.  
3. Unplug the power cord from the power source receptacle.  
4. Unplug the power cord from the appliance inlet on the power supply faceplate.  
5. Slide the ejector tab on the power supply faceplate to the right and hold it in  
place to unlock the power supply.  
6. Grasp the handle on the power supply faceplate, and pull firmly to start removing  
7. Place one hand underneath the power supply to support it and slide it completely  
out of the chassis.  
8. If you are not reinstalling a power supply into the emptied slot, install a blank  
power supply panel over the slot.  
Figure 91: Removing an AC Power Supply  
Installing an AC Power Supply in J6350 Routers  
1. Attach an electrostatic discharge (ESD) grounding strap to your bare wrist and  
connect the strap to the ESD point on the chassis, or to an outside ESD point if  
the router is disconnected from earth ground. For more information about ESD,  
2. Using both hands, slide the power supply into the chassis until you feel resistance.  
3. Firmly push the power supply into the chassis until it comes to a stop. Make sure  
that the power supply faceplate is flush with any adjacent power supply faceplate.  
4. Insert the appliance coupler end of a power cord into the appliance inlet on the  
power supply faceplate.  
5. Insert the power cord plug into an AC power source receptacle.  
Replacing Power System Components  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
193  
     
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
NOTE: Each power supply must be connected to a dedicated AC power feed. For  
information about connecting to AC power sources, see Connecting  
6. Verify that the power cord does not block access to router components or drape  
where people might trip on it.  
7.  
Press and release the power button to power on the router. Verify that the POWER  
LED lights steadily.  
Figure 92: Installing an AC Power Supply  
Replacing DC Power Supply Cables  
To replace a power cable for a DC power supply:  
1. Locate a replacement power cable and a lug that meet the specifications defined  
CAUTION: A licensed electrician must attach a cable lug to the power cable that you  
supply. A cable with an incorrectly attached lug can damage the router (for example,  
by causing a short circuit).  
2. Attach an electrostatic discharge (ESD) grounding strap to your bare wrist and  
connect the strap to the ESD point on the chassis, or to an outside ESD point if  
the router is disconnected from earth ground. For more information about ESD,  
3. Press and release the power button to power off the Services Router. Wait for  
the POWER LED to turn off.  
4. Ensure that the voltage across the DC power source cable leads is 0 V and that  
the cable leads cannot become active during installation.  
194  
Replacing Power System Components  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Chapter 10: Replacing Hardware Components  
CAUTION: You must ensure that power connections maintain the proper polarity.  
The power source cables might be labeled (+) and () to indicate their polarity. There  
is no standard color coding for DC power cables. The color coding used by the external  
DC power source at your site determines the color coding for the leads on the power  
cables that attach to the terminal studs on each power supply.  
5. Remove the power cable from the DC power source.  
6. Use a Phillips screwdriver to remove the clear plastic cover protecting the terminal  
block.  
7. Within the terminal block, remove the screw that fastens the power cable lug to  
the terminal block.  
8. Carefully move the power cable out of the way.  
9. Using the removed screw, secure the replacement power cable (see 1) to the  
appropriate terminal. Tighten the screw until snug. Do not overtighten.  
The screw contains a captive washer used to secure the power cable lug to the  
terminal block.  
NOTE: Each power supply must be connected to a dedicated DC power feed. For  
information about connecting to DC power sources, see Connecting  
10. Dress the power cable appropriately.  
11. Replace the clear plastic cover over the terminal block.  
12. Verify that the power cable does not block access to router components or drape  
where people might trip on it.  
13.  
Press and release the power button to power on the router. Verify that the POWER  
LED lights steadily.  
Removing a DC Power Supply  
The power supplies are located at the right rear of the chassis. A power supply weighs  
2.4 lb (1.1 kg).  
To remove a DC power supply (see Figure 93 on page 196):  
1. Attach an electrostatic discharge (ESD) grounding strap to your bare wrist and  
connect the strap to the ESD point on the chassis, or to an outside ESD point if  
the router is disconnected from earth ground. For more information about ESD,  
2. Press and release the power button to power off the Services Router. Wait for  
the POWER LED to turn off.  
3. Ensure that the voltage across the DC power source cable leads is 0 V and that  
the cable leads cannot become active during installation.  
Replacing Power System Components  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
195  
   
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
CAUTION: You must ensure that power connections maintain the proper polarity.  
The power source cables might be labeled (+) and () to indicate their polarity. There  
is no standard color coding for DC power cables. The color coding used by the external  
DC power source at your site determines the color coding for the leads on the power  
cables that attach to the terminal studs on each power supply.  
4. Remove the power cables from the DC power source.  
5. Use a Phillips screwdriver to remove the clear plastic cover protecting the terminal  
block.  
6. Within the terminal block, remove the screws that fasten the power cable lugs  
to the terminal block.  
7. Carefully move the power cables out of the way.  
8. Slide the ejector tab on the power supply faceplate to the right, and hold it in  
place to unlock the power supply.  
9. Grasp the handle on the power supply faceplate, and pull firmly to start removing  
10. Place one hand underneath the power supply to support it, and slide it completely  
out of the chassis.  
11. If you are not reinstalling a power supply into the emptied slot, install a blank  
power supply panel over the slot.  
Figure 93: Removing a DC Power Supply  
Installing a DC Power Supply  
Each power supply in a DC-powered router must be connected to earth ground. A  
ground terminal is provided on each DC power supply for this purpose.  
To install a DC power supply (see Figure 94 on page 198):  
196  
Replacing Power System Components  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 10: Replacing Hardware Components  
1. Ensure that the voltage across the DC power source cable leads is 0 V and that  
the cable leads cannot become active during installation.  
CAUTION: You must ensure that power connections maintain the proper polarity.  
The power source cables might be labeled (+) and () to indicate their polarity. There  
is no standard color coding for DC power cables. The color coding used by the external  
DC power source at your site determines the color coding for the leads on the power  
cables that attach to the terminal studs on each power supply.  
2. Attach an electrostatic discharge (ESD) grounding strap to your bare wrist and  
connect the strap to the ESD point on the chassis, or to an outside ESD point if  
the router is disconnected from earth ground. For more information about ESD,  
3. Using both hands, slide the power supply into the chassis until you feel resistance.  
4. Firmly push the power supply into the chassis until it comes to a stop. Make sure  
that the power supply faceplate is flush with any adjacent power supply faceplate.  
5. Use a Phillips screwdriver to remove the clear plastic cover protecting the terminal  
block.  
6. Within the terminal block, remove the two center screws next to the labels  
48 VDC and RTN.  
Each screw contains a captive washer to secure a power cable lug to the terminal  
block.  
7. Using one of the removed screws, secure the positive (+) DC source power cable  
lug to the RTN terminal. Tighten the screw until snug. Do not overtighten. Apply  
between 8 lb-in. (0.9 Nm) and 9 lb-in. (1.02 Nm) of torque to the screw.  
8. Using the other removed screw, secure the negative () DC source power cable  
lug to the 48 VDC terminal. Tighten the screw until snug. Do not overtighten.  
Apply between 8 lb-in. (0.9 Nm) and 9 lb-in. (1.02 Nm) of torque to the screw.  
NOTE: Each power supply must be connected to a dedicated DC power feed. For  
information about connecting to DC power sources, see Connecting  
9. Dress the power cables appropriately.  
10. Replace the clear plastic cover over the terminal block.  
11. Verify that the power cord does not block access to router components or drape  
where people might trip on it.  
12.  
Press and release the power button to power on the router. Verify that the POWER  
LED lights steadily.  
Replacing Power System Components  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
197  
 
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
Figure 94: Installing a DC Power Supply  
Replacing Crypto Accelerator Modules on J2320 and J2350 Routers  
The Crypto Accelerator Module is a processor card that enhances performance of  
cryptographic algorithms used in IP security (IPSec) services. The Crypto Module is  
an optional feature on J2320 and J2350 Services Routers.  
Figure 95 on page 198 shows the location of the Crypto Accelerator Module on J2320  
and J2350 routers.  
Figure 95: Crypto Accelerator Module Location on J2320 and J2350 Routers  
To remove or install a Crypto Accelerator Module, use the following procedures:  
198  
Replacing Crypto Accelerator Modules on J2320 and J2350 Routers  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 10: Replacing Hardware Components  
Removing a J2320 or J2350 Crypto Accelerator Module  
NOTE: If you are installing a Crypto Accelerator Module into a J2320 or J2350 Services  
Router for the first time, proceed directly to Installing a J2320 or J2350 Crypto  
To remove the Crypto Accelerator Module:  
1. Place an electrostatic bag or antistatic mat on a flat stable surface to receive the  
Crypto Module.  
2. Attach an electrostatic discharge (ESD) grounding strap to your bare wrist and  
connect the strap to the ESD point on the chassis, or to an outside ESD point if  
the router is disconnected from earth ground. For more information about ESD,  
3. Press and release the power button to power off the Services Router. Wait for  
the POWER LED to turn off.  
4. Unplug the power cord or cable from the power source receptacle.  
5. Remove the chassis cover. (See Removing and Replacing the Chassis Cover on  
6. Locate the Crypto Module on the system board (see Figure 95 on page 198).  
7. Using a Phillips screwdriver, remove the three screws from top of the Crypto  
Accerator Module, as shown in Figure 96 on page 199.  
Figure 96: Removing a J2320 or J2350 Crypto Module  
8. Gently lift the Crypto Module to disengage it from the connector on the system  
board, as shown in Figure 96 on page 199.  
9. Place the Crypto Module on the antistatic mat or in the electrostatic bag.  
Replacing Crypto Accelerator Modules on J2320 and J2350 Routers  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
199  
     
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
Installing a J2320 or J2350 Crypto Accelerator Module  
To install a Crypto Accelerator Module:  
1. Take the following steps if you have not already done so:  
a. Attach an electrostatic discharge (ESD) grounding strap to your bare wrist  
and connect the strap to the ESD point on the chassis, or to an outside ESD  
point if the router is disconnected from earth ground. For more information  
b. Press and release the power button to power off the Services Router. Wait  
for the POWER LED to turn off.  
c. Unplug the power cord or cable from the power source receptacle.  
2. Locate the Crypto Module connector on the system board (see  
3. Remove the Crypto Module from its electrostatic bag.  
4. Align the notches in the Crypto Module with the notches in the connector on the  
system board and push the Crypto Module down flat, as shown in  
Figure 97: Installing a J2320 or J2350 Crypto Accelerator Module  
5. Insert the three screws and tighten them until snug. Do not overtighten.  
6. Replace the chassis cover. (See Removing and Replacing the Chassis Cover on  
7. Replace the power cord or cable.  
200  
Replacing Crypto Accelerator Modules on J2320 and J2350 Routers  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 10: Replacing Hardware Components  
8.  
9.  
Press and release the power button to power on the router. Verify that the POWER  
LED lights steadily.  
Verify that the Crypto Module is correctly installed by issuing the show chassis  
hardware command, as shown in the following example:  
user@host> show chassis hardware  
user@host> show chassis hardware  
Hardware inventory:  
Item  
Chassis  
Version Part number Serial number  
JN1092BAEADB  
Description  
J6350  
Midplane  
System IO  
Crypto Module  
Acceleration  
Routing Engine  
FPC 0  
REV 03  
REV 01  
710-014593  
710-016210  
NR2489  
NL3304  
JX350 System IO  
Crypto  
REV 08  
REV 00  
710-015273  
750-015152  
NM4265  
RE-J6350-3400  
FPC  
4x GE Base PIC  
FPC  
PIC 0  
FPC 6  
PIC 0  
Xcvr 0  
Xcvr 2  
6x GE SFP uPIM  
SFP-SX  
SFP-SX  
NON-JNPR  
NON-JNPR  
PC14DP3  
PC21M3E  
Power Supply 0  
If Crypto Module appears in the output, the Crypto Accelerator Module is installed  
correctly.  
Replacing Crypto Accelerator Modules on J4350 and J6350 Routers  
The Crypto Accelerator Module is a processor card that enhances performance of  
cryptographic algorithms used in IP security (IPSec) services. The Crypto Module is  
a standard feature on J6350 Services Routers and an optional feature on the J4350  
Services Routers.  
Figure 98 on page 202 shows the location of the Crypto Accelerator Module.  
Replacing Crypto Accelerator Modules on J4350 and J6350 Routers  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
201  
     
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
Figure 98: Crypto Accelerator Module Location on J4350 and J6350 Routers  
To modify a Crypto Accelerator Module configuration, use the following procedures:  
Removing a J4350 or J6350 Crypto Accelerator Module  
NOTE: If you are installing a Crypto Accelerator Module into a J4350 Services Router  
To remove the Crypto Accelerator Module:  
1. Place an electrostatic bag or antistatic mat on a flat stable surface to receive the  
Crypto Module.  
2. Attach an electrostatic discharge (ESD) grounding strap to your bare wrist and  
connect the strap to the ESD point on the chassis, or to an outside ESD point if  
the router is disconnected from earth ground. For more information about ESD,  
3. Press and release the power button to power off the Services Router. Wait for  
the POWER LED to turn off.  
4. Unplug the power cord or cable from the power source receptacle.  
5. Remove the screws from the sides and the top of the chassis, and slide the cover  
off the chassis.  
202  
Replacing Crypto Accelerator Modules on J4350 and J6350 Routers  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 10: Replacing Hardware Components  
6. Locate the Crypto Module on the system board (see Figure 98 on page 202).  
Figure 99: Removing a J4350 or J6350 Crypto Module Screw  
8. Pull the white release clips on either side of the Crypto Module out to either side,  
as shown in Figure 100 on page 203, to tilt the Crypto Module upward.  
Figure 100: Removing and Installing a J4350 or J6350 Crypto Accelerator Module  
9. Slide the Crypto Module out of its socket.  
10. Remove the standoff washer that was under the Crypto Module.  
11. Place the Crypto Module on the antistatic mat or in the electrostatic bag.  
Replacing Crypto Accelerator Modules on J4350 and J6350 Routers  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
203  
   
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
Installing a J4350 or j6350 Crypto Accelerator Module  
To install a Crypto Accelerator Module:  
1. Take the following steps if you have not already done so:  
a. Attach an electrostatic discharge (ESD) grounding strap to your bare wrist  
and connect the strap to the ESD point on the chassis, or to an outside ESD  
point if the router is disconnected from earth ground. For more information  
b. Press and release the power button to power off the Services Router. Wait  
for the POWER LED to turn off.  
c. Unplug the power cord or cable from the power source receptacle.  
d. Remove the screws from the sides and the top of the chassis, and slide the  
cover off the chassis.  
The socket is tipped up at an angle when empty.  
remove them.  
4. Remove the Crypto Module from its electrostatic bag and insert it into the socket.  
5. Push the Crypto Module down flat against the main board until the release clips  
click into place, as shown in Figure 100 on page 203.  
6. Insert the standoff washer under the Crypto Module.  
7. Insert the screw and tighten it until snug. Do not overtighten.  
8. Slide the cover onto the router, and replace and tighten the cover screws.  
9. Replace the power cord or cable.  
10.  
Press and release the power button to power on the router. Verify that the POWER  
LED lights steadily.  
11.  
Verify that the Crypto Module is correctly installed by issuing the show chassis  
hardware command, as shown in the following example:  
user@host> show chassis hardware  
Hardware inventory:  
Item  
Chassis  
Version Part number Serial number  
JN1092BAEADB  
Description  
J6350  
Midplane  
System IO  
Crypto Module  
Acceleration  
Routing Engine  
FPC 0  
REV 03  
REV 01  
710-014593  
710-016210  
NR2489  
NL3304  
JX350 System IO  
Crypto  
REV 08  
REV 00  
710-015273  
750-015152  
NM4265  
RE-J6350-3400  
FPC  
4x GE Base PIC  
FPC  
PIC 0  
FPC 6  
PIC 0  
Xcvr 0  
Xcvr 2  
6x GE SFP uPIM  
SFP-SX  
SFP-SX  
NON-JNPR  
NON-JNPR  
PC14DP3  
PC21M3E  
Power Supply 0  
204  
Replacing Crypto Accelerator Modules on J4350 and J6350 Routers  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 10: Replacing Hardware Components  
If Crypto Module appears in the output, the Crypto Accelerator Module is installed  
correctly.  
Replacing Air Filters on J2350 Routers  
The cooling fans on J2350 routers draw air through vents along the left side of the  
chassis and exhaust it through vents on the right side of the chassis. For more  
On J2350 routers that comply with Network Equipment Building System (NEBS)  
criteria, the air intake grid contains a filter. To verify that the system is a  
NEBS-compliant system, run the show chassis hardware command. A NEBS-compliant  
system displays the term NEBS in the output.  
We recommend changing the filter every 6 months. However, the optimal filter  
replacement interval can vary depending on the environment where the router is  
located. If temperature alarms appear, inspect the air filter.  
To replace the air filter:  
1. Loosen the filter tray thumbscrew at the rear of the J2350 chassis.  
2. Hold the screw firmly and pull it away from the chassis until you have pulled the  
attached filter tray out of the chassis (see Figure 101 on page 205).  
Figure 101: Removing the Air Filter Tray  
3. Hook-and-loop fasteners on the base of the filter tray hold the air filter inside  
the tray. Grasp the air filter with your fingers and gently pull it away from the  
filter tray.  
4. Set the old air filter aside.  
5. Place the new filter so that its edge aligns with the first hook-and-loop fastener  
Replacing Air Filters on J2350 Routers  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
205  
     
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
Figure 102: Placing the Air Filter on the Air Filter Tray  
6. Press down on the filter until it is firmly seated against the bottom of the tray.  
7. Hold the filter tray with the thumbscrew so that its sheet metal side faces the  
power supply fan exhaust. The air filter tray is designed to prevent it from being  
inserted incorrectly (see Figure 103 on page 206).  
Figure 103: Inserting the Air Filter Tray on J2350 Routers  
8. Slide the tray fully into the air filter opening.  
9. Tighten the thumbscrew to the chassis.  
Replacing Air Filters on J4350 and J6350 Routers  
The front panel of J4350 and J6350 Services Routers contains an air intake grid with  
a protective cover and a filter, as shown in Figure 104 on page 207.  
206  
Replacing Air Filters on J4350 and J6350 Routers  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 10: Replacing Hardware Components  
Figure 104: Attaching Air Filter and Filter Cover  
We recommend changing the filter every 6 months. However, the optimal filter  
replacement interval can vary depending on the environment where the router is  
located. If temperature alarms appear, inspect the air filter.  
To replace the air filter:  
1. Remove the filter cover by squeezing the plastic tabs on either side of the filter  
cover.  
2. Pull the filter cover away from the chassis.  
3. Remove the old filter.  
4. Place the new filter in the opening.  
5. Replace the filter cover by pressing it until it clicks into place.  
Replacing Air Filters on J4350 and J6350 Routers  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
207  
 
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
208  
Replacing Air Filters on J4350 and J6350 Routers  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 11  
Troubleshooting Hardware Components  
This chapter contains the following topics:  
Chassis Alarm Conditions  
You can monitor alarms to troubleshoot hardware problems on a Services Router.  
Alarms alert you to conditions on the router chassis, or in the system software that  
might prevent the router from operating normally. You can monitor active alarms  
from the J-Web interface or the CLI.  
Services Router alarms warn you about conditions that can prevent the router from  
operating normally. Chassis and system alarm conditions are preset. When the  
Routing Engine detects an alarm condition, it lights the ALARM LED on the front  
panel. When the condition is corrected, the light turns off.  
To view a more detailed description of the alarm cause, issue the show chassis alarms  
CLI command:  
user@host> show chassis alarms  
Table 70 on page 209 describes alarms that can occur for a chassis component such  
as the Routing Engine or a Physical Interface Module (PIM).  
Table 70: Chassis Alarm Conditions and Corrective Actions  
Component  
Alarm Conditions  
Corrective Action  
Alarm Severity  
Alternative boot media  
The Services Router boots from Typically, the router boots from the  
Yellow (minor)  
an alternative boot device.  
internal compact flash. If you  
configured your router to boot from  
an alternative boot device, ignore this  
alarm condition.  
If you did not configure the router to  
boot from an alternative boot device,  
contact JTAC. (See Requesting  
Chassis Alarm Conditions  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
209  
           
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
Table 70: Chassis Alarm Conditions and Corrective Actions (continued)  
Component  
Alarm Conditions  
Corrective Action  
Alarm Severity  
PIM  
A PIM has failed.  
Replace the failed PIM. (See  
Red (major)  
When a PIM fails, it attempts  
to reboot. If the Routing Engine  
detects that a PIM is rebooting  
too often, it shuts down the  
PIM.  
Routing Engine  
An error occurred during the  
process of reading or writing  
compact flash.  
Reformat the compact flash and  
install a bootable image. (See the  
J-series Services Router Administration  
Guide.)  
Yellow (minor)  
If this remedy fails, you must replace  
the failed Routing Engine. To contact  
Routing Engine temperature is  
too warm.  
Check the room temperature.  
Yellow (minor)  
you must replace a fan or the  
Routing Engine, contact JTAC.  
Check the air filter and replace  
it if it appears clogged. (See  
Routing Engine fan has failed. Replace the failed fan. To contact  
Red (major)  
Troubleshooting Power Management  
If one or more PIMs remain offline when you power on the chassis, the combination  
of PIMs installed might exceed the power and heat capacity of the chassis. For  
information about the maximum power and heat tokens permitted for each chassis,  
210  
Troubleshooting Power Management  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
               
Chapter 11: Troubleshooting Hardware Components  
To bring the PIM online:  
1. Check if the PIM exceeds the power and heat tokens permitted by issuing the  
show chassis fpc and show chassis power-ratings CLI commands:  
user@host> show chassis fpc  
Temp CPU Utilization (%)  
Memory  
Utilization (%)  
DRAM (MB) Heap  
Slot State  
0 Online  
1 Empty  
(C) Total Interrupt  
Buffer  
-------------------- CPU less FPC --------------------  
--------------------- Not Usable ---------------------  
-------------------- CPU less FPC --------------------  
2 Online  
3 Empty  
4 Empty  
5 Online  
-------------------- CPU less FPC --------------------  
6 Empty  
In this example, J-series power management has placed the PIM in slot 5 in an  
offline state to prevent damage. If brought online, the PIM would cause the  
combination of PIMs to exceed the maximum limit of 83 high-power tokens for  
the J2350 router.  
user@host> show chassis power-ratings  
Device  
Low  
High  
Power  
Heat  
Power  
Ratings  
Total Tokens  
FPC 1  
FPC 2  
FPC 3  
FPC 4  
83  
6
3
3
0
83  
27  
27  
27  
0
83  
21  
18  
18  
0
-
OK  
OK  
OK  
OK  
FPC 5  
Tokens Used  
2
14  
27  
108  
2
59  
Exceeded  
-
NOTE: In the show chassis power-ratings command output, the PIM slot number is  
reported as an FPC number.  
The offline PIM is not powered off and continues to draw minimal power.  
2. To bring the PIM online, you have the following options:  
Remove one or more PIMs from the chassis. This option requires that you  
power off the router. For more information about removing PIMs, see  
Bring the PIM online without powering off the router. To do so, use the set  
chassis fpc offline command to set another PIM slot in the chassis to the  
offline state. For example:  
Troubleshooting Power Management  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
211  
 
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
user@host# set chassis fpc 2 offline  
If the power and heat tokens no longer exceed the maximum, the PIMs that  
were placed offline by J-series power management are brought online  
automatically.  
Use the set chassis disable-power-management command to disable J-series  
power management:  
user@host# set chassis disable-power-management  
CAUTION: Use extreme caution when disabling J-series power management. To  
prevent equipment damage, do not install a combination of PIMs that exceeds the  
power or heat capacity of your router when J-series power management is disabled.  
The set chassis disable-power-management command brings the offline PIMs  
online automatically.  
To reenable J-series power management, remove the set chassis  
disable-power-management command from the configuration. For detailed information  
about the set chassis fpc offline and set chassis disable-power-management commands,  
see the JUNOS System Basics Configuration Guide.  
Contacting the Juniper Networks Technical Assistance Center  
If you need assistance while troubleshooting a Services Router, open a support case  
using the Case Manager link at http://www.juniper.net/support/, or call 1-888-314-JTAC  
(within the United States) or 1-408-745-9500 (from outside the United States). For  
212  
Contacting the Juniper Networks Technical Assistance Center  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 12  
Contacting Customer Support and  
Returning Hardware  
This chapter describes how to return the Services Router or individual components  
to Juniper Networks for repair or replacement. It contains the following topics:  
Locating Component Serial Numbers  
Before contacting Juniper Networks to request a Return Materials Authorization  
(RMA), you must find the serial number on the router or component. To list the router  
components and their serial numbers, enter the following command-line interface  
(CLI) command:  
user@host> show chassis hardware  
Hardware inventory:  
Item  
Chassis  
Version Part number Serial number  
JN1092BAEADB  
Description  
J6350  
Midplane  
System IO  
Crypto Module  
Routing Engine  
FPC 0  
REV 03  
REV 01  
710-014593  
710-016210  
NR2489  
NL3304  
JX350 System IO  
Crypto Acceleration  
RE-J6350-3400  
FPC  
4x GE Base PIC  
FPC  
REV 08  
REV 00  
710-015273  
750-015152  
NM4265  
PIC 0  
FPC 6  
PIC 0  
Xcvr 0  
Xcvr 2  
6x GE SFP uPIM  
SFP-SX  
SFP-SX  
NON-JNPR  
NON-JNPR  
PC14DP3  
PC21M3E  
Power Supply 0  
NOTE: In the show chassis hardware command, the PIM slot number is reported as  
an FPC number and the PIM number (always 0) is reported as the PIC number.  
Most components also have a serial number ID label attached to the component  
body.  
Locating Component Serial Numbers  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
213  
             
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
The following sections describe the label location on each type of component:  
J2320 and J2350 Chassis Serial Number and Agency Labels  
J2320 and J2350 Services Routers have serial number ID labels located on the back  
of the chassis, as shown in Figure 105 on page 214, and an agency label on the bottom  
of the chassis, as shown in Figure 106 on page 214.  
Figure 105: Location of the Serial Number ID Labels  
Figure 106: Location of the Agency Labels  
214  
Locating Component Serial Numbers  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 12: Contacting Customer Support and Returning Hardware  
J4350 and J6350 Chassis Serial Number and Agency Labels  
J4350 and J6350 Services Routers have serial number ID labels on the back of the  
chassis, as shown in Figure 107 on page 215, and an agency label on the bottom front  
corner, as shown in Figure 108 on page 215.  
Figure 107: Location of Serial Number ID Labels  
Figure 108: Location of the Agency Labels  
Locating Component Serial Numbers  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
215  
     
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
PIM Serial Number Label  
PIMs are field-replaceable. Each PIM has a unique serial number. The serial number  
label is located on the right side of the PIM, when the PIM is horizontally oriented  
(as it would be installed in the router). The exact location might be slightly different  
on different PIMs, depending on the placement of components on the PIM board.  
Power Supply Serial Number Labels  
The power supplies installed in the J6350 Services Router are field-replaceable. Each  
power supply has a unique serial number. The serial number label is located on the  
top of the power supply.  
Contacting Customer Support  
After you have located the serial numbers of the components you need to return,  
contact Juniper Networks Technical Assistance Center (JTAC) in one of the following  
ways.  
You can contact JTAC 24 hours a day, seven days a week.  
On the Web, using the Case Manager link at http://www.juniper.net/support/  
By telephone:  
From the US and Canada: 1-888-314-JTAC  
From all other locations: 1-408-745-9500  
If contacting JTAC by telephone, enter your 11-digit case number followed by the  
pound (#) key if this is an existing case, or press the star (*) key to be routed to the  
next available support engineer.  
Information You Might Need to Supply to JTAC  
When requesting support from JTAC by telephone, be prepared to provide the  
following information:  
Your existing case number, if you have one  
Details of the failure or problem  
Type of activity being performed on the router when the problem occurred  
Configuration data displayed by one or more show commands  
Return Procedure  
If the problem cannot be resolved by the JTAC technician a Return Materials  
Authorization (RMA) number is issued. This number is used to track the returned  
material at the factory and to return repaired or new components to the customer  
as needed.  
216  
Contacting Customer Support  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                     
Chapter 12: Contacting Customer Support and Returning Hardware  
NOTE: Do not return any component to Juniper Networks unless you have first  
obtained an RMA number. Juniper Networks reserves the right to refuse shipments  
that do not have an RMA. Refused shipments are returned to the customer via collect  
freight.  
For more information about return and repair policies, see the customer support  
For product problems or technical support issues, open a support case using the Case  
Manager link at http://www.juniper.net/support/, or call 1-888-314-JTAC (within the  
United States) or 1-408-745-9500 (outside the United States).  
When you need to return a component:  
1. Determine the part number and serial number of the component. For instructions,  
2. Obtain an RMA number from JTAC.  
3. Provide the following information:  
Part number and serial number of component  
Your name, organization name, telephone number, fax number, and shipping  
address  
Description of the failure  
The support representative validates your request and issues an RMA number  
for return of the component.  
4. Pack the router or component for shipment, as described in Packing a Router  
Packing a Router or Component for Shipment  
This section contains the following topics:  
Tools and Parts Required  
To remove components from the router or the router from a rack, you need the  
following tools and parts:  
Blank panels to cover empty slots  
Electrostatic bag or antistatic mat, for each component  
Electrostatic discharge (ESD) grounding wrist strap  
Packing a Router or Component for Shipment  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
217  
         
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
Flat-blade screwdriver, approximately 1/4 in. (6 mm)  
Phillips (+) screwdrivers, numbers 1 and 2  
Packing the Services Router for Shipment  
To pack the router for shipment, follow this procedure:  
1. Retrieve the shipping carton and packing materials in which the router was  
originally shipped. If you do not have these materials, contact your Juniper  
Networks representative about approved packaging materials.  
2. Attach an electrostatic discharge (ESD) grounding strap to your bare wrist and  
connect the strap to the ESD point on the chassis, or to an outside ESD point if  
the router is disconnected from earth ground. For more information about ESD,  
3. On the console or other management device connected to the master Routing  
Engine, enter CLI operational mode and issue the following command to shut  
down the router software.  
user@host> request system halt  
Wait until a message appears on the console confirming that the operating system  
has halted. For more information about the command, see the J-series Services  
Router Administration Guide.  
4. Shut down power to the router by pressing the power button on the front panel  
of the router.  
5. Disconnect power from the router. For instructions, see Replacing AC Power  
6. Remove the cables that connect to all external devices. For instructions, see  
7. Remove all field-replaceable units (FRUs) from the router.  
8. If the router is installed on a wall or rack, have one person support the weight  
of the router, while another person unscrews and removes the mounting screws.  
9. Place the router in the shipping carton.  
10. Cover the router with an ESD bag, and place the packing foam on top of and  
around the router.  
11. Replace the accessory box on top of the packing foam.  
12. Securely tape the box closed.  
13. Write the RMA number on the exterior of the box to ensure proper tracking.  
Packing Components for Shipment  
To pack and ship individual components, follow these guidelines:  
218  
Packing a Router or Component for Shipment  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 12: Contacting Customer Support and Returning Hardware  
When you return components, make sure they are adequately protected with  
packing materials and packed so that the pieces are prevented from moving  
around inside the carton.  
Use the original shipping materials if they are available.  
Place individual boards in electrostatic bags.  
Write the RMA number on the exterior of the box to ensure proper tracking.  
CAUTION: Do not stack any of the router components.  
Packing a Router or Component for Shipment  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
219  
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
220  
Packing a Router or Component for Shipment  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Part 4  
J-series Requirements and Specifications  
J-series Requirements and Specifications  
221  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
222  
J-series Requirements and Specifications  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 13  
Network Cable Specifications and  
Connector Pinouts  
The network interfaces supported on the router accept different kinds of network  
cable.  
Serial PIM Cable Specifications  
The 2-port serial PIM uses the cables and connectors summarized in  
Table 71 on page 223. Pinouts are detailed in Table 72 on page 224 through  
Table 71: 2-Port Serial PIM Cables and Connectors  
End-to-End  
Conductors  
Name  
Connector  
Connector Hardware  
Pinouts  
RS-232 DTE  
DB-25 male  
4-40 threaded  
jackscrews  
13  
RS-232 DCE  
DB-25 female  
4-40 threaded jacknuts  
13  
25  
RS-422/449 (EIA-449)  
DTE  
DC-37 (DB-37) male  
4-40 threaded  
jackscrews  
RS-422/449 (EIA-449)  
DCE  
DC-37 (DB-37) female  
4-40 threaded jacknuts  
25  
Serial PIM Cable Specifications  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
223  
         
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
Table 71: 2-Port Serial PIM Cables and Connectors (continued)  
End-to-End  
Conductors  
Name  
Connector  
Connector Hardware  
Pinouts  
EIA-530A DTE  
DB-25 male  
4-40 threaded  
jackscrews  
23  
EIA-530A DCE  
V.35 DTE  
DB-25 female  
M/34 male  
4-40 threaded jacknuts  
22  
18  
Standard (Normally  
included with M/34  
connector shell)  
V.35 DCE  
M/34 female  
Standard (Normally  
included with M/34  
connector shell)  
18  
X.21 DTE  
X.21 DCE  
DB-15 male  
M3 threaded jackscrews 13  
M3 threaded jacknuts 13  
DB-15 female  
RS-232 DTE Cable Pinout  
Table 72: RS-232 DTE Cable Pinout  
LFH-60 Pin  
DB-25 Pin  
LFH-60 Pairing  
Description  
15  
60  
1
1
Frame Ground  
Transmit Data  
Receive Data  
Request to Send  
Clear to Send  
Data Set Ready  
Signal Ground  
Data Carrier Detect  
Transmit Clock  
Receive Clock  
Local Loopback  
Data Terminal Ready  
Terminal Clock  
2
3
48  
37  
9
4
5
6
57  
13  
56  
5
7
8
15  
17  
18  
20  
24  
41  
33  
52  
22 to 21  
224  
Serial PIM Cable Specifications  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 13: Network Cable Specifications and Connector Pinouts  
Table 72: RS-232 DTE Cable Pinout (continued)  
LFH-60 Pin  
DB-25 Pin  
LFH-60 Pairing  
Description  
18 to 17  
RS-232 DCE Cable Pinout  
Table 73: RS-232 DCE Cable Pinout  
LFH-60 Pin  
DB-25 Pin  
LFH-60 Pairing  
Description  
15  
1
1
Frame Ground  
Transmit Data  
Receive Data  
Request to Send  
Clear to Send  
Data Set Ready  
Signal Ground  
Data Carrier Detect  
Transmit Clock  
Receive Clock  
Local Loopback  
Data Terminal Ready  
Terminal Clock  
2
60  
37  
48  
33  
57  
13  
56  
52  
45  
9
3
4
5
6
7
8
15  
17  
18  
20  
24  
5
22 to 21  
RS-422/449 (EIA-449) DTE Cable Pinout  
Table 74: RS-422/449 (EIA-449) DTE Cable Pinout  
LFH-60 Pin  
DC-37 (DB-37) Pin  
LFH-60 Pairing  
Description  
15  
60  
56  
1
4
5
Shield Ground  
Send Data (A)  
Send Timing (A)  
59  
55  
Serial PIM Cable Specifications  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
225  
           
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
Table 74: RS-422/449 (EIA-449) DTE Cable Pinout (continued)  
LFH-60 Pin  
DC-37 (DB-37) Pin  
LFH-60 Pairing  
Description  
1
6
2
Receive Data (A)  
Request to Send (A)  
Receive Timing (A)  
Clear to Send (A)  
Local Loopback  
Data Mode (A)  
Terminal Ready (A)  
Receive Ready (A)  
Terminal Timing (A)  
Signal Ground  
48  
5
7
47  
6
8
37  
41  
9
9
38  
10  
11  
12  
13  
17  
19  
20  
22  
23  
24  
25  
26  
27  
29  
30  
31  
35  
37  
10  
34  
14  
51  
33  
13  
52  
36  
4
Receive Common  
Send Data (B)  
59  
55  
2
60  
56  
1
Send Timing (B)  
Receive Data (B)  
Request to Send (B)  
Receive Timing (B)  
Clear to Send (B)  
Data Mode (B)  
47  
6
48  
5
38  
10  
34  
14  
51  
57  
26 to 25  
18 to 17  
37  
9
33  
13  
52  
Terminal Ready (B)  
Receiver Ready (B)  
Terminal Timing (B)  
Send Common  
226  
Serial PIM Cable Specifications  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 13: Network Cable Specifications and Connector Pinouts  
RS-422/449 (EIA-449) DCE Cable Pinout  
Table 75: RS-422/449 (EIA-449) DCE Cable Pinout  
LFH-60 Pin  
DC-37 (DB-37) Pin  
LFH-60 Pairing  
Description  
15  
1
1
Shield Ground  
4
2
Send Data (A)  
56  
60  
37  
52  
48  
45  
33  
9
5
55  
59  
38  
51  
47  
Send Timing (A)  
Receive Data (A)  
Request to Send (A)  
Receive Timing (A)  
Clear to Send (A)  
Local Loopback  
Data Mode (A)  
6
7
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
17  
19  
20  
22  
23  
24  
25  
26  
27  
29  
30  
31  
35  
37  
34  
10  
14  
6
Terminal Ready (A)  
Receive Ready (A)  
Terminal Timing (A)  
Signal Ground  
13  
5
36  
4
Receive Common  
Send Data (B)  
2
1
55  
59  
38  
51  
47  
34  
10  
14  
6
56  
60  
37  
52  
48  
33  
9
Send Timing (B)  
Receive Data (B)  
Request to Send (B)  
Receive Timing (B)  
Clear to Send (B)  
Data Mode (B)  
Terminal Ready (B)  
Receiver Ready (B)  
Terminal Timing (B)  
Send Common  
13  
5
57  
26 to 25  
Serial PIM Cable Specifications  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
227  
     
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
EIA-530A DTE Cable Pinout  
Table 76: EIA-530A DTE Cable Pinout  
LFH-60 Pin  
DB-25 Pin  
LFH-60 Pairing  
Description  
15  
1
Shield Ground  
60  
2
59  
2
Transmit Data (A)  
Receive Data (A)  
Request to Send (A)  
Clear to Send (A)  
Data Set Ready (A)  
Signal Ground  
1
3
48  
4
47  
38  
37  
5
9
6
57  
7
13  
8
14  
5
Received Line Signal Detector (A)  
Receive Clock (B)  
Received Line Signal Detector (B)  
Terminal Timing (B)  
Transmit Clock (B)  
Clear to Send (B)  
Transmit Data (B)  
Transmit Clock (A)  
Receive Data (B)  
Receive Clock (A)  
Local Loopback  
Request to Send (B)  
Data Terminal Ready (A)  
Signal Ground  
6
9
14  
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
16  
17  
18  
19  
20  
23  
24  
13  
52  
56  
37  
60  
55  
1
51  
55  
38  
59  
56  
2
5
6
41  
47  
48  
33  
4
52  
51  
Terminal Timing (A)  
26 to 25  
30 to 29  
18 to 17  
228  
Serial PIM Cable Specifications  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 13: Network Cable Specifications and Connector Pinouts  
EIA-530A DCE Cable Pinout  
Table 77: EIA-530A DCE Cable Pinout  
LFH-60 Pin  
DB-25 Pin  
LFH-60 Pairing  
Description  
15  
1
Shield Ground  
1
2
2
Transmit Data (A)  
Receive Data (A)  
Request to Send (A)  
Clear to Send (A)  
Data Set Ready (A)  
Signal Ground  
60  
3
59  
38  
47  
37  
4
48  
5
33  
6
57  
7
13  
8
14  
52  
13  
5
Received Line Signal Detector (A)  
Receive Clock (B)  
Received Line Signal Detector (B)  
Terminal Timing (B)  
Transmit Clock (B)  
Clear to Send (B)  
Transmit Data (B)  
Transmit Clock (A)  
Receive Data (B)  
Receive Clock (A)  
Local Loopback  
51  
9
14  
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
16  
17  
18  
19  
20  
23  
24  
6
55  
56  
48  
1
47  
2
56  
55  
60  
51  
59  
52  
45  
38  
37  
Request to Send (B)  
Data Terminal Ready (A)  
Signal Ground  
9
4
5
6
Terminal Timing (A)  
26 to 25  
30 to 29  
Serial PIM Cable Specifications  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
229  
     
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
V.35 DTE Cable Pinout  
Table 78: V.35 DTE Cable Pinout  
LFH-60 Pin  
M/34 Pin  
LFH-60 Pairing  
Description  
15  
A
B
C
D
E
Frame Ground  
Signal Ground  
Request to Send  
Clear to Send  
57  
48  
37  
9
Data Set Ready  
Received Line Signal Detector  
Data Terminal Ready  
Test Mode  
13  
F
33  
H
K
P
41  
60  
59  
2
Transmit Data (A)  
Receive Data (A)  
Transmit Data (B)  
Receive Data (B)  
Terminal Timing (A)  
Receive Timing (A)  
Terminal Timing (B)  
Receive Timing (B)  
Transmit Timing (A)  
Transmit Timing (B)  
1
R
S
59  
60  
1
2
T
52  
U
V
W
X
Y
AA  
51  
6
5
51  
52  
5
6
56  
55  
56  
55  
22 to 21  
26 to 25  
18 to 17  
230  
Serial PIM Cable Specifications  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 13: Network Cable Specifications and Connector Pinouts  
V.35 DCE Cable Pinout  
Table 79: V.35 DCE Cable Pinout  
LFH-60 Pin  
M/34 Pin  
LFH-60 Pairing  
Description  
15  
A
B
Frame Ground  
57  
Signal Ground  
37  
C
D
E
Request to Send  
Clear to Send  
48  
33  
Data Set Ready  
Received Line Signal Detector  
Data Terminal Ready  
Test Mode  
13  
F
9
H
K
P
45  
1
2
Transmit Data (A)  
Receive Data (A)  
Transmit Data (B)  
Receive Data (B)  
Terminal Timing (A)  
Receive Timing (A)  
Terminal Timing (B)  
Receive Timing (B)  
Transmit Timing (A)  
Transmit Timing (B)  
60  
R
S
59  
1
2
59  
T
60  
6
5
U
V
W
X
Y
AA  
52  
51  
5
6
51  
52  
55  
56  
56  
55  
22 to 21  
26 to 25  
X.21 DTE Cable Pinout  
Table 80: X.21 DTE Cable Pinout  
LFH-60 Pin  
DB-15 Pin  
LFH-60 Pairing  
Description  
15  
1
Shield Ground  
Serial PIM Cable Specifications  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
231  
           
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
Table 80: X.21 DTE Cable Pinout (continued)  
LFH-60 Pin  
DB-15 Pin  
LFH-60 Pairing  
Description  
60  
2
59  
47  
2
Transmit Data (A)  
Control (A)  
48  
3
1
4
Receive (A)  
37  
5
38  
6
Indicate (A)  
5
6
Signal Element Timing (A)  
Signal Ground  
Transmit Data (B)  
Control (B)  
57  
8
59  
9
60  
48  
1
47  
10  
11  
12  
13  
2
Receive (B)  
38  
37  
5
Indicate (B)  
6
Signal Element Timing (B)  
30 to 29  
18 to 17  
X.21 DCE Cable Pinout  
Table 81: X.21 DCE Cable Pinout  
LFH-60 Pin  
DB-15 Pin  
LFH-60 Pairing  
Description  
15  
1
1
Shield Ground  
Transmit Data (A)  
Control (A)  
2
2
37  
60  
48  
52  
57  
2
3
38  
59  
47  
51  
4
Receive (A)  
5
Indicate (A)  
6
Signal Element Timing (A)  
Signal Ground  
Transmit Data (B)  
Control (B)  
8
9
1
38  
59  
10  
11  
37  
60  
Receive (B)  
232  
Serial PIM Cable Specifications  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 13: Network Cable Specifications and Connector Pinouts  
Table 81: X.21 DCE Cable Pinout (continued)  
LFH-60 Pin  
47  
DB-15 Pin  
LFH-60 Pairing  
Description  
12  
13  
48  
52  
Indicate (B)  
51  
Signal Element Timing (B)  
30 to 29  
Fast Ethernet RJ-45 Connector Pinout  
Table 82 on page 233 describes the Fast Ethernet RJ-45 connector pinout information.  
NOTE: Either a straight-through or cross-over cable can be used to connect to the  
interface.  
Table 82: Fast Ethernet RJ-45 Connector Pinout  
Pin  
1
Signal  
TX+  
2
TX-  
3
RX+  
4
Termination network  
Termination network  
RX-  
5
6
7
Termination network  
Termination network  
8
Gigabit Ethernet uPIM RJ-45 Connector Pinout  
Table 83 on page 233 describes connector pinout information for 8-port and 16-port  
Gigabit Ethernet uPIM ports.  
Table 83: Gigabit Ethernet uPIM RJ-45 Connector Pinout  
Pin  
1
Signal Name  
BI_DA+  
Function  
Bidirectional pair +A  
Bidirectional pair -A  
2
BI_DA-  
Fast Ethernet RJ-45 Connector Pinout  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
233  
           
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
Table 83: Gigabit Ethernet uPIM RJ-45 Connector Pinout (continued)  
Pin  
3
Signal Name  
BI_DB+  
BI_DC+  
BI_DC-  
Function  
Bidirectional pair +B  
Bidirectional pair +C  
Bidirectional pair -C  
Bidirectional pair -B  
Bidirectional pair +D  
Bidirectional pair -D  
4
5
6
BI_DB-  
7
BI_DD+  
BI_DD-  
8
Gigabit Ethernet ePIM RJ-45 Connector Pinout  
Table 84 on page 234 describes connector pinout information for 1-port Gigabit  
Ethernet ePIM ports.  
Table 84: Gigabit Ethernet ePIM RJ-45  
Connector Pinouts  
Pin  
1
Signal  
MDI0+  
MDI0-  
2
3
MDI1+  
MDI2+  
MDI2-  
4
5
6
MDI1-  
7
MDI3+  
MDI3-  
8
Chassis Console Port Pinouts  
The console port on a J-series Services Router chassis has an RJ-45 connector.  
Table 85 on page 235 provides RJ-45 chassis console connector pinout information.  
An RJ-45 cable is supplied with the router.  
To connect the console port to an external management device, you need an RJ-45  
to DB-9 serial port adapter, which is also supplied with the router.  
234  
Gigabit Ethernet ePIM RJ-45 Connector Pinout  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Chapter 13: Network Cable Specifications and Connector Pinouts  
Table 85: RJ-45 Chassis Console Connector Pinout  
Pin  
1
Signal  
Description  
RTS Output  
DTR Output  
TxD Output  
GND  
Request to Send  
Data Terminal Ready  
Transmit Data  
Chassis Ground  
Chassis Ground  
Receive Data  
2
3
4
5
GND  
6
RxD Input  
DSR Input  
CTS Input  
7
Data Set Ready  
Clear to Send  
8
Table 86 on page 235 describes the DB-9 connector pinouts.  
Table 86: DB-9 Console Connector Pinout  
Pin  
1
Signal  
DCD  
RxD  
Direction  
<–  
Description  
Carrier Detect  
Receive Data  
2
<–  
3
TxD  
>  
Transmit Data  
Data Terminal Ready  
Signal Ground  
Data Set Ready  
Request To Send  
Clear To Send  
Ring Indicator  
4
DTR  
>  
5
Ground  
DSR  
6
<–  
7
RTS  
>  
8
CTS  
<–  
9
RING  
<–  
E1 and T1 RJ-48 Cable Pinouts  
The E1 and T1 PIMs use an RJ-48 cable, which is not supplied with the PIM.  
CAUTION: To maintain agency approvals, use only a properly constructed, shielded  
cable.  
E1 and T1 RJ-48 Cable Pinouts  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
235  
       
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
Table 87 on page 236 through Table 90 on page 237 describe the RJ-48 connector  
pinouts.  
Table 87: RJ-48 Connector to RJ-48 Connector (Straight) Pinout  
RJ-48 Pin  
RJ-48 Pin (on T1/E1 PIM) (Data Numbering  
(Data Numbering Form)  
Form)  
Signal  
1
2
4
5
3
6
7
8
1
RX, Ring, –  
2
RX, Tip, +  
4
TX, Ring, –  
5
TX, Tip, +  
3
Shield/Return/Ground  
Shield/Return/Ground  
No connect  
6
No connect  
No connect  
No connect  
Table 88: RJ-48 Connector to RJ-48 Connector (Crossover) Pinout  
RJ-48 Pin  
RJ-48 Pin (on T1/E1 PIM)  
(Data Numbering  
(Data Numbering Form)  
Form)  
Signal  
1
2
4
5
3
6
7
8
4
RX/Ring/<––>TX/Ring/–  
RX/Tip/+ <––>TX/Tip/+  
TX/Ring/<––>RX/Ring/–  
TX/Tip/+ <––>RX/Tip/+  
Shield/Return/Ground  
Shield/Return/Ground  
No connect  
5
1
2
3
6
No connect  
No connect  
No connect  
236  
E1 and T1 RJ-48 Cable Pinouts  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 13: Network Cable Specifications and Connector Pinouts  
Table 89: RJ-48 Connector to DB-15 Connector (Straight) Pinout  
DB-15 Pin  
RJ-48 Pin (on T1/E1 PIM)  
(Data Numbering  
Form)  
(Data Numbering Form)  
Signal  
1
11  
RX/Ring/<––>RX/Ring/–  
RX/Tip/+ <––>RX/Tip/+  
TX/Ring/<––>TX/Ring/–  
TX/Tip/+ <––>TX/Tip/+  
Shield/Return/Ground  
Shield/Return/Ground  
No connect  
2
3
4
9
5
1
3
4
6
2
7
No connect  
No connect  
No connect  
No connect  
No connect  
No connect  
No connect  
No connect  
No connect  
8
No connect  
9
No connect  
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
No connect  
No connect  
No connect  
No connect  
No connect  
No connect  
Table 90: RJ-48 Connector to DB-15 Connector (Crossover) Pinout  
DB-15 Pin  
RJ-48 Pin (on T1/E1 PIM)  
(Data Numbering  
(Data Numbering Form)  
Form)  
Signal  
1
2
4
5
3
6
9
RX/Ring/<––>TX/Ring/–  
RX/Tip/+ <––>TX/Tip/+  
TX/Ring/<––>RX/Ring/–  
TX/Tip/+ <––>RX/Tip/+  
Shield/Return/Ground  
Shield/Return/Ground  
1
11  
3
4
2
E1 and T1 RJ-48 Cable Pinouts  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
237  
   
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
Table 90: RJ-48 Connector to DB-15 Connector (Crossover) Pinout (continued)  
DB-15 Pin  
RJ-48 Pin (on T1/E1 PIM)  
(Data Numbering  
(Data Numbering Form)  
Form)  
Signal  
7
No connect  
No connect  
No connect  
No connect  
No connect  
No connect  
No connect  
No connect  
No connect  
No connect  
No connect  
No connect  
No connect  
No connect  
No connect  
No connect  
No connect  
No connect  
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
E3 and T3 BNC Connector Pinout  
The E3 and T3 PIMs each use two BNC connectorsone for transmitting data (TX)  
and one for receiving data (RX).  
ADSL and G.SHDSL RJ-11 Connector Pinout  
The 1-port ADSL 2/2+ Annex A and Annex B PIMs use an RJ-11 cable, which is not  
supplied with the PIMs. The 2-port G.SHDSL Annex A and Annex B PIM also uses an  
RJ-11 connector pinout.  
Table 91: ADSL and G.SHDSL RJ-11 Connector Pinout  
Pin  
1
Signal  
No connect  
No connect  
RJ P Tip  
2
3
4
RJ N Ring  
No connect  
No connect  
5
6
238  
E3 and T3 BNC Connector Pinout  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Chapter 13: Network Cable Specifications and Connector Pinouts  
ISDN RJ-45 Connector Pinout  
The 1-port and 4-port ISDN PIMs use an RJ-45 cable, which is not supplied with the  
PIMs. Table 92 on page 239 describes the RJ-45 connector pinout.  
Table 92: ISDN RJ-45 Connector Pinout  
Pin  
1
Signal  
No connect  
No connect  
RJ_SX_P  
2
3
4
RJ_SR_P  
5
RJ_SR_N  
6
RJ_SX_N  
No connect  
No connect  
Shielded  
7
8
9
10  
Shielded 2  
Connector Pinouts for Avaya VoIP Modules  
The Avaya VoIP modules supported on the Services Router accept different kinds of  
network cables.  
TGM550 Console Port Pinouts  
The console port on a TGM550 Telephony Gateway Module has an RJ-45 connector.  
Table 93 on page 240 provides TGM550 RJ-45 console connector pinout information.  
An RJ-45 cable is supplied with the TGM550.  
ISDN RJ-45 Connector Pinout  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
239  
             
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
NOTE: Two different RJ-45 cables and RJ-45 to DB-9 adapters are provided. Do not  
use the RJ-45 cable and adapter for the Services Router console port to connect to  
the TGM550 console port.  
To connect the console port to an external management device, you need an RJ-45  
to DB-9 serial port adapter, which is also supplied with the TGM550.  
Table 93: TGM550 RJ-45 Console Connector Pinouts  
TGM550 RJ-45  
Pin  
Signal  
Terminal DB-9 Pins  
1
For future use  
NC  
3
2
TXD (TGM550 input)  
3
RXD (TGM550 output)  
2
4
CD  
4
5
GND  
DTR  
RTS  
CTS  
5
6
1
7
8
8
7
TGM550 RJ-11 Connector Pinout for Analog Ports  
The two analog telephone ports and two analog trunk ports on the TGM550 use an  
RJ-11 cable. Table 94 on page 240 describes the TGM550 RJ-11 connector pinout.  
Table 94: TGM550 RJ-11 Connector Pinout  
Pin  
1
Signal  
No connection  
No connection  
Ring  
2
3
4
Tip  
5
No connection  
No connection  
6
240  
Connector Pinouts for Avaya VoIP Modules  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 13: Network Cable Specifications and Connector Pinouts  
TIM508 Connector Pinout  
The TIM508 Analog Telephony Interface Module uses a B25A unshielded 25pair  
amphenol cable. Table 95 on page 241 describes the TIM508 connector pinout.  
Table 95: TIM508 Connector Pinout  
Pin  
1
Signal  
Tip  
2
Tip  
3
Tip  
4
Tip  
5
Tip  
6
Tip  
7
Tip  
8
Tip  
26  
27  
28  
29  
30  
31  
32  
33  
R - Receive  
Ring  
Ring  
Ring  
Ring  
Ring  
Ring  
Ring  
TIM510 RJ-45 Connector Pinout  
describes the TIM510 RJ-45 connector pinout.  
Table 96: TIM510 RJ-45 Connector Pinout  
Pin  
1
Signal  
Ring  
Tip  
2
Connector Pinouts for Avaya VoIP Modules  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
241  
           
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
Table 96: TIM510 RJ-45 Connector Pinout (continued)  
Pin  
3
Signal  
No connection  
R1 - Transmit  
T1 - Transmit  
No connection  
No connection  
No connection  
4
5
6
7
8
TIM514 Connector Pinout  
describes the TIM514 RJ-11 connector pinout information.  
Table 97: TIM514 RJ-11 Connector Pinout  
Pin  
1
Signal  
No connection  
No connection  
Ring  
2
3
4
Tip  
5
No connection  
No connection  
6
TIM516 Connector Pinout  
The TIM516 Analog Telephony Interface Module uses a B25A unshielded 25pair  
amphenol cable. Table 98 on page 242 describes the TIM516 connector pinout.  
Table 98: TIM516 Connector Pinout  
Pin  
1
Signal  
Tip  
2
Tip  
3
Tip  
242  
Connector Pinouts for Avaya VoIP Modules  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Chapter 13: Network Cable Specifications and Connector Pinouts  
Table 98: TIM516 Connector Pinout (continued)  
Pin  
4
Signal  
Tip  
5
Tip  
6
Tip  
7
Tip  
8
Tip  
17  
18  
19  
20  
21  
22  
23  
24  
26  
27  
28  
29  
30  
31  
32  
33  
42  
43  
44  
45  
46  
47  
Tip  
Tip  
Tip  
Tip  
Tip  
Tip  
Tip  
Tip  
Ring  
Ring  
Ring  
Ring  
Ring  
Ring  
Ring  
Ring  
Ring  
Ring  
Ring  
Ring  
Ring  
Ring  
Connector Pinouts for Avaya VoIP Modules  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
243  
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
Table 98: TIM516 Connector Pinout (continued)  
Pin  
48  
49  
Signal  
Ring  
Ring  
TIM518 Connector Pinout  
The TIM518 Analog Telephony Interface Module uses a B25A unshielded 25pair  
amphenol cable. Table 99 on page 244 describes the TIM518 connector pinout.  
Table 99: TIM518 Connector Pinout  
Pin  
1
Signal  
Ring  
Ring  
Ring  
Ring  
Ring  
Ring  
Ring  
Ring  
Ring  
Ring  
Ring  
Ring  
Ring  
Ring  
Ring  
Ring  
Tip  
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
17  
18  
19  
20  
21  
22  
23  
24  
26  
27  
28  
Tip  
Tip  
244  
Connector Pinouts for Avaya VoIP Modules  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 13: Network Cable Specifications and Connector Pinouts  
Table 99: TIM518 Connector Pinout (continued)  
Pin  
29  
30  
31  
32  
33  
42  
43  
44  
45  
46  
47  
48  
49  
Signal  
Tip  
Tip  
Tip  
Tip  
Tip  
Tip  
Tip  
Tip  
Tip  
Tip  
Tip  
TIM521 Connector Pinout  
describes the TIM521 RJ-45 connector pinout.  
Table 100: TIM521 RJ-45 Connector Pinout  
Pin  
1
Signal  
No connection  
No connection  
Transmit pair +  
Receive pair +  
Receive pair –  
Transmit pair –  
No connection  
No connection  
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
Connector Pinouts for Avaya VoIP Modules  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
245  
     
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
246  
Connector Pinouts for Avaya VoIP Modules  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 14  
Safety and Regulatory Compliance  
Information  
To install and use the Services Router safely, follow proper safety procedures. This  
chapter discusses the following safety and regulatory compliance information:  
Definition of Safety Warning Levels  
This manual uses the following three levels of safety warnings:  
NOTE: You might find this information helpful in a particular situation, or might  
otherwise overlook it.  
CAUTION: You need to observe the specified guidelines to avoid minor injury or  
discomfort to you, or severe damage to the Services Router.  
WARNING: This symbol means danger. You are in a situation that could cause bodily  
injury. Before you work on any equipment, be aware of the hazards involved with  
electrical circuitry and be familiar with standard practices for preventing accidents.  
WARNING: Waarschuwing Dit waarschuwingssymbool betekent gevaar. U verkeert  
in een situatie die lichamelijk letsel kan veroorzaken. Voordat u aan enige apparatuur  
gaat werken, dient u zich bewust te zijn van de bij elektrische schakelingen betrokken  
Definition of Safety Warning Levels  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
247  
       
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
risico's en dient u op de hoogte te zijn van standaard maatregelen om ongelukken  
te voorkomen.  
WARNING: Varoitus Tämä varoitusmerkki merkitsee vaaraa. Olet tilanteessa, joka  
voi johtaa ruumiinvammaan. Ennen kuin työskentelet minkään laitteiston parissa,  
ota selvää sähkökytkentöihin liittyvistä vaaroista ja tavanomaisista onnettomuuksien  
ehkäisykeinoista.  
WARNING: Attention Ce symbole d'avertissement indique un danger. Vous vous  
trouvez dans une situation pouvant causer des blessures ou des dommages corporels.  
Avant de travailler sur un équipement, soyez conscient des dangers posés par les  
circuits électriques et familiarisez-vous avec les procédures couramment utilisées  
pour éviter les accidents.  
WARNING: Warnung Dieses Warnsymbol bedeutet Gefahr. Sie befinden sich in einer  
Situation, die zu einer Körperverletzung führen könnte. Bevor Sie mit der Arbeit an  
irgendeinem Gerät beginnen, seien Sie sich der mit elektrischen Stromkreisen  
verbundenen Gefahren und der Standardpraktiken zur Vermeidung von Unfällen  
bewußt.  
WARNING: Avvertenza Questo simbolo di avvertenza indica un pericolo. La situazione  
potrebbe causare infortuni alle persone. Prima di lavorare su qualsiasi apparecchiatura,  
occorre conoscere i pericoli relativi ai circuiti elettrici ed essere al corrente delle  
pratiche standard per la prevenzione di incidenti.  
WARNING: Advarsel Dette varselsymbolet betyr fare. Du befinner deg i en situasjon  
som kan føre til personskade. Før du utfører arbeid på utstyr, må du vare oppmerksom  
på de faremomentene som elektriske kretser innebærer, samt gjøre deg kjent med  
vanlig praksis når det gjelder å unngå ulykker.  
WARNING: Aviso Este símbolo de aviso indica perigo. Encontra-se numa situação  
que lhe poderá causar danos físicos. Antes de começar a trabalhar com qualquer  
equipamento, familiarize-se com os perigos relacionados com circuitos eléctricos, e  
com quaisquer práticas comuns que possam prevenir possíveis acidentes.  
WARNING: ¡Atención! Este símbolo de aviso significa peligro. Existe riesgo para su  
integridad física. Antes de manipular cualquier equipo, considerar los riesgos que  
248  
Definition of Safety Warning Levels  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 14: Safety and Regulatory Compliance Information  
entraña la corriente eléctrica y familiarizarse con los procedimientos estándar de  
prevención de accidentes.  
WARNING: Varning! Denna varningssymbol signalerar fara. Du befinner dig i en  
situation som kan leda till personskada. Innan du utför arbete på någon utrustning  
måste du vara medveten om farorna med elkretsar och känna till vanligt förfarande  
för att förebygga skador.  
Safety Guidelines and Warnings  
This section lists the following safety guidelines and warnings for installing, operating,  
and maintaining a Services Router:  
General Safety Guidelines and Warnings  
The following guidelines help ensure your safety and protect the Services Router  
from damage. The list of guidelines might not address all potentially hazardous  
situations in your working environment, so be alert and exercise good judgment at  
all times.  
Perform only the procedures explicitly described in this manual. Make sure that  
only authorized service personnel perform other system services.  
Keep the area around the chassis clear and free from dust before, during, and  
after installation.  
Keep tools away from areas where people could trip over them while walking.  
Do not wear loose clothing or jewelry, such as rings, bracelets, or chains, which  
could become caught in the chassis.  
Wear safety glasses if you are working under any conditions that could be  
hazardous to your eyes.  
Do not perform any actions that create a potential hazard to people or make the  
equipment unsafe.  
Never attempt to lift an object that is too heavy for one person to handle.  
Never install or manipulate wiring during electrical storms.  
Never install electrical jacks in wet locations unless the jacks are specifically  
designed for wet environments.  
Operate the Services Router only when it is properly grounded.  
Safety Guidelines and Warnings  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
249  
     
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
The separate protective earthing terminal provided on this product shall be  
permanently connected to earth.  
Replace fuses only with fuses of the same type and rating.  
Do not open or remove chassis covers or sheet metal parts unless instructions  
are provided in this manual. Such an action could cause severe electrical shock.  
Do not push or force any objects through any opening in the chassis frame. Such  
an action could result in electrical shock or fire.  
Avoid spilling liquid onto the Services Router chassis or onto any Services Router  
component. Such an action could cause electrical shock or damage the Services  
Router.  
Avoid touching uninsulated electrical wires or terminals that have not been  
disconnected from their power source. Such an action could cause electrical  
shock.  
In addition, observe the warnings and guidelines in the following sections.  
Qualified Personnel Warning  
WARNING: Only trained and qualified personnel should install or replace the Services  
Router.  
Waarschuwing Installatie en reparaties mogen uitsluitend door getraind en bevoegd  
personeel uitgevoerd worden.  
Varoitus Ainoastaan koulutettu ja pätevä henkilökunta saa asentaa tai vaihtaa tämän  
laitteen.  
Attention Tout installation ou remplacement de l'appareil doit être réalisé par du  
personnel qualifié et compétent.  
Warnung Gerät nur von geschultem, qualifiziertem Personal installieren oder  
auswechseln lassen.  
WARNING: Avvertenza Solo personale addestrato e qualificato deve essere autorizzato  
ad installare o sostituire questo apparecchio.  
Advarsel Kun kvalifisert personell med riktig opplæring bør montere eller bytte ut  
dette utstyret.  
Aviso Este equipamento deverá ser instalado ou substituído apenas por pessoal  
devidamente treinado e qualificado.  
¡Atención! Estos equipos deben ser instalados y reemplazados exclusivamente por  
personal técnico adecuadamente preparado y capacitado.  
250  
Safety Guidelines and Warnings  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 14: Safety and Regulatory Compliance Information  
Varning! Denna utrustning ska endast installeras och bytas ut av utbildad och  
kvalificerad personal.  
Preventing Electrostatic Discharge Damage  
Many Services Router hardware components are sensitive to damage from static  
electricity. Some components can be impaired by voltages as low as 30 V. You can  
easily generate potentially damaging static voltages whenever you handle plastic or  
foam packing material or if you move components across plastic or carpets. Observe  
the following guidelines to minimize the potential for electrostatic discharge (ESD)  
damage, which can cause intermittent or complete component failures:  
Always use an ESD wrist strap or ankle strap, and make sure that it is in direct  
contact with your skin.  
CAUTION: For safety, periodically check the resistance value of the ESD strap. The  
measurement should be in the range of 1 to 10 Mohms.  
When handling any component that is removed from the chassis, make sure the  
equipment end of your ESD strap is attached to one of the electrostatic discharge  
Avoid contact between the component and your clothing. ESD voltages emitted  
from clothing can still damage components.  
When removing or installing a component, always place it component-side up  
on an antistatic surface, in an antistatic card rack, or in an electrostatic bag (see  
Figure 109 on page 251). If you are returning a component, place it in an  
electrostatic bag before packing it.  
Figure 109: Place a Component into an Electrostatic Bag  
Safety Guidelines and Warnings  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
251  
       
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
Electrical Safety Guidelines and Warnings  
When working on equipment powered by electricity, follow the guidelines described  
in the following sections:  
General Electrical Safety Guidelines  
WARNING: Certain ports on the router are designed for use as intrabuilding  
(within-the-building) interfaces only (Type 2 or Type 4 ports as described in  
GR-1089-CORE, Issue 4) and require isolation from the exposed outside plant (OSP)  
cabling. To comply with NEBS requirements and protect against lightning surges and  
commercial power disturbances, the intrabuilding ports must not be metallically  
connected to interfaces that connect to the OSP or its wiring. The intrabuilding ports  
on the router are suitable for connection to intrabuilding or unexposed wiring or  
cabling only. The addition of primary protectors is not sufficient protection for  
connecting these interfaces metallically to OSP wiring.  
CAUTION: To comply with intrabuilding lightning and surge requirements,  
intrabuilding wiring must be shielded, and the shield for the wiring must be grounded  
at both ends.  
CAUTION: Before removing or installing components of a router, attach an ESD strap  
to an ESD point and place the other end of the strap around your bare wrist. Failure  
to use an ESD strap could result in damage to the router.  
252  
Safety Guidelines and Warnings  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 14: Safety and Regulatory Compliance Information  
Install the Services Router in compliance with the following local, national, or  
international electrical codes:  
United StatesNational Fire Protection Association (NFPA 70), United States  
National Electrical Code.  
CanadaCanadian Electrical Code, Part 1, CSA C22.1.  
Other countriesInternational Electromechanical Commission (IEC) 60364,  
Part 1 through Part 7.  
Evaluated to the TN power system.  
Locate the emergency power-off switch for the room in which you are working  
so that if an electrical accident occurs, you can quickly turn off the power.  
Make sure that grounding surfaces are cleaned and brought to a bright finish  
before grounding connections can be made.  
Do not work alone if potentially hazardous conditions exist anywhere in your  
workspace.  
Never assume that power is disconnected from a circuit. Always check the circuit  
before starting to work.  
Carefully look for possible hazards in your work area, such as moist floors,  
ungrounded power extension cords, and missing safety grounds.  
Operate the Services Router within marked electrical ratings and product usage  
instructions.  
For the Services Router and peripheral equipment to function safely and correctly,  
use the cables and connectors specified for the attached peripheral equipment,  
and make certain they are in good condition.  
Many Services Router components can be removed and replaced without powering  
down or disconnecting power to the Services Router, as detailed in elsewhere in this  
manual. Never install equipment if it appears damaged.  
AC Power Electrical Safety Guidelines  
CAUTION: For routers with AC power supplies, an external surge protective device  
(SPD) must be used at the AC power source.  
The following electrical safety guidelines apply to AC-powered routers:  
AC-powered routers are shipped with a three-wire electrical cord with a  
grounding-type plug that fits only a grounding-type power outlet. Do not  
circumvent this safety feature. Equipment grounding should comply with local  
and national electrical codes.  
You must provide an external Listed circuit breaker rated minimum 15 A in the  
building installation.  
The power cord serves as the main disconnecting device. The socket outlet must  
be near the router and be easily accessible.  
Safety Guidelines and Warnings  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
253  
   
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
The cores in the mains lead are colored in accordance with the following code  
(within the United States):  
Green and yellowEarth  
BlueNeutral  
BrownLive  
When a router is equipped with two AC power supplies, both power cords (one  
for each power supply) must be unplugged to completely disconnect power to  
the router.  
Note the following warnings printed on the AC power supply faceplate:  
To completely de-energize the system disconnect maximum of 2 power  
cordsets.  
Apparaten skall anslutas till jordat uttag när den ansluts till ett nätverk.  
[Swedish]  
Power Cable Warning (Japanese)  
WARNING: The attached power cable is only for this product. Do not use the cable  
for another product.  
DC Power Electrical Safety Guidelines  
The following electrical safety guidelines apply to a DC-powered router:  
A DC-powered router is equipped with a DC terminal block that is rated for the  
power requirements of a maximally configured router. To supply sufficient power,  
terminate the DC input wiring on a facility DC source capable of supplying at  
least 8 A @ 48 VDC. Incorporate an easily accessible disconnect device into  
the facility wiring. Be sure to connect the ground wire or conduit to a solid office  
(earth) ground. A closed loop ring is recommended for terminating the ground  
conductor at the ground stud.  
In the United States, a restricted access area is one in accordance with Articles  
110-16, 110-17, and 110-18 of the National Electrical Code ANSI/NFPA 70.  
254  
Safety Guidelines and Warnings  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 14: Safety and Regulatory Compliance Information  
NOTE: Primary overcurrent protection is provided by the building circuit breaker.  
This breaker should protect against excess currents, short circuits, and earth faults  
in accordance with NEC ANSI/NFPA70.  
Ensure that the polarity of the DC input wiring is correct. Under certain conditions,  
connections with reversed polarity might trip the primary circuit breaker or  
damage the equipment.  
For personal safety, connect the green and yellow wire to safety (earth) ground  
at both the router and the supply side of the DC wiring.  
The marked input voltage of 48 VDC for a DC-powered router is the nominal  
voltage associated with the battery circuit, and any higher voltages are only to  
be associated with float voltages for the charging function.  
Because the router is a positive ground system, you must connect the positive  
lead to the terminal labeled RTN, the negative lead to the terminal labeled  
48 VDC, and the earth ground to the chassis grounding points.  
Power Sources for Redundant Power Supplies  
If your J6350 Services Router includes an optional redundant DC power supply, make  
sure that the two DC power supplies are powered by dedicated power feeds derived  
from feed A and feed B. This configuration provides the commonly deployed A/B  
feed redundancy for the system. Failure to do so makes the router susceptible to  
total power failure if one of the power supplies fails.  
DC Power Disconnection Warning  
WARNING: Before performing any of the following procedures, ensure that power  
is removed from the DC circuit. To ensure that all power is off, locate the circuit  
breaker on the panel board that services the DC circuit, switch the circuit breaker to  
the OFF position, and tape the switch handle of the circuit breaker in the OFF position.  
Waarschuwing Voordat u een van de onderstaande procedures uitvoert, dient u te  
controleren of de stroom naar het gelijkstroom circuit uitgeschakeld is. Om u ervan  
te verzekeren dat alle stroom UIT is geschakeld, kiest u op het schakelbord de  
stroomverbreker die het gelijkstroom circuit bedient, draait de stroomverbreker naar  
de UIT positie en plakt de schakelaarhendel van de stroomverbreker met plakband  
in de UIT positie vast.  
Varoitus Varmista, että tasavirtapiirissä ei ole virtaa ennen seuraavien toimenpiteiden  
suorittamista. Varmistaaksesi, että virta on KATKAISTU täysin, paikanna tasavirrasta  
Safety Guidelines and Warnings  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
255  
       
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
huolehtivassa kojetaulussa sijaitseva suojakytkin, käännä suojakytkin  
KATKAISTU-asentoon ja teippaa suojakytkimen varsi niin, että se pysyy  
KATKAISTU-asennossa.  
WARNING: Attention Avant de pratiquer l'une quelconque des procédures ci-dessous,  
vérifier que le circuit en courant continu n'est plus sous tension. Pour en être sûr,  
localiser le disjoncteur situé sur le panneau de service du circuit en courant continu,  
placer le disjoncteur en position fermée (OFF) et, à l'aide d'un ruban adhésif, bloquer  
la poignée du disjoncteur en position OFF.  
Warnung Vor Ausführung der folgenden Vorgänge ist sicherzustellen, daß die  
Gleichstromschaltung keinen Strom erhält. Um sicherzustellen, daß sämtlicher Strom  
abgestellt ist, machen Sie auf der Schalttafel den Unterbrecher für die  
Gleichstromschaltung ausfindig, stellen Sie den Unterbrecher auf AUS, und kleben  
Sie den Schaltergriff des Unterbrechers mit Klebeband in der AUS-Stellung fest.  
Avvertenza Prima di svolgere una qualsiasi delle procedure seguenti, verificare che  
il circuito CC non sia alimentato. Per verificare che tutta l'alimentazione sia scollegata  
(OFF), individuare l'interruttore automatico sul quadro strumenti che alimenta il  
circuito CC, mettere l'interruttore in posizione OFF e fissarlo con nastro adesivo in  
tale posizione.  
WARNING: Advarsel Før noen av disse prosedyrene utføres, kontroller at strømmen  
er frakoblet likestrømkretsen. Sørg for at all strøm er slått AV. Dette gjøres ved å  
lokalisere strømbryteren på brytertavlen som betjener likestrømkretsen, slå  
strømbryteren AV og teipe bryterhåndtaket på strømbryteren i AV-stilling.  
Aviso Antes de executar um dos seguintes procedimentos, certifique-se que desligou  
a fonte de alimentação de energia do circuito de corrente contínua. Para se assegurar  
que toda a corrente foi DESLIGADA, localize o disjuntor no painel que serve o circuito  
de corrente contínua e coloque-o na posição OFF (Desligado), segurando nessa  
posição a manivela do interruptor do disjuntor com fita isoladora.  
¡Atención! Antes de proceder con los siguientes pasos, comprobar que la alimentación  
del circuito de corriente continua (CC) esté cortada (OFF). Para asegurarse de que  
toda la alimentación esté cortada (OFF), localizar el interruptor automático en el  
panel que alimenta al circuito de corriente continua, cambiar el interruptor automático  
a la posición de Apagado (OFF), y sujetar con cinta la palanca del interruptor  
automático en posición de Apagado (OFF).  
Varning! Innan du utför någon av följande procedurer måste du kontrollera att  
strömförsörjningen till likströmskretsen är bruten. Kontrollera att all strömförsörjning  
är BRUTEN genom att slå AV det överspänningsskydd som skyddar likströmskretsen  
och tejpa fast överspänningsskyddets omkopplare i FRÅN-läget.  
256  
Safety Guidelines and Warnings  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 14: Safety and Regulatory Compliance Information  
DC Power Grounding Requirements and Warning  
An insulated grounding conductor that is identical in size to the grounded and  
ungrounded branch circuit supply conductors, but is identifiable by green and yellow  
stripes, is installed as part of the branch circuit that supplies the unit. The grounding  
conductor must be permanently connected to earth.  
WARNING: When installing the router, the ground connection must always be made  
first and disconnected last.  
Waarschuwing Bij de installatie van het toestel moet de aardverbinding altijd het  
eerste worden gemaakt en het laatste worden losgemaakt.  
Varoitus Laitetta asennettaessa on maahan yhdistäminen aina tehtävä ensiksi ja  
maadoituksen irti kytkeminen viimeiseksi.  
Attention Lors de l'installation de l'appareil, la mise à la terre doit toujours être  
connectée en premier et déconnectée en dernier.  
Warnung Der Erdanschluß muß bei der Installation der Einheit immer zuerst  
hergestellt und zuletzt abgetrennt werden.  
Avvertenza In fase di installazione dell'unità, eseguire sempre per primo il  
collegamento a massa e disconnetterlo per ultimo.  
Advarsel Når enheten installeres, må jordledningen alltid tilkobles først og frakobles  
sist.  
Aviso Ao instalar a unidade, a ligação à terra deverá ser sempre a primeira a ser  
ligada, e a última a ser desligada.  
¡Atención! Al instalar el equipo, conectar la tierra la primera y desconectarla la última.  
Varning! Vid installation av enheten måste jordledningen alltid anslutas först och  
kopplas bort sist.  
DC Power Wiring Sequence Warning  
WARNING: Wire the DC power supply using the appropriate lugs. When connecting  
power, the proper wiring sequence is ground to ground, +RTN to +RTN, then -48 V  
to -48 V. When disconnecting power, the proper wiring sequence is -48 V to -48 V,  
+RTN to +RTN, then ground to ground. Note that the ground wire should always  
be connected first and disconnected last.  
Safety Guidelines and Warnings  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
257  
       
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
WARNING: Waarschuwing De juiste bedradingsvolgorde verbonden is aarde naar  
aarde, +RTN naar +RTN, en 48 V naar 48 V. De juiste bedradingsvolgorde  
losgemaakt is en 48 V naar 48 V, +RTN naar +RTN, aarde naar aarde.  
WARNING: Varoitus Oikea yhdistettava kytkentajarjestys on maajohto maajohtoon,  
+RTN varten +RTN, 48 V varten 48 V. Oikea irrotettava kytkentajarjestys on  
48 V varten 48 V, +RTN varten +RTN, maajohto maajohtoon.  
WARNING: Attention Câblez l'approvisionnement d'alimentation CC En utilisant les  
crochets appropriés à l'extrémité de câblage. En reliant la puissance, l'ordre approprié  
de câblage est rectifié pour rectifier, +RTN à +RTN, puis -48 V à -48 V. En  
débranchant la puissance, l'ordre approprié de câblage est -48 V à -48 V, +RTN à  
+RTN, a alors rectifié pour rectifier. Notez que le fil de masse devrait toujours être  
relié d'abord et débranché pour la dernière fois. Notez que le fil de masse devrait  
toujours être relié d'abord et débranché pour la dernière fois.  
WARNING: Warnung Verdrahten Sie die Gleichstrom-Versorgung mit den passenden  
Ansätzen am Verdrahtung Ende. Wenn man Energie anschließt, wird die korrekte  
Verdrahtung. Reihenfolge gerieben, um, +RTN zu +RTN, dann -48 V bis -48 V zu  
reiben. Wenn sie Energie trennt, ist die korrekte Verdrahtung Reihenfolge -48 V bis  
-48 V,+RTN zu +RTN, rieb dann, um zu reiben. Beachten Sie, daß der Erdungsdraht  
immer zuerst angeschlossen werden und zuletzt getrennt werden sollte.  
WARNING: Avvertenza Mostra la morsettiera dell alimentatore CC. Cablare  
l'alimentatore CC usando i connettori adatti all'estremità del cablaggio, come illustrato.  
La corretta sequenza di cablaggio è da massa a massa, da positivo a positivo (da  
linea ad L) e da negativo a negativo (da neutro a N). Tenere presente che il filo di  
massa deve sempre venire collegato per primo e scollegato per ultimo.  
WARNING: Advarsel Riktig tilkoples tilkoplingssekvens er jord til jord, +RTN til  
+RTN, 48 V til 48 V. Riktig frakoples tilkoplingssekvens er 48 V til 48 V, +RTN  
til +RTN, jord til jord.  
WARNING: Aviso Ate con alambre la fuente de potencia cc Usando los terminales  
apropiados en el extremo del cableado. Al conectar potencia, la secuencia apropiada  
del cableado se muele para moler, +RTN a +RTN, entonces -48 V a -48 V. Al  
desconectar potencia, la secuencia apropiada del cableado es -48 V a -48 V, +RTN  
a +RTN, entonces molió para moler. Observe que el alambre de tierra se debe  
258  
Safety Guidelines and Warnings  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 14: Safety and Regulatory Compliance Information  
conectar siempre primero y desconectar por último. Observe que el alambre de tierra  
se debe conectar siempre primero y desconectar por último.  
WARNING: ¡Atención! Wire a fonte de alimentação de DC Usando os talões  
apropriados na extremidade da fiação. Ao conectar a potência, a seqüência apropriada  
da fiação é moída para moer, +RTN a +RTN, então -48 V a -48 V. Ao desconectar  
a potência, a seqüência apropriada da fiação é -48 V a -48 V, +RTN a +RTN, moeu  
então para moer. Anote que o fio à terra deve sempre ser conectado primeiramente  
e desconectado por último. Anote que o fio à terra deve sempre ser conectado  
primeiramente e desconectado por último.  
Varning! Korrekt kopplingssekvens ar jord till jord, +RTN till +RTN, 48 V till 48  
V. Korrekt kopplas kopplingssekvens ar 48 V till 48 V, +RTN till +RTN, jord till  
jord.  
DC Power Wiring Terminations Warning  
WARNING: When stranded wiring is required, use approved wiring terminations,  
such as closed-loop or spade-type with upturned lugs. These terminations should be  
the appropriate size for the wires and should clamp both the insulation and conductor.  
WARNING: Waarschuwing Wanneer geslagen bedrading vereist is, dient u bedrading  
te gebruiken die voorzien is van goedgekeurde aansluitingspunten, zoals het  
gesloten-lus type of het grijperschop type waarbij de aansluitpunten omhoog wijzen.  
Deze aansluitpunten dienen de juiste maat voor de draden te hebben en dienen  
zowel de isolatie als de geleider vast te klemmen.  
WARNING: Varoitus Jos säikeellinen johdin on tarpeen, käytä hyväksyttyä  
johdinliitäntää, esimerkiksi suljettua silmukkaa tai kourumaista liitäntää, jossa on  
ylöspäin käännetyt kiinnityskorvat. Tällaisten liitäntöjen tulee olla kooltaan johtimiin  
sopivia ja niiden tulee puristaa yhteen sekä eristeen että johdinosan.  
WARNING: Attention Quand des fils torsadés sont nécessaires, utiliser des douilles  
terminales homologuées telles que celles à circuit fermé ou du type à plage ouverte  
avec cosses rebroussées. Ces douilles terminales doivent être de la taille qui convient  
aux fils et doivent être refermées sur la gaine isolante et sur le conducteur.  
Safety Guidelines and Warnings  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
259  
   
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
WARNING: Warnung Wenn Litzenverdrahtung erforderlich ist, sind zugelassene  
Verdrahtungsabschlüsse, z.B. für einen geschlossenen Regelkreis oder gabelförmig,  
mit nach oben gerichteten Kabelschuhen zu verwenden. Diese Abschlüsse sollten  
die angemessene Größe für die Drähte haben und sowohl die Isolierung als auch den  
Leiter festklemmen.  
WARNING: Avvertenza Quando occorre usare trecce, usare connettori omologati,  
come quelli a occhiello o a forcella con linguette rivolte verso l'alto. I connettori  
devono avere la misura adatta per il cablaggio e devono serrare sia l'isolante che il  
conduttore.  
WARNING: Advarsel Hvis det er nødvendig med flertrådede ledninger, brukes  
godkjente ledningsavslutninger, som for eksempel lukket sløyfe eller spadetype med  
oppoverbøyde kabelsko. Disse avslutningene skal ha riktig størrelse i forhold til  
ledningene, og skal klemme sammen både isolasjonen og lederen.  
WARNING: Aviso Quando forem requeridas montagens de instalação eléctrica de  
cabo torcido, use terminações de cabo aprovadas, tais como, terminações de cabo  
em circuito fechado e planas com terminais de orelha voltados para cima. Estas  
terminações de cabo deverão ser do tamanho apropriado para os respectivos cabos,  
e deverão prender simultaneamente o isolamento e o fio condutor.  
WARNING: ¡Atención! Cuando se necesite hilo trenzado, utilizar terminales para  
cables homologados, tales como las de tipo "bucle cerrado" o "espada", con las  
lengüetas de conexión vueltas hacia arriba. Estos terminales deberán ser del tamaño  
apropiado para los cables que se utilicen, y tendrán que sujetar tanto el aislante como  
el conductor.  
WARNING: Varning! När flertrådiga ledningar krävs måste godkända  
ledningskontakter användas, t.ex. kabelsko av sluten eller öppen typ med uppåtvänd  
tapp. Storleken på dessa kontakter måste vara avpassad till ledningarna och måste  
kunna hålla både isoleringen och ledaren fastklämda.  
Grounded Equipment Warning  
WARNING: The router is intended to be grounded. Ensure that the router is connected  
to earth ground during normal use.  
260  
Safety Guidelines and Warnings  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 14: Safety and Regulatory Compliance Information  
Waarschuwing Deze apparatuur hoort geaard te worden Zorg dat de host-computer  
tijdens normaal gebruik met aarde is verbonden.  
Varoitus Tämä laitteisto on tarkoitettu maadoitettavaksi. Varmista, että isäntälaite  
on yhdistetty maahan normaalikäytön aikana.  
Attention Cet équipement doit être relié à la terre. S'assurer que l'appareil hôte est  
relié à la terre lors de l'utilisation normale.  
Warnung Dieses Gerät muß geerdet werden. Stellen Sie sicher, daß das Host-Gerät  
während des normalen Betriebs an Erde gelegt ist.  
WARNING: Avvertenza Questa apparecchiatura deve essere collegata a massa.  
Accertarsi che il dispositivo host sia collegato alla massa di terra durante il normale  
utilizzo.  
Advarsel Dette utstyret skal jordes. Forviss deg om vertsterminalen er jordet ved  
normalt bruk.  
Aviso Este equipamento deverá estar ligado à terra. Certifique-se que o host se  
encontra ligado à terra durante a sua utilização normal.  
¡Atención! Este equipo debe conectarse a tierra. Asegurarse de que el equipo principal  
esté conectado a tierra durante el uso normal.  
Varning! Denna utrustning är avsedd att jordas. Se till att värdenheten är jordad vid  
normal användning.  
Warning Statement for Norway and Sweden  
WARNING: The equipment must be connected to an earthed mains socket-outlet.  
Advarsel Apparatet skal kobles til en jordet stikkontakt.  
Varning! Apparaten skall anslutas till jordat nätuttag.  
In Case of Electrical Accident  
If an electrical accident results in an injury, take the following actions in this order:  
1. Use caution. Be aware of potentially hazardous conditions that could cause further  
injury.  
2. Disconnect power from the Services Router.  
3. If possible, send another person to get medical aid. Otherwise, assess the  
condition of the victim, then call for help.  
Safety Guidelines and Warnings  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
261  
       
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
Multiple Power Supplies Disconnection Warning  
WARNING: The J6350 Services Router has more than one power supply connection.  
All connections must be removed completely to remove power from the unit  
completely.  
WARNING: Waarschuwing Deze J6350 eenheid heeft meer dan één  
stroomtoevoerverbinding; alle verbindingen moeten volledig worden verwijderd om  
de stroom van deze eenheid volledig te verwijderen.  
WARNING: Varoitus Tässä laitteessa on useampia virtalähdekytkentöjä. Kaikki  
kytkennät on irrotettava kokonaan, jotta virta poistettaisiin täysin laitteesta.  
WARNING: Attention Cette J6350 unité est équipée de plusieurs raccordements  
d'alimentation. Pour supprimer tout courant électrique de l'unité, tous les cordons  
d'alimentation doivent être débranchés.  
WARNING: Warnung Diese J6350 Einheit verfügt über mehr als einen Stromanschluß;  
um Strom gänzlich von der Einheit fernzuhalten, müssen alle Stromzufuhren  
abgetrennt sein.  
WARNING: Avvertenza Questa J6350 unità ha più di una connessione per  
alimentatore elettrico; tutte le connessioni devono essere completamente rimosse  
per togliere l'elettricità dall'unità.  
WARNING: Advarsel Denne J6350 enheten har mer enn én strømtilkobling. Alle  
tilkoblinger må kobles helt fra for å eliminere strøm fra enheten.  
WARNING: Aviso Este J6350 dispositivo possui mais do que uma conexão de fonte  
de alimentação de energia; para poder remover a fonte de alimentação de energia,  
deverão ser desconectadas todas as conexões existentes.  
WARNING: ¡Atención! Esta J6350 unidad tiene más de una conexión de suministros  
de alimentación; para eliminar la alimentación por completo, deben desconectarse  
completamente todas las conexiones.  
262  
Safety Guidelines and Warnings  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 14: Safety and Regulatory Compliance Information  
WARNING: Varning! Denna J6350 enhet har mer än en strömförsörjningsanslutning;  
alla anslutningar måste vara helt avlägsnade innan strömtillförseln till enheten är  
fullständigt bruten.  
Power Disconnection Warning  
WARNING: Before working on the router or near power supplies, unplug the power  
cord from an AC router.  
WARNING: Waarschuwing Voordat u aan een frame of in de nabijheid van voedingen  
werkt, dient u bij wisselstroom toestellen de stekker van het netsnoer uit het  
stopcontact te halen.  
WARNING: Varoitus Kytke irti vaihtovirtalaitteiden virtajohto, ennen kuin teet mitään  
asennuspohjalle tai työskentelet virtalähteiden läheisyydessä.  
WARNING: Attention Avant de travailler sur un châssis ou à proximité d'une  
alimentation électrique, débrancher le cordon d'alimentation des unités en courant  
alternatif.  
WARNING: Warnung Bevor Sie an einem Chassis oder in der Nähe von Netzgeräten  
arbeiten, ziehen Sie bei Wechselstromeinheiten das Netzkabel ab bzw.  
WARNING: Avvertenza Prima di lavorare su un telaio o intorno ad alimentatori,  
scollegare il cavo di alimentazione sulle unità CA.  
WARNING: Advarsel Før det utføres arbeid på kabinettet eller det arbeides i nærheten  
av strømforsyningsenheter, skal strømledningen trekkes ut på vekselstrømsenheter.  
WARNING: Aviso Antes de trabalhar num chassis, ou antes de trabalhar perto de  
unidades de fornecimento de energia, desligue o cabo de alimentação nas unidades  
de corrente alternada.  
Safety Guidelines and Warnings  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
263  
   
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
WARNING: ¡Atención! Antes de manipular el chasis de un equipo o trabajar cerca  
de una fuente de alimentación, desenchufar el cable de alimentación en los equipos  
de corriente alterna (CA).  
WARNING: Varning! Innan du arbetar med ett chassi eller nära  
strömförsörjningsenheter skall du för växelströmsenheter dra ur nätsladden.  
TN Power Warning  
WARNING: The router is designed to work with a TN power system.  
WARNING: Waarschuwing Het apparaat is ontworpen om te functioneren met TN  
energiesystemen.  
WARNING: Varoitus Koje on suunniteltu toimimaan TN-sähkövoimajärjestelmien  
yhteydessä.  
WARNING: Attention Ce dispositif a été conçu pour fonctionner avec des systèmes  
d'alimentation TN.  
WARNING: Warnung Das Gerät ist für die Verwendung mit TN-Stromsystemen  
ausgelegt.  
WARNING: Avvertenza Il dispositivo è stato progettato per l'uso con sistemi di  
alimentazione TN.  
WARNING: Advarsel Utstyret er utfomet til bruk med TN-strømsystemer.  
WARNING: Aviso O dispositivo foi criado para operar com sistemas de corrente TN.  
264  
Safety Guidelines and Warnings  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 14: Safety and Regulatory Compliance Information  
WARNING: ¡Atención! El equipo está diseñado para trabajar con sistemas de  
alimentación tipo TN.  
WARNING: Varning! Enheten är konstruerad för användning tillsammans med  
elkraftssystem av TN-typ.  
Telecommunication Line Cord Warning  
WARNING: To reduce the risk of fire, use only No. 26 AWG or larger UL-listed or  
CSA-certified telecommunication line cord.  
WARNING: Waarschuwing Om brandgevaar te reduceren, dient slechts  
telecommunicatielijnsnoer nr. 26 AWG of groter gebruikt te worden.  
WARNING: Varoitus Tulipalovaaran vähentämiseksi käytä ainoastaan nro 26 AWG-  
tai paksumpaa tietoliikennejohdinta.  
WARNING: Attention Pour réduire les risques d'incendie, n'utiliser que des cordons  
de lignes de télécommunications de type AWG nº 26 ou plus larges.  
WARNING: Warnung Zur Reduzierung der Feuergefahr eine Fernmeldeleitungsschnur  
der Größe 26 AWG oder größer verwenden.  
WARNING: Avvertenza Per ridurre il rischio di incendio, usare solo un cavo per linea  
di telecomunicazioni di sezione 0,12 mm2 (26 AWG) o maggiore.  
WARNING: Advarsel Bruk kun AWG nr. 26 eller telekommunikasjonsledninger med  
større dimensjon for å redusere faren for brann.  
WARNING: Aviso Para reduzir o risco de incêndio, utilize apenas terminais de fio  
de telecomunicações Nº. 26 AWG ou superiores.  
Safety Guidelines and Warnings  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
265  
   
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
WARNING: ¡Atención! Para reducir el riesgo de incendios, usar sólo líneas de  
telecomunicaciones de calibre No. 26 AWG o más gruesas.  
WARNING: Varning! För att minska brandrisken skall endast Nr. 26 AWG eller större  
telekommunikationsledning användas.  
Installation Safety Guidelines and Warnings  
Observe the following guidelines and warnings before and during Services Router  
installation:  
Chassis Lifting Guidelines  
The weight of a fully populated chassis is approximately 15.9 lbs (7.2 kg) for a J2320  
Services Router, 18.2 lbs (8.3 kg) for a J2350 Services Router, 25.3 lbs (11.5 kg) for  
a J4350 Services Router, and 30.7 lb (13.9 kg) for a J6350 Services Router. Observe  
the following guidelines for lifting and moving a Services Router:  
Installationon page 103 to verify that the intended site meets the specified  
power, environmental, and clearance requirements.  
Before lifting or moving the Services Router, disconnect all external cables.  
As when lifting any heavy object, lift most of the weight with your legs rather  
than your back. Keep your knees bent and your back relatively straight and avoid  
twisting your body as you lift. Balance the load evenly and be sure that your  
footing is solid.  
Installation Instructions Warning  
WARNING: Read the installation instructions before you connect the router to a  
power source.  
Waarschuwing Raadpleeg de installatie-aanwijzingen voordat u het systeem met de  
voeding verbindt.  
Varoitus Lue asennusohjeet ennen järjestelmän yhdistämistä virtalähteeseen.  
Attention Avant de brancher le système sur la source d'alimentation, consulter les  
directives d'installation.  
266  
Safety Guidelines and Warnings  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Chapter 14: Safety and Regulatory Compliance Information  
Warnung Lesen Sie die Installationsanweisungen, bevor Sie das System an die  
Stromquelle anschließen.  
WARNING: Avvertenza Consultare le istruzioni di installazione prima di collegare il  
sistema all'alimentatore.  
Advarsel Les installasjonsinstruksjonene før systemet kobles til strømkilden.  
Aviso Leia as instruções de instalação antes de ligar o sistema à sua fonte de energia.  
¡Atención! Ver las instrucciones de instalación antes de conectar el sistema a la red  
de alimentación.  
Varning! Läs installationsanvisningarna innan du kopplar systemet till dess  
strömförsörjningsenhet.  
Rack-Mounting Requirements and Warnings  
Ensure that the equipment rack into which the Services Router is installed is evenly  
and securely supported, to avoid the hazardous condition that could result from  
uneven mechanical loading.  
WARNING: To prevent bodily injury when mounting or servicing the router in a rack,  
take the following precautions to ensure that the system remains stable. The following  
directives help maintain your safety:  
The router must be installed into a rack that is secured to the building structure.  
The router should be mounted at the bottom of the rack if it is the only unit in  
the rack.  
When mounting the router in a partially filled rack, load the rack from the bottom  
to the top with the heaviest component at the bottom of the rack.  
If the rack is provided with stabilizing devices, install the stabilizers before  
mounting or servicing the router in the rack.  
WARNING: Waarschuwing Om lichamelijk letsel te voorkomen wanneer u dit toestel  
in een rek monteert of het daar een servicebeurt geeft, moet u speciale  
voorzorgsmaatregelen nemen om ervoor te zorgen dat het toestel stabiel blijft. De  
onderstaande richtlijnen worden verstrekt om uw veiligheid te verzekeren:  
Safety Guidelines and Warnings  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
267  
   
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
De Juniper Networks router moet in een stellage worden geïnstalleerd die aan  
een bouwsel is verankerd.  
Dit toestel dient onderaan in het rek gemonteerd te worden als het toestel het  
enige in het rek is.  
Wanneer u dit toestel in een gedeeltelijk gevuld rek monteert, dient u het rek  
van onderen naar boven te laden met het zwaarste onderdeel onderaan in het  
rek.  
Als het rek voorzien is van stabiliseringshulpmiddelen, dient u de stabilisatoren  
te monteren voordat u het toestel in het rek monteert of het daar een servicebeurt  
geeft.  
WARNING: Varoitus Kun laite asetetaan telineeseen tai huolletaan sen ollessa  
telineessä, on noudatettava erityisiä varotoimia järjestelmän vakavuuden  
säilyttämiseksi, jotta vältytään loukkaantumiselta. Noudata seuraavia  
turvallisuusohjeita:  
Juniper Networks router on asennettava telineeseen, joka on kiinnitetty  
rakennukseen.  
Jos telineessä ei ole muita laitteita, aseta laite telineen alaosaan.  
Jos laite asetetaan osaksi täytettyyn telineeseen, aloita kuormittaminen sen  
alaosasta kaikkein raskaimmalla esineellä ja siirry sitten sen yläosaan.  
Jos telinettä varten on vakaimet, asenna ne ennen laitteen asettamista telineeseen  
tai sen huoltamista siinä.  
WARNING: Attention Pour éviter toute blessure corporelle pendant les opérations  
de montage ou de réparation de cette unité en casier, il convient de prendre des  
précautions spéciales afin de maintenir la stabilité du système. Les directives  
ci-dessous sont destinées à assurer la protection du personnel:  
Le rack sur lequel est monté le Juniper Networks router doit être fixé à la structure  
du bâtiment.  
Si cette unité constitue la seule unité montée en casier, elle doit être placée dans  
le bas.  
Si cette unité est montée dans un casier partiellement rempli, charger le casier  
de bas en haut en plaçant l'élément le plus lourd dans le bas.  
Si le casier est équipé de dispositifs stabilisateurs, installer les stabilisateurs avant  
de monter ou de réparer l'unité en casier.  
268  
Safety Guidelines and Warnings  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 14: Safety and Regulatory Compliance Information  
WARNING: Warnung Zur Vermeidung von Körperverletzung beim Anbringen oder  
Warten dieser Einheit in einem Gestell müssen Sie besondere Vorkehrungen treffen,  
um sicherzustellen, daß das System stabil bleibt. Die folgenden Richtlinien sollen zur  
Gewährleistung Ihrer Sicherheit dienen:  
Der Juniper Networks router muß in einem Gestell installiert werden, das in der  
Gebäudestruktur verankert ist.  
Wenn diese Einheit die einzige im Gestell ist, sollte sie unten im Gestell  
angebracht werden.  
Bei Anbringung dieser Einheit in einem zum Teil gefüllten Gestell ist das Gestell  
von unten nach oben zu laden, wobei das schwerste Bauteil unten im Gestell  
anzubringen ist.  
Wird das Gestell mit Stabilisierungszubehör geliefert, sind zuerst die Stabilisatoren  
zu installieren, bevor Sie die Einheit im Gestell anbringen oder sie warten.  
WARNING: Avvertenza Per evitare infortuni fisici durante il montaggio o la  
manutenzione di questa unità in un supporto, occorre osservare speciali precauzioni  
per garantire che il sistema rimanga stabile. Le seguenti direttive vengono fornite  
per garantire la sicurezza personale:  
Il Juniper Networks router deve essere installato in un telaio, il quale deve essere  
fissato alla struttura dell'edificio.  
Questa unità deve venire montata sul fondo del supporto, se si tratta dell'unica  
unità da montare nel supporto.  
Quando questa unità viene montata in un supporto parzialmente pieno, caricare  
il supporto dal basso all'alto, con il componente più pesante sistemato sul fondo  
del supporto.  
Se il supporto è dotato di dispositivi stabilizzanti, installare tali dispositivi prima  
di montare o di procedere alla manutenzione dell'unità nel supporto.  
WARNING: Advarsel Unngå fysiske skader under montering eller reparasjonsarbeid  
på denne enheten når den befinner seg i et kabinett. Vær nøye med at systemet er  
stabilt. Følgende retningslinjer er gitt for å verne om sikkerheten:  
Juniper Networks router må installeres i et stativ som er forankret til  
bygningsstrukturen.  
Denne enheten bør monteres nederst i kabinettet hvis dette er den eneste enheten  
i kabinettet.  
Safety Guidelines and Warnings  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
269  
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
Ved montering av denne enheten i et kabinett som er delvis fylt, skal kabinettet  
lastes fra bunnen og opp med den tyngste komponenten nederst i kabinettet.  
Hvis kabinettet er utstyrt med stabiliseringsutstyr, skal stabilisatorene installeres  
før montering eller utføring av reparasjonsarbeid på enheten i kabinettet.  
WARNING: Aviso Para se prevenir contra danos corporais ao montar ou reparar esta  
unidade numa estante, deverá tomar precauções especiais para se certificar de que  
o sistema possui um suporte estável. As seguintes directrizes ajudá-lo-ão a efectuar  
o seu trabalho com segurança:  
O Juniper Networks router deverá ser instalado numa prateleira fixa à estrutura  
do edificio.  
Esta unidade deverá ser montada na parte inferior da estante, caso seja esta a  
única unidade a ser montada.  
Ao montar esta unidade numa estante parcialmente ocupada, coloque os itens  
mais pesados na parte inferior da estante, arrumando-os de baixo para cima.  
Se a estante possuir um dispositivo de estabilização, instale-o antes de montar  
ou reparar a unidade.  
WARNING: ¡Atención! Para evitar lesiones durante el montaje de este equipo sobre  
un bastidor, o posteriormente durante su mantenimiento, se debe poner mucho  
cuidado en que el sistema quede bien estable. Para garantizar su seguridad, proceda  
según las siguientes instrucciones:  
El Juniper Networks router debe instalarse en un bastidor fijado a la estructura  
del edificio.  
Colocar el equipo en la parte inferior del bastidor, cuando sea la única unidad  
en el mismo.  
Cuando este equipo se vaya a instalar en un bastidor parcialmente ocupado,  
comenzar la instalación desde la parte inferior hacia la superior colocando el  
equipo más pesado en la parte inferior.  
Si el bastidor dispone de dispositivos estabilizadores, instalar éstos antes de  
montar o proceder al mantenimiento del equipo instalado en el bastidor.  
WARNING: Varning! För att undvika kroppsskada när du installerar eller utför  
underhållsarbete på denna enhet på en ställning måste du vidta särskilda  
270  
Safety Guidelines and Warnings  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 14: Safety and Regulatory Compliance Information  
försiktighetsåtgärder för att försäkra dig om att systemet står stadigt. Följande riktlinjer  
ges för att trygga din säkerhet:  
Juniper Networks router måste installeras i en ställning som är förankrad i  
byggnadens struktur.  
Om denna enhet är den enda enheten på ställningen skall den installeras längst  
ned på ställningen.  
Om denna enhet installeras på en delvis fylld ställning skall ställningen fyllas  
nedifrån och upp, med de tyngsta enheterna längst ned på ställningen.  
Om ställningen är försedd med stabiliseringsdon skall dessa monteras fast innan  
enheten installeras eller underhålls på ställningen.  
Ramp Warning  
WARNING: When installing the router, do not use a ramp inclined at more than 10  
degrees.  
Waarschuwing Gebruik een oprijplaat niet onder een hoek van meer dan 10 graden.  
Varoitus Älä käytä sellaista kaltevaa pintaa, jonka kaltevuus ylittää 10 astetta.  
Attention Ne pas utiliser une rampe dont l'inclinaison est supérieure à 10 degrés.  
Warnung Keine Rampen mit einer Neigung von mehr als 10 Grad verwenden.  
WARNING: Avvertenza Non usare una rampa con pendenza superiore a 10 gradi.  
Advarsel Bruk aldri en rampe som heller mer enn 10 grader.  
Aviso Não utilize uma rampa com uma inclinação superior a 10 graus.  
¡Atención! No usar una rampa inclinada más de 10 grados  
Varning! Använd inte ramp med en lutning på mer än 10 grader.  
Laser and LED Safety Guidelines and Warnings  
Single-mode Physical Interface Modules (PIMs) are equipped with laser transmitters,  
which are considered a Class 1 Laser Product by the U.S. Food and Drug  
Administration, and are evaluated as a Class 1 Laser Product per EN 608251  
requirements.  
Safety Guidelines and Warnings  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
271  
       
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
Observe the following guidelines and warnings:  
General Laser Safety Guidelines  
When working around PIMs, observe the following safety guidelines to prevent eye  
injury:  
Do not look into unterminated ports or at fibers that connect to unknown sources.  
Do not examine unterminated optical ports with optical instruments.  
Avoid direct exposure to the beam.  
WARNING: Unterminated optical connectors can emit invisible laser radiation. The  
lens in the human eye focuses all the laser power on the retina, so focusing the eye  
directly on a laser sourceeven a low-power lasercould permanently damage the  
eye.  
Class 1 Laser Product Warning  
WARNING: Class 1 laser product.  
Waarschuwing Klasse-1 laser produkt.  
Varoitus Luokan 1 lasertuote.  
Attention Produit laser de classe I.  
Warnung Laserprodukt der Klasse 1.  
WARNING: Avvertenza Prodotto laser di Classe 1.  
Advarsel Laserprodukt av klasse 1.  
Aviso Produto laser de classe 1.  
¡Atención! Producto láser Clase I.  
Varning! Laserprodukt av klass 1.  
272  
Safety Guidelines and Warnings  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 14: Safety and Regulatory Compliance Information  
Class 1 LED Product Warning  
WARNING: Class 1 LED product.  
Waarschuwing Klasse 1 LED-product.  
Varoitus Luokan 1 valodiodituote.  
Attention Alarme de produit LED Class I.  
Warnung Class 1 LED-Produktwarnung.  
WARNING: Avvertenza Avvertenza prodotto LED di Classe 1.  
Advarsel LED-produkt i klasse 1.  
Aviso Produto de classe 1 com LED.  
¡Atención! Aviso sobre producto LED de Clase 1.  
Varning! Lysdiodprodukt av klass 1.  
Laser Beam Warning  
WARNING: Do not stare into the laser beam or view it directly with optical  
instruments.  
WARNING: Waarschuwing Niet in de straal staren of hem rechtstreeks bekijken met  
optische instrumenten.  
WARNING: Varoitus Älä katso säteeseen äläkä tarkastele sitä suoraan optisen laitteen  
avulla.  
WARNING: Attention Ne pas fixer le faisceau des yeux, ni l'observer directement à  
l'aide d'instruments optiques.  
Safety Guidelines and Warnings  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
273  
       
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
WARNING: Warnung Nicht direkt in den Strahl blicken und ihn nicht direkt mit  
optischen Geräten prüfen.  
WARNING: Avvertenza Non fissare il raggio con gli occhi né usare strumenti ottici  
per osservarlo direttamente.  
WARNING: Advarsel Stirr eller se ikke direkte p strlen med optiske instrumenter.  
WARNING: Aviso Não olhe fixamente para o raio, nem olhe para ele directamente  
com instrumentos ópticos.  
WARNING: ¡Atención! No mirar fijamente el haz ni observarlo directamente con  
instrumentos ópticos.  
WARNING: Varning! Rikta inte blicken in mot strålen och titta inte direkt på den  
genom optiska instrument.  
Radiation from Open Port Apertures Warning  
WARNING: Because invisible radiation may be emitted from the aperture of the port  
when no fiber cable is connected, avoid exposure to radiation and do not stare into  
open apertures.  
WARNING: Waarschuwing Aangezien onzichtbare straling vanuit de opening van  
de poort kan komen als er geen fiberkabel aangesloten is, dient blootstelling aan  
straling en het kijken in open openingen vermeden te worden.  
WARNING: Varoitus Koska portin aukosta voi emittoitua näkymätöntä säteilyä, kun  
kuitukaapelia ei ole kytkettynä, vältä säteilylle altistumista äläkä katso avoimiin  
aukkoihin.  
274  
Safety Guidelines and Warnings  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 14: Safety and Regulatory Compliance Information  
WARNING: Attention Des radiations invisibles à l'il nu pouvant traverser l'ouverture  
du port lorsqu'aucun câble en fibre optique n'y est connecté, il est recommandé de  
ne pas regarder fixement l'intérieur de ces ouvertures.  
WARNING: Warnung Aus der Port-Öffnung können unsichtbare Strahlen emittieren,  
wenn kein Glasfaserkabel angeschlossen ist. Vermeiden Sie es, sich den Strahlungen  
auszusetzen, und starren Sie nicht in die Öffnungen!  
WARNING: Avvertenza Quando i cavi in fibra non sono inseriti, radiazioni invisibili  
possono essere emesse attraverso l'apertura della porta. Evitate di esporvi alle  
radiazioni e non guardate direttamente nelle aperture.  
WARNING: Advarsel Unngå utsettelse for stråling, og stirr ikke inn i åpninger som  
er åpne, fordi usynlig stråling kan emiteres fra portens åpning når det ikke er tilkoblet  
en fiberkabel.  
WARNING: Aviso Dada a possibilidade de emissão de radiação invisível através do  
orifício da via de acesso, quando esta não tiver nenhum cabo de fibra conectado,  
deverá evitar a exposição à radiação e não deverá olhar fixamente para orifícios que  
se encontrarem a descoberto.  
WARNING: ¡Atención! Debido a que la apertura del puerto puede emitir radiación  
invisible cuando no existe un cable de fibra conectado, evite mirar directamente a  
las aperturas para no exponerse a la radiación.  
WARNING: Varning! Osynlig strålning kan avges från en portöppning utan ansluten  
fiberkabel och du bör därför undvika att bli utsatt för strålning genom att inte stirra  
in i oskyddade öppningar.  
Maintenance and Operational Safety Guidelines and Warnings  
As you maintain the Services Router, observe the following guidelines and warnings:  
Safety Guidelines and Warnings  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
275  
   
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
Battery Handling Warning  
WARNING: Replacing the battery incorrectly might result in an explosion. Replace  
the battery only with the same or equivalent type recommended by the manufacturer.  
Dispose of used batteries according to the manufacturer's instructions.  
WARNING: Waarschuwing Er is ontploffingsgevaar als de batterij verkeerd vervangen  
wordt. Vervang de batterij slechts met hetzelfde of een equivalent type dat door de  
fabrikant aanbevolen is. Gebruikte batterijen dienen overeenkomstig  
fabrieksvoorschriften weggeworpen te worden.  
WARNING: Varoitus Räjähdyksen vaara, jos akku on vaihdettu väärään akkuun.  
Käytä vaihtamiseen ainoastaan saman- tai vastaavantyyppistä akkua, joka on  
valmistajan suosittelema. Hävitä käytetyt akut valmistajan ohjeiden mukaan.  
WARNING: Attention Danger d'explosion si la pile n'est pas remplacée correctement.  
Ne la remplacer que par une pile de type semblable ou équivalent, recommandée  
par le fabricant. Jeter les piles usagées conformément aux instructions du fabricant.  
WARNING: Warnung Bei Einsetzen einer falschen Batterie besteht Explosionsgefahr.  
Ersetzen Sie die Batterie nur durch den gleichen oder vom Hersteller empfohlenen  
Batterietyp. Entsorgen Sie die benutzten Batterien nach den Anweisungen des  
Herstellers.  
WARNING: Advarsel Det kan være fare for eksplosjon hvis batteriet skiftes på feil  
måte. Skift kun med samme eller tilsvarende type som er anbefalt av produsenten.  
Kasser brukte batterier i henhold til produsentens instruksjoner.  
WARNING: Avvertenza Pericolo di esplosione se la batteria non è installata  
correttamente. Sostituire solo con una di tipo uguale o equivalente, consigliata dal  
produttore. Eliminare le batterie usate secondo le istruzioni del produttore.  
WARNING: Aviso Existe perigo de explosão se a bateria for substituída  
incorrectamente. Substitua a bateria por uma bateria igual ou de um tipo equivalente  
recomendado pelo fabricante. Destrua as baterias usadas conforme as instruções do  
fabricante.  
276  
Safety Guidelines and Warnings  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 14: Safety and Regulatory Compliance Information  
WARNING: ¡Atención! Existe peligro de explosión si la batería se reemplaza de  
manera incorrecta. Reemplazar la batería exclusivamente con el mismo tipo o el  
equivalente recomendado por el fabricante. Desechar las baterías gastadas según  
las instrucciones del fabricante.  
WARNING: Varning! Explosionsfara vid felaktigt batteribyte. Ersätt endast batteriet  
med samma batterityp som rekommenderas av tillverkaren eller motsvarande. Följ  
tillverkarens anvisningar vid kassering av använda batterier.  
Jewelry Removal Warning  
WARNING: Before working on equipment that is connected to power lines, remove  
jewelry, including rings, necklaces, and watches. Metal objects heat up when  
connected to power and ground and can cause serious burns or weld the metal object  
to the terminals.  
WARNING: Waarschuwing Alvorens aan apparatuur te werken die met elektrische  
leidingen is verbonden, sieraden (inclusief ringen, kettingen en horloges) verwijderen.  
Metalen voorwerpen worden warm wanneer ze met stroom en aarde zijn verbonden,  
en kunnen ernstige brandwonden veroorzaken of het metalen voorwerp aan de  
aansluitklemmen lassen.  
WARNING: Varoitus Ennen kuin työskentelet voimavirtajohtoihin kytkettyjen  
laitteiden parissa, ota pois kaikki korut (sormukset, kaulakorut ja kellot mukaan  
lukien). Metalliesineet kuumenevat, kun ne ovat yhteydessä sähkövirran ja maan  
kanssa, ja ne voivat aiheuttaa vakavia palovammoja tai hitsata metalliesineet kiinni  
liitäntänapoihin.  
WARNING: Attention Avant d'accéder à cet équipement connecté aux lignes  
électriques, ôter tout bijou (anneaux, colliers et montres compris). Lorsqu'ils sont  
branchés à l'alimentation et reliés à la terre, les objets métalliques chauffent, ce qui  
peut provoquer des blessures graves ou souder l'objet métallique aux bornes.  
WARNING: Warnung Vor der Arbeit an Geräten, die an das Netz angeschlossen sind,  
jeglichen Schmuck (einschließlich Ringe, Ketten und Uhren) abnehmen.  
Metallgegenstände erhitzen sich, wenn sie an das Netz und die Erde angeschlossen  
werden, und können schwere Verbrennungen verursachen oder an die  
Anschlußklemmen angeschweißt werden.  
Safety Guidelines and Warnings  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
277  
   
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
WARNING: Avvertenza Prima di intervenire su apparecchiature collegate alle linee  
di alimentazione, togliersi qualsiasi monile (inclusi anelli, collane, braccialetti ed  
orologi). Gli oggetti metallici si riscaldano quando sono collegati tra punti di  
alimentazione e massa: possono causare ustioni gravi oppure il metallo può saldarsi  
ai terminali.  
WARNING: Advarsel Fjern alle smykker (inkludert ringer, halskjeder og klokker) før  
du skal arbeide på utstyr som er koblet til kraftledninger. Metallgjenstander som er  
koblet til kraftledninger og jord blir svært varme og kan forårsake alvorlige  
brannskader eller smelte fast til polene.  
WARNING: Aviso Antes de trabalhar em equipamento que esteja ligado a linhas de  
corrente, retire todas as jóias que estiver a usar (incluindo anéis, fios e relógios). Os  
objectos metálicos aquecerão em contacto com a corrente e em contacto com a  
ligação à terra, podendo causar queimaduras graves ou ficarem soldados aos  
terminais.  
WARNING: ¡Atención! Antes de operar sobre equipos conectados a líneas de  
alimentación, quitarse las joyas (incluidos anillos, collares y relojes). Los objetos de  
metal se calientan cuando se conectan a la alimentación y a tierra, lo que puede  
ocasionar quemaduras graves o que los objetos metálicos queden soldados a los  
bornes.  
WARNING: Varning! Tag av alla smycken (inklusive ringar, halsband och armbandsur)  
innan du arbetar på utrustning som är kopplad till kraftledningar. Metallobjekt hettas  
upp när de kopplas ihop med ström och jord och kan förorsaka allvarliga brännskador;  
metallobjekt kan också sammansvetsas med kontakterna.  
Lightning Activity Warning  
WARNING: Do not work on the system or connect or disconnect cables during periods  
of lightning activity.  
WARNING: Waarschuwing Tijdens onweer dat gepaard gaat met bliksem, dient u  
niet aan het systeem te werken of kabels aan te sluiten of te ontkoppelen.  
278  
Safety Guidelines and Warnings  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 14: Safety and Regulatory Compliance Information  
WARNING: Varoitus Älä työskentele järjestelmän parissa äläkä yhdistä tai irrota  
kaapeleita ukkosilmalla.  
WARNING: Attention Ne pas travailler sur le système ni brancher ou débrancher les  
câbles pendant un orage.  
WARNING: Warnung Arbeiten Sie nicht am System und schließen Sie keine Kabel  
an bzw. trennen Sie keine ab, wenn es gewittert.  
WARNING: Avvertenza Non lavorare sul sistema o collegare oppure scollegare i cavi  
durante un temporale con fulmini.  
WARNING: Advarsel Utfør aldri arbeid på systemet, eller koble kabler til eller fra  
systemet når det tordner eller lyner.  
WARNING: Aviso Não trabalhe no sistema ou ligue e desligue cabos durante períodos  
de mau tempo (trovoada).  
WARNING: ¡Atención! No operar el sistema ni conectar o desconectar cables durante  
el transcurso de descargas eléctricas en la atmósfera.  
WARNING: Varning! Vid åska skall du aldrig utföra arbete på systemet eller ansluta  
eller koppla loss kablar.  
Operating Temperature Warning  
WARNING: To prevent the router from overheating, do not operate it in an area that  
ο
ο
exceeds the maximum recommended ambient temperature of 104 F (40 C). To  
prevent airflow restriction, allow at least 6 inches (15.2 cm) of clearance around the  
ventilation openings.  
WARNING: Waarschuwing Om te voorkomen dat welke router van de Juniper  
Networks router dan ook oververhit raakt, dient u deze niet te bedienen op een plaats  
Safety Guidelines and Warnings  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
279  
   
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
ο
waar de maximale aanbevolen omgevingstemperatuur van 40 C wordt overschreden.  
Om te voorkomen dat de luchtstroom wordt beperkt, dient er minstens 15,2 cm  
speling rond de ventilatie-openingen te zijn.  
WARNING: Varoitus Ettei Juniper Networks router-sarjan reititin ylikuumentuisi, sitä  
ei saa käyttää tilassa, jonka lämpötila ylittää korkeimman suositellun  
ο
ympäristölämpötilan 40 C. Ettei ilmanvaihto estyisi, tuuletusaukkojen ympärille on  
jätettävä ainakin 15,2 cm tilaa.  
WARNING: Attention Pour éviter toute surchauffe des routeurs de la gamme Juniper  
Networks router, ne l'utilisez pas dans une zone où la température ambiante est  
ο
supérieure à 40 C. Pour permettre un flot d'air constant, dégagez un espace d'au  
moins 15,2 cm autour des ouvertures de ventilations.  
WARNING: Warnung Um einen Router der router vor Überhitzung zu schützen, darf  
dieser nicht in einer Gegend betrieben werden, in der die Umgebungstemperatur  
ο
das empfohlene Maximum von 40 C überschreitet. Um Lüftungsverschluß zu  
verhindern, achten Sie darauf, daß mindestens 15,2 cm lichter Raum um die  
Lüftungsöffnungen herum frei bleibt.  
WARNING: Avvertenza Per evitare il surriscaldamento dei router, non adoperateli  
ο
in un locale che ecceda la temperatura ambientale massima di 40 C. Per evitare che  
la circolazione dell'aria sia impedita, lasciate uno spazio di almeno 15.2 cm di fronte  
alle aperture delle ventole.  
WARNING: Advarsel Unngå overoppheting av eventuelle rutere i Juniper Networks  
router Disse skal ikke brukes på steder der den anbefalte maksimale  
ο
ο
omgivelsestemperaturen overstiger 40 C (104 F). Sørg for at klaringen rundt  
lufteåpningene er minst 15,2 cm (6 tommer) for å forhindre nedsatt luftsirkulasjon.  
WARNING: Aviso Para evitar o sobreaquecimento do encaminhador Juniper Networks  
router, não utilize este equipamento numa área que exceda a temperatura máxima  
ο
recomendada de 40 C. Para evitar a restrição à circulação de ar, deixe pelo menos  
um espaço de 15,2 cm à volta das aberturas de ventilação.  
WARNING: ¡Atención! Para impedir que un encaminador de la serie Juniper Networks  
router se recaliente, no lo haga funcionar en un área en la que se supere la  
280  
Safety Guidelines and Warnings  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 14: Safety and Regulatory Compliance Information  
ο
temperatura ambiente máxima recomendada de 40 C. Para impedir la restricción  
de la entrada de aire, deje un espacio mínimo de 15,2 cm alrededor de las aperturas  
para ventilación.  
WARNING: Varning! Förhindra att en Juniper Networks router överhettas genom att  
inte använda den i ett område där den maximalt rekommenderade  
ο
omgivningstemperaturen på 40 C överskrids. Förhindra att luftcirkulationen inskränks  
genom att se till att det finns fritt utrymme på minst 15,2 cm omkring  
ventilationsöppningarna.  
Product Disposal Warning  
WARNING: Disposal of this product must be handled according to all national laws  
and regulations.  
WARNING: Waarschuwing Dit produkt dient volgens alle landelijke wetten en  
voorschriften te worden afgedankt.  
WARNING: Varoitus Tämän tuotteen lopullisesta hävittämisestä tulee huolehtia  
kaikkia valtakunnallisia lakeja ja säännöksiä noudattaen.  
WARNING: Attention La mise au rebut définitive de ce produit doit être effectuée  
conformément à toutes les lois et réglementations en vigueur.  
WARNING: Warnung Dieses Produkt muß den geltenden Gesetzen und Vorschriften  
entsprechend entsorgt werden.  
WARNING: Avvertenza L'eliminazione finale di questo prodotto deve essere eseguita  
osservando le normative italiane vigenti in materia  
WARNING: Advarsel Endelig disponering av dette produktet må skje i henhold til  
nasjonale lover og forskrifter.  
Safety Guidelines and Warnings  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
281  
   
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
WARNING: Aviso A descartagem final deste produto deverá ser efectuada de acordo  
com os regulamentos e a legislação nacional.  
WARNING: ¡Atención! El desecho final de este producto debe realizarse según todas  
las leyes y regulaciones nacionales  
WARNING: Varning! Slutlig kassering av denna produkt bör skötas i enlighet med  
landets alla lagar och föreskrifter.  
Agency Approvals  
The Services Router complies with the following standards:  
Safety  
CAN/CSA-22.2 No. 60950103UL 609501 Safety of Information  
Technology Equipment  
EN 609501 Safety of Information Technology Equipment  
EN 60825-1 Safety of Laser Products - Part 1: Equipment Classification,  
Requirements and User's Guide  
EMC (J2320 and J2350)  
AS/NZS 3548 Class A (Australia/New Zealand)  
EN 55022 Class A Emissions (Europe)  
FCC Part 15 Class A (USA)  
VCCI Class A (Japan)  
FCC Part 68  
Industry Canada CS-03  
EMC (J4320 and J6350)  
AS/NZS 3548 Class B (Australia/New Zealand)  
EN 55022 Class B Emissions (Europe)  
FCC Part 15 Class B (USA)  
VCCI Class B (Japan)  
FCC Part 68  
Industry Canada CS-03  
Immunity  
282  
Agency Approvals  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 14: Safety and Regulatory Compliance Information  
EN 61000-3-2 Power Line Harmonics  
EN 61000-3-3 Voltage Fluctuations and Flicker  
EN 61000-4-2 ESD  
EN 61000-4-3 Radiated Immunity  
EN 61000-4-4 EFT  
EN 61000-4-5 Surge  
EN 61000-4-6 Low Frequency Common Immunity  
EN 61000-4-11 Voltage Dips and Sags  
ETSI  
ETSI EN-300386-2 Telecommunication Network Equipment. Electromagnetic  
Compatibility Requirements  
Compliance Statements for Environmental Requirements  
Lithium Battery  
Batteries in this product are not based on mercury, lead, or cadmium substances.  
The batteries used in this product are in compliance with EU Directives 91/157/EEC,  
93/86/EEC, and 98/101/EEC. The product documentation includes instructional  
information about the proper method of reclamation and recycling.  
Compliance Statements for NEBS  
This product complies with the following Network Equipment Building System (NEBS)  
standards:  
The equipment is suitable for installation as part of the Common Bonding Network  
(CBN).  
The equipment is suitable for installation in locations where the National Electrical  
Code (NEC) applies.  
The battery return connection is to be treated as a Common DC return (DC-C),  
as defined in GR-1089-CORE.  
The minimum steady-state operating voltage is -32 V.  
Compliance Statements for EMC Requirements  
Compliance Statements for Environmental Requirements  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
283  
           
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
Canada  
This Class B digital apparatus complies with Canadian ICES-003.  
Cet appareil numérique de la classe B est conforme à la norme NMB-003 du Canada.  
The Industry Canada label identifies certified equipment. This certification means  
that the equipment meets certain telecommunications network protective, operational,  
and safety requirements. Industry Canada does not guarantee the equipment will  
operate to the userssatisfaction.  
Before installing this equipment, users should ensure that it is permissible to be  
connected to the facilities of the local telecommunications company. The equipment  
must also be installed using an acceptable method of connection. In some cases, the  
inside wiring associated with a single line individual service may be extended by  
means of a certified connector assembly. The customer should be aware that  
compliance with the above conditions may not prevent degradation of service in  
some situations.  
Repairs to certified equipment should be made by an authorized Canadian  
maintenance facility designated by the supplier. Any repairs or alterations made by  
the user to this equipment, or equipment malfunctions, may give the  
telecommunications company cause to request the user to disconnect the equipment.  
CAUTION: Users should not attempt to make electrical ground connections by  
themselves, but should contact the appropriate inspection authority or an electrician,  
as appropriate.  
Users should ensure for their own protection that the electrical ground connections  
of the power utility, telephone lines, and internal metallic water pipe system, if  
present, are connected together. This precaution may be particularly important in  
rural areas.  
284  
Compliance Statements for EMC Requirements  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 14: Safety and Regulatory Compliance Information  
European Community  
Compliance Statements for EMC Requirements  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
285  
   
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
Japan  
The preceding translates as follows:  
This is a Class B product based on the standard of the Voluntary Control Council for  
Interference by Information Technology Equipment (VCCI). If this product is used  
near a radio or television receiver in a domestic environment, it may cause radio  
interference. Install and use the equipment according to the instruction manual.  
286  
Compliance Statements for EMC Requirements  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 14: Safety and Regulatory Compliance Information  
United States  
The Services Router has been tested and found to comply with the limits for a Class  
B digital device, pursuant to Part 15 of the FCC Rules. These limits are designed to  
provide reasonable protection against harmful interference when the equipment is  
operated in a commercial environment. This equipment generates, uses, and can  
radiate radio frequency energy and, if not installed and used in accordance with the  
instruction manual, may cause harmful interference to radio communications.  
Operation of this equipment in a residential area is likely to cause harmful interference  
in which case the user will be required to correct the interference at his own expense.  
FCC Part 15 Statement  
This equipment has been tested and found to comply with the limits for a Class B  
digital device pursuant to Part 15 of the FCC Rules. These limits are designed to  
provide reasonable protection against harmful interference in a residential installation.  
This equipment generates, uses, and can radiate radio frequency energy and, if not  
installed and used in accordance with the instructions, may cause harmful interference  
to radio communications. However, there is no guarantee that interference will not  
occur in a particular installation.  
If this equipment does cause harmful interference to radio or television reception,  
which can be determined by turning the equipment off and on, the user is encouraged  
to try and correct the interference by one or more of the following measures:  
Reorient or relocate the receiving antenna.  
Increase the separation between the equipment and the receiver.  
Connect the equipment into an outlet on a circuit different from that to which  
the receiver is connected.  
Consult the dealer or an experienced radio or TV technician for help.  
FCC Part 68 Statement  
This equipment complies with Part 68 of the Federal Communications Commission  
(FCC) rules. On the product is a label that contains the FCC registration number for  
this device. If requested, this information must be provided to the telephone company.  
This equipment is designed to be connected to the telephone network or premises  
wiring using a compatible modular jack which is Part 68 compliant. See installation  
instructions for details.  
If this device causes harm to the telephone network, the telephone company will  
notify you in advance that temporary discontinuance of service may be required.  
The telephone company may request that you disconnect the equipment until the  
problem is resolved. The telephone company may make changes in its facilities,  
equipment, operations or procedures that could affect the operation of this equipment.  
If this happens, the telephone company will provide advance notice in order for you  
to make necessary modifications to maintain uninterrupted service.  
Compliance Statements for EMC Requirements  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
287  
           
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
If trouble is experienced with this equipment or for repair or warranty information,  
please follow the applicable procedures explained in the Technical Supportsection  
of this manual.  
FCC Registration NumberSee label on product.  
Required Connector (USOC)RJ-48C  
Service Order Code (SOC)6.ON  
288  
Compliance Statements for EMC Requirements  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Part 5  
Index  
Index  
289  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
290  
Index  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
plug types...........................................................110  
replacing.............................................................191  
accident, steps to take................................................261  
ACT LED......................................................................72  
TIM508.................................................................74  
TIM510.................................................................75  
TIM514.................................................................76  
TIM516.................................................................77  
TIM518.................................................................79  
TIM521.................................................................80  
ACTIVITY LED (Dual-Port Fast Ethernet PIM)...............61  
adapter, console port  
Symbols  
#, comments in configuration statements.................xviii  
#, configuration mode command prompt....................93  
( ), in syntax descriptions..........................................xviii  
* (red asterisk).............................................................86  
4-Port Fast Ethernet ePIM............................................61  
4-Port ISDN BRI S/T PIM  
description............................................................62  
PIM ONLINE LED..................................................63  
4-Port ISDN BRI U PIM  
description............................................................62  
PIM ONLINE LED..................................................63  
< >, in syntax descriptions......................................xviii  
>, operational mode command prompt......................92  
? command  
for CLI online help................................................96  
in configuration mode...........................................93  
in operational mode..............................................92  
? icon ..........................................................................86  
[ ], in configuration statements..................................xviii  
{ }, in configuration statements................................xviii  
| (pipe), in syntax descriptions...................................xviii  
chassis........................................................139, 142  
TGM550................................................................70  
addresses  
ge-0/0/0 for autoinstallation................................134  
loopback.............................................................134  
management interface........................................134  
ADSL PIM  
description............................................................64  
PIM ONLINE LED..................................................65  
ADSL ports  
description............................................................64  
LED states.............................................................65  
RJ-11 connector pinouts......................................238  
agency approvals.......................................................282  
air filter  
A
AC plug types.............................................................110  
AC power  
description......................................................25, 38  
location...............................................................207  
replacing.............................................................206  
airflow  
connecting power...............................................124  
cords See AC power cords  
dedicated AC power feed requirement................194  
electrical specifications.......................................109  
grounding the router...........................................124  
installing a J6350 power supply..........................193  
J2320 system........................................................24  
J2350 system........................................................24  
J4350 system........................................................36  
J6350 system........................................................37  
removing a J6350 power supply.........................192  
requirements......................................................109  
safety guidelines.................................................253  
AC power cords  
description............................................................39  
space requirement..............................................103  
ALARM LED  
description......................................................21, 34  
indications..........................................................209  
alarms  
conditions, in chassis components......................209  
LED.................................................................21, 34  
ALM LED......................................................................72  
TIM508.................................................................74  
TIM510.................................................................75  
TIM514.................................................................76  
TIM516.................................................................77  
TIM518.................................................................79  
TIM521.................................................................80  
electrical specifications.......................................110  
physical requirements.........................................109  
Index  
291  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
alternative boot media See boot devices; USB  
altitude requirement..................................................106  
B
backup compact flash, removing...............................184  
backup router  
defining (configuration editor)............................149  
description..........................................................134  
basic connectivity  
analog media module See TIM514  
analog telephone (LINE) ports  
TGM550, pinouts................................................240  
TIM508, possible configurations...........................73  
TIM514, pinouts..................................................242  
TIM514, possible configurations...........................76  
TIM516, possible configurations...........................77  
TIM518, possible configurations...........................78  
analog trunk (TRUNK) ports  
TGM550, pinouts................................................240  
TIM508, possible configurations...........................73  
TIM514, pinouts..................................................242  
TIM514, possible configurations...........................76  
TIM516, possible configurations...........................77  
TIM518, possible configurations...........................78  
Annex A; Annex B See ADSL; SHDSL  
CLI configuration editor......................................147  
establishing.........................................................131  
J-Web configuration editor..................................147  
Quick Configuration............................................143  
requirements......................................................136  
sample configuration..........................................150  
secure Web access..............................................153  
verifying.............................................................150  
battery  
environmental compliance.................................283  
handling..............................................................276  
lithium................................................................283  
BGP route reflectors license........................................162  
blank panel  
antistatic mat.............................................................251  
Apply button................................................................88  
approvals, agency......................................................282  
ASB LED.......................................................................72  
asymmetric digital subscriber line See ADSL  
for PIM slots..........................................................46  
for power supply (J6350).....................................191  
blinking  
AT modem command........................................142, 143  
AT&D1 modem command.........................................142  
AT&K0 modem command.........................................142  
AT&W modem command..........................................142  
ATDT modem command...........................................143  
ATS0=1 modem command.......................................142  
AUX port................................................................23, 36  
auxiliary console port.............................................23, 36  
Avaya IG550 Integrated Gateway See Avaya VoIP  
modules  
Fast Ethernet port ACTIVITY LED state (dual-port  
PIM)..................................................................61  
Fast Ethernet port link activity LED state (4-port  
ePIM).................................................................62  
Gigabit Ethernet port LED ....................................51  
Gigabit Ethernet port TX/RX LED  
state......................................................23, 35, 54  
ISDN BRI ONLINE LED state.................................63  
POWER LED state...........................................21, 33  
STATUS (router) LED state..............................21, 34  
TIM508 ACT (active) LED state..............................74  
TIM514 ACT (active) LED state..............................76  
TIM516 ACT (active) LED state..............................77  
TIM518 ACT (active) LED state..............................79  
boot devices...........................................................19, 31  
external compact flash..........................................24  
boot process, backup router for.................................134  
boot sequence........................................................19, 31  
Border Gateway Protocol (BGP) route reflectors  
license....................................................................162  
bottom pane................................................................84  
braces, in configuration statements...........................xviii  
brackets  
Avaya VoIP modules  
connector pinouts...............................................239  
grounding, 10 AWG replacement cable.................66  
heat dissipation...................................................112  
LEDs See LEDs  
non-hot-swappability............................................66  
overview...............................................................43  
power consumption............................................112  
power management, planning............................112  
power management, troubleshooting.................210  
requirements........................................................67  
summary........................................................67, 68  
TGM550................................................................69  
TGM550 maximum gateway capacities.................71  
TIM508.................................................................73  
TIM510.................................................................74  
TIM514.................................................................75  
TIM516.................................................................76  
TIM518.................................................................78  
TIM521.................................................................79  
angle, in syntax descriptions..............................xviii  
square, in configuration statements...................xviii  
BRI media module See TIM521  
browser interface See J-Web interface  
BTUs per hour............................................................106  
built-in Ethernet ports See Gigabit Ethernet ports  
buttons  
Apply (Quick Configuration)..................................88  
Cancel (J-Web configuration editor).......................89  
Cancel (Quick Configuration)................................88  
292  
Index  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
Commit (J-Web configuration editor)....................89  
OK (J-Web configuration editor)............................88  
OK (Quick Configuration)......................................88  
power.............................................................20, 33  
RESET CONFIG...............................................22, 35  
TIM514 analog pinouts.......................................242  
TIM516 pinouts...................................................242  
TIM518 pinouts...................................................244  
TIM521 ISDN BRI pinouts...................................245  
Canada, compliance statement..................................284  
Cancel button  
J-Web configuration editor....................................89  
Quick Configuration..............................................88  
case number, for JTAC...............................................216  
certificates See SSL certificates  
C
cables  
AC power See AC power cords  
ADSL RJ-11 pinouts.............................................238  
arranging for safety.............................................175  
Avaya VoIP 10 AWG replacement grounding  
cable.................................................................66  
chassis console port, DB-9 connector  
channelized E1 PIM.....................................................57  
channelized E1 ports  
description............................................................57  
LED states.............................................................58  
RJ-48 cable pinouts.............................................235  
channelized T1 PIM......................................................57  
channelized T1 ports  
pinouts............................................................235  
chassis console port, RJ-45 connector  
pinouts............................................................234  
connecting to network media.............................123  
console port cable (chassis),  
connecting..............................................139, 142  
console port cable (chassis), replacing................172  
DC cables See DC power cables  
disconnecting PIM cables....................................175  
E1 RJ-48 pinouts.................................................235  
Ethernet cable, connecting..................137, 139, 142  
Fast Ethernet RJ-45 connector pinout.................233  
Gigabit Ethernet RJ-45 connector pinouts  
description............................................................57  
LED states.............................................................58  
RJ-48 cable pinouts.............................................235  
chassis  
alarm conditions and remedies...........................209  
component serial number labels.................213, 214  
cover, replacing (J2320 and J2350).....................176  
dimensions.....................................................17, 30  
environmental tolerances...................................106  
grounding...........................................................123  
heat dissipation...................................................112  
J2320....................................................................13  
J2350....................................................................13  
J4350....................................................................27  
J6350....................................................................27  
lifting guidelines..................................................266  
PIM slot numbers............................................20, 32  
power consumption............................................112  
power management, planning............................112  
power management, troubleshooting.................210  
rack requirements...............................................104  
weight.............................................................17, 30  
chassis software process..............................................40  
chassisd process..........................................................40  
checklist, for site preparation.....................................115  
clear operation, RESET CONFIG button..................22, 35  
clear-text access.........................................................135  
clearance...................................................................103  
CLI See JUNOS CLI  
(ePIM).............................................................234  
Gigabit Ethernet RJ-45 connector pinouts  
(uPIMs)............................................................233  
grounding...........................................................123  
ISDN RJ-45 pinouts.............................................239  
PIM, installing.....................................................175  
PIM, removing....................................................175  
reducing radio frequency interference (RFI)........108  
serial EIA-530A DCE pinouts...............................229  
serial EIA-530A DTE pinouts...............................228  
serial PIM specifications......................................223  
serial RS-232 DCE pinouts..................................225  
serial RS-232 DTE pinouts...................................224  
serial RS-422/449 (EIA-449) DCE pinouts............227  
serial RS-422/449 (EIA-449) DTE pinouts............225  
serial V.35 DCE pinouts......................................231  
serial V.35 DTE pinouts.......................................230  
serial X.21 DCE pinouts......................................232  
serial X.21 DTE pinouts......................................231  
SHDSL RJ-11 pinouts...........................................238  
T1 RJ-48 pinouts.................................................235  
TGM550 analog pinouts......................................240  
TGM550 console port, DB-9 connector  
CLI configuration editor  
basic settings......................................................147  
initial configuration.............................................147  
secure access configuration................................158  
statement types....................................................94  
CLI terminal See JUNOS CLI  
pinouts............................................................239  
TGM550 console port, RJ-45 connector  
command completion  
pinouts............................................................239  
TIM508 pinouts...................................................241  
TIM510 E1/T1 pinouts........................................241  
description............................................................95  
setting on and off..................................................98  
command hierarchy.....................................................91  
Index  
293  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
command prompts  
connectivity  
changing...............................................................98  
configuration mode (#).........................................93  
operational mode (>)...........................................92  
command-line interface See CLI configuration editor;  
JUNOS CLI  
comments, in configuration statements....................xviii  
Commit button............................................................89  
committed configuration  
basic See basic connectivity  
hardware............................................................117  
modem (remote) connection..............................141  
regaining lost DHCP lease after initial  
configuration...................................................145  
through J-Web.....................................................137  
through the CLI locally........................................139  
through the CLI remotely....................................141  
root password requirement.................................133  
Common Criteria environments  
management access affected..............................136  
NTP requirement................................................133  
password limitations...........................................133  
compact flash  
backup, replacing................................................184  
description......................................................18, 31  
external, description.............................................24  
external, J2320 and J2350....................................24  
external, replacing..............................................184  
inserting.............................................................183  
location (horizontal)............................................182  
location (vertical)................................................181  
minor (yellow) alarm..........................................209  
removing............................................................183  
replacing.....................................................178, 181  
replacing, rotating fans warning.................179, 182  
compliance  
connector pinouts  
TIM508 ports......................................................241  
TIM516 ports......................................................242  
TIM518 ports......................................................244  
console port  
adapter (chassis).........................................139, 142  
adapter (TGM550).................................................70  
auxiliary console port......................................23, 36  
connecting through the CLI locally......................139  
connecting through the CLI remotely..................141  
description......................................................23, 36  
on chassis, DB-9 connector pinouts....................235  
on chassis, RJ-45 connector pinouts....................234  
on TGM550, DB-9 connector pinouts..................239  
on TGM550, RJ-45 connector pinouts.................239  
replacing the cable..............................................172  
settings for local CLI connection.........................140  
settings for modem connection at router for  
remote CLI access...........................................142  
settings for modem connection for remote CLI  
access.............................................................143  
container statements...................................................94  
conventions  
EMC requirements..............................................283  
general standards...............................................282  
lithium battery....................................................276  
components  
packing for shipment..........................................218  
replacing.............................................................171  
serial number label.....................................213, 214  
troubleshooting...................................................209  
See also LEDs  
how to use this guide...........................................xvi  
notice icons.........................................................xvii  
text and syntax...................................................xvii  
cooling system  
airflow requirement............................................103  
description......................................................25, 38  
Copper Gigabit Ethernet ePIMs  
overview...............................................................52  
pinouts................................................................234  
Copper Gigabit Ethernet uPIMs  
overview...............................................................49  
pinouts................................................................233  
cords See AC power cords; cables; DC power cables  
cover, replacing (J2320 and J2350)............................176  
Crypto Accelerator Module  
description......................................................18, 31  
installing.....................................................200, 204  
location.......................................................198, 201  
removing....................................................199, 202  
curly braces, in configuration statements..................xviii  
customer support........................................................xxi  
contacting JTAC....................................................xxi  
contacting JTAC for hardware return...................216  
information required for hardware return...........216  
configuration  
clearing with RESET CONFIG button...............22, 35  
factory, resetting with RESET CONFIG  
button.........................................................22, 35  
root password requirement.................................133  
configuration editor See CLI configuration editor; J-Web  
configuration editor  
configuration hierarchy, J-Web display.........................87  
configuration mode  
commands............................................................93  
prompt (#)............................................................93  
connection  
AC power............................................................124  
DC power............................................................126  
for management.................................................131  
network cables....................................................123  
to Services Router...............................................137  
294  
Index  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
DIMMs (dual inline memory modules) See DRAM  
modules  
D
daemons See processes, software  
direct inward dialing, on line ports...................73, 75, 78  
DNS (Domain Name System).....................................133  
DNS server  
defining (configuration editor)............................149  
defining (Quick Configuration)............................146  
function..............................................................133  
documentation set  
datasheets URL............................................................43  
DB-9 connector pinouts  
chassis console port............................................235  
TGM550 console port..........................................239  
DB-9 to DB-25 serial port adapter..............................142  
DC power  
cables See DC power cables  
comments on.......................................................xxi  
domain name............................................................132  
defining (configuration editor)............................148  
defining (Quick Configuration)............................145  
See also DNS server  
Domain Name System...............................................133  
domain search  
defining (configuration editor)............................149  
defining (Quick Configuration)............................146  
downloading  
connecting power...............................................126  
dedicated DC power feed requirement...............197  
electrical specifications.......................................109  
grounding requirements and warning.................257  
grounding the router...........................................127  
installing a J6350 power supply..........................196  
J2320 system........................................................24  
J2350 system........................................................24  
J4350 system........................................................36  
J6350 system........................................................37  
power disconnection warning.............................255  
removing a J6350 power supply.........................195  
requirements......................................................109  
safety guidelines (general)...................................254  
safety guidelines, power sources for redundant  
power supplies................................................255  
wiring sequence warning....................................257  
wiring terminations warning...............................259  
DC power cables  
licenses (J-Web)...................................................164  
DRAM modules  
installing.............................................................190  
location...............................................................188  
removing............................................................189  
dry chemical fire extinguishers, prohibited................107  
DS1 ports See E1 ports; T1 ports  
DS3 ports See E3 ports; T3 ports  
DSL See ADSL; SHDSL  
dual inline memory modules See DRAM modules  
Dual-Port Channelized T1/E1/ISDN PRI PIM.................57  
Dual-Port E1 PIM..........................................................56  
Dual-Port E3 PIM .........................................................59  
Dual-Port Fast Ethernet PIM.........................................60  
Dual-Port Serial PIM.....................................................55  
Dual-Port T1 PIM..........................................................56  
Dual-Port T3 PIM .........................................................59  
electrical specifications.......................................111  
physical requirements.........................................111  
replacing.............................................................194  
usage warning.....................................................254  
Declaration of Conformity..........................................285  
default gateway  
defining (Quick Configuration)............................146  
description..........................................................134  
deleting  
all configurations with RESCUE CONFIG  
E
button.........................................................22, 35  
licenses (CLI).......................................................165  
licenses (J-Web)...................................................164  
DHCP (Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol)............134  
DHCP server  
E1 ports  
description............................................................56  
See also channelized E1 ports  
LED states.............................................................57  
RJ-48 cable pinouts.............................................235  
E1 trunk ports, TIM510  
description............................................................74  
pinouts................................................................241  
E1/T1 media module See TIM508 See TIM510 See  
TIM516 See TIM518  
after initial configuration.....................................134  
before initial configuration..................................134  
regaining lost lease after initial  
configuration...................................................145  
diagnosis  
chassis................................................................209  
hardware............................................................209  
dial-up modem connection See modem connection to  
router console port  
E3 ports  
BNC connector pinouts.......................................238  
description............................................................59  
LED states.............................................................60  
earth ground See grounding  
DID on line ports..............................................73, 75, 78  
digital certificate See SSL certificates  
digital subscriber line See ADSL; SHDSL  
Index  
295  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
earthquakes  
F
rack-mount requirements...................................105  
seismic requirements..........................................106  
factory configuration, resetting with RESCUE CONFIG  
button................................................................22, 35  
failures  
compact flash, USB for....................................24, 36  
PIM, troubleshooting...........................................210  
Routing Engine fan, troubleshooting...................210  
fans  
description......................................................25, 38  
See also air filter  
See also cooling system  
failure, troubleshooting.......................................210  
Fast Ethernet ports  
4-Port Fast Ethernet ePIM.....................................61  
ACTIVITY status (dual-port PIM)............................61  
Dual-Port Fast Ethernet PIM..................................60  
LED states (4-port ePIM).......................................62  
LED states (dual-port PIM).....................................61  
link activity (4-port ePIM)......................................62  
link status (4-port ePIM)........................................62  
LINK/ SPEED status (dual-port PIM).......................61  
RJ-45 connector pinout.......................................233  
FCC Part 15 compliance statement............................287  
FCC Part 68 compliance statement............................287  
feature licenses See licenses  
feature overview............................................................7  
field-replaceable units, replacing................................171  
filter cover See air filter  
filter, air See air filter  
fire extinguishers  
prohibited...........................................................107  
required..............................................................107  
fire safety requirements.............................................106  
fire suppression  
equipment required............................................107  
shutdown requirement.......................................106  
font conventions.........................................................xvii  
forwarding software process........................................40  
FPC, PIM slot number in command  
displays..........................................................176, 213  
front panel.............................................................19, 32  
FRUs (field-replaceable units), replacing.....................171  
fwdd process................................................................40  
EIA-530A DCE cable pinouts......................................229  
EIA-530A DTE cable pinouts......................................228  
electrical specifications..............................................109  
electricity  
safety warnings...................................................252  
wiring guidelines.................................................108  
electromagnetic compatibility (EMC) See EMC  
electromagnetic interference (EMI) See See EMI  
electrostatic bag, for storing components...................251  
electrostatic discharge, preventing.............................251  
elements, J-Web...........................................................84  
EMC (electromagnetic compatibility)  
compliance with requirements............................283  
preventing problems with...................................108  
standards............................................................282  
EMI (electromagnetic interference)  
compliance with requirements............................283  
standards............................................................282  
suppressing.........................................................108  
encrypted access  
through HTTPS...................................................153  
through SSH........................................................136  
through SSL........................................................153  
environment, CLI  
displaying.............................................................97  
setting...................................................................97  
environmental requirements for operation................106  
ePIMs  
4-Port Fast Ethernet..............................................61  
Copper Gigabit Ethernet........................................52  
SFP Gigabit Ethernet.............................................52  
slot locations.........................................................33  
EPROM..................................................................18, 31  
ESD (electrostatic discharge), preventing...................251  
ESD wrist strap  
verifying resistance, for safety............................251  
wearing during installation....................................27  
Ethernet cable  
chassis console DB-9 connector pinouts..............235  
chassis console, RJ-45 connector pinouts............234  
connecting the Services Router to a management  
device.....................................................137, 139  
connecting the Services Router to a modem.......142  
replacing.............................................................172  
TGM550 console DB-9 connector pinouts...........239  
TGM550 console, RJ-45 connector pinouts..........239  
Ethernet ports See Fast Ethernet ports See Gigabit  
Ethernet ports  
G
G.SHDSL PIM  
description............................................................65  
PIM ONLINE LED..................................................66  
G.SHDSL ports See SHDSL ports  
Gateway Module See TGM550  
ETR LED.......................................................................72  
European Union, compliance statement....................285  
external compact flash See compact flash  
gateway, default.........................................................134  
ge-0/0/0  
connecting through J-Web...................................137  
defining address (configuration editor)...............150  
defining address (Quick Configuration)...............146  
296  
Index  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
for autoinstallation..............................................134  
management interface........................................134  
Gigabit Ethernet ePIMs  
returning.............................................................213  
troubleshooting components..............................209  
See also LEDs  
alarms...................................................................54  
description............................................................52  
high-speed slot locations.......................................53  
installation............................................................53  
LEDs.....................................................................54  
limitations.............................................................53  
link speeds and transmission modes ...................53  
SFP, optical interface support...............................54  
Gigabit Ethernet ports  
hardware features  
Avaya VoIP modules.............................................66  
components..........................................................30  
front panel......................................................19, 32  
PIMs.....................................................................43  
product overview....................................................3  
Hayes-compatible modem See modem connection to  
router console port  
heat dissipation, PIMs  
built-in............................................................23, 35  
copper..................................................................52  
LED states...........................................23, 35, 51, 54  
port 0..................................................................134  
RJ-45 connector pinouts (ePIM)...........................234  
RJ-45 connector pinouts (uPIMs).........................233  
SFP (optical)....................................................50, 53  
Gigabit Ethernet uPIMs  
alarms...................................................................52  
description............................................................49  
installation............................................................51  
LEDs.....................................................................51  
limitations.............................................................51  
link speeds and transmission modes ...................50  
SFP, optical interface support...............................52  
glossary  
managing............................................................112  
troubleshooting...................................................210  
help apropos command...............................................97  
Help icon (?)...........................................................86, 89  
help reference command.............................................97  
help topic command....................................................97  
Help, J-Web interface.............................................85, 89  
Help, JUNOS CLI...........................................................97  
high availability (HA) LED.......................................22, 34  
high-speed interfaces See ePIMs  
high-speed slots for ePIMs, location.............................33  
hostname...................................................................132  
defining (configuration editor)............................148  
defining (Quick Configuration)............................145  
overview.............................................................132  
See also DNS server  
basic connectivity...............................................131  
PIMs.....................................................................43  
secure Web access..............................................153  
graceful shutdown......................................................129  
graphical user interface See J-Web interface  
grounding  
Avaya VoIP 10 AWG replacement cable................66  
cable...................................................................123  
chassis................................................................123  
DC power requirements and warning.................257  
equipment warning.............................................260  
grounding lug  
how to use this guide...................................................xvi  
HTTP (Hypertext Transfer Protocol)  
enabling Web access (configuration editor).........158  
enabling Web access (Quick Configuration)........155  
on built-in management interfaces.....................154  
verifying configuration........................................159  
HTTPS (Hypertext Transfer Protocol over SSL)  
enabling secure access (configuration  
editor).............................................................158  
enabling secure access (Quick  
Configuration).................................................155  
Quick Configuration............................................155  
recommended for secure access.........................154  
verifying secure access configuration..................159  
humidity requirement................................................106  
Hyperterminal, for terminal emulation  
connecting..................................................125, 127  
group licenses............................................................163  
GUI See J-Web interface  
local CLI connection............................................139  
modem connection at router for remote CLI  
access.............................................................142  
modem connection for remote CLI access..........143  
Hypertext Transfer Protocol See HTTP  
H
HA (high availability) LED.......................................22, 34  
hardware  
alarm conditions and remedies...........................209  
Avaya VoIP module overview...............................66  
installation and connection.................................117  
maintenance.......................................................171  
PIM overview........................................................43  
product overview....................................................3  
replacing components.........................................171  
Hypertext Transfer Protocol over SSL See HTTPS  
I
idle time, setting for a CLI session................................98  
ifd process...................................................................40  
IG550 Integrated Gateway See Avaya VoIP modules  
Index  
297  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
immunity standards...................................................282  
initial configuration requirements..............................136  
injury, steps to take....................................................261  
installation  
feature summary....................................................7  
hardware..............................................................13  
hardware replacement........................................171  
hardware return..................................................213  
HTTPS Web access.............................................153  
installation and connection.................................117  
JUNOS software overview.....................................39  
licenses...............................................................161  
models available.....................................................3  
network cables and connectors...........................223  
PIMs.....................................................................43  
release notes, URL.................................................xv  
safety and compliance........................................247  
site preparation...................................................103  
SSL access...........................................................153  
user interfaces See user interfaces  
AC power supplies (J6350)..................................193  
air filter...............................................................206  
compact flash.............................................178, 181  
console port cable (chassis).................................172  
Crypto Accelerator Module..........................200, 204  
DC power supplies (J6350)..................................196  
DRAM modules...................................................190  
initial..................................................................117  
licenses (CLI).......................................................165  
licenses (J-Web)...................................................164  
PIM cables..........................................................175  
PIMs...................................................................174  
preparation.........................................................103  
requirements......................................................117  
restricted access, J2350......................................119  
restricted access, J4350 and  
J-Web configuration editor  
basic settings......................................................147  
configuration hierarchy display.............................87  
initial configuration.............................................147  
secure access......................................................158  
J-Web interface  
J6350............................................25, 37, 38, 120  
safety guidelines and warnings...........................266  
site checklist.......................................................115  
site guidelines.....................................................103  
USB storage device.............................................187  
Integrated Services Digital Network See ISDN  
interface software process...........................................40  
interfaces  
J2320 overview.......................................................4  
J2320 types supported..........................................46  
J2350 overview.......................................................5  
J2350 types supported..........................................46  
J4350 overview.......................................................6  
J4350 types supported..........................................47  
J6350 overview.......................................................7  
J6350 types supported..........................................47  
Internet Explorer, modifying for worldwide version of  
JUNOS software........................................................83  
ISDN BRI ports  
configuration editor See J-Web configuration editor  
connecting..........................................................137  
context-sensitive help.....................................85, 96  
Help (?) icon..........................................................86  
Internet Explorer, modifying for worldwide version  
of JUNOS software.............................................83  
layout....................................................................84  
main pane............................................................85  
managing licenses..............................................163  
overview...............................................................81  
page layout...........................................................83  
Quick Configuration See Quick Configuration  
regaining lost DHCP lease after initial  
configuration...................................................145  
sessions................................................................90  
side pane..............................................................86  
starting.................................................................83  
top pane...............................................................85  
windows, multiple, unpredictable results  
BRI S/T..................................................................62  
BRI U....................................................................62  
for TIM521 See TIM521  
with...................................................................90  
J-Web Quick Configuration See Quick Configuration  
J2320  
LED states.............................................................63  
provisioning........................................................115  
RJ-45 connector pinouts......................................239  
ISDN PRI PIM...............................................................57  
ISDN provisioning......................................................115  
See also ISDN BRI ports  
Avaya VoIP modules.............................................66  
boot devices..........................................................19  
boot sequence......................................................19  
chassis..................................................................13  
chassis cover, replacing......................................176  
compact flash location........................................179  
compact flash, replacing.....................................179  
cooling system......................................................25  
electrical specifications.......................................109  
external compact flash..........................................24  
fans.......................................................................25  
front panel............................................................19  
J
J-Flow license.............................................................162  
J-series  
Avaya VoIP modules.............................................66  
establishing secure Web access..........................153  
establishing software connectivity......................131  
298  
Index  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
hardware........................................................13, 26  
installation..........................................................119  
interfaces supported.............................................46  
mounting brackets..............................................119  
overview.................................................................3  
physical specifications..........................................17  
PIMs supported.....................................................46  
ports supported....................................................46  
power management............................................112  
Routing Engine, hardware.....................................18  
TGM550................................................................69  
TIM508.................................................................73  
TIM510.................................................................74  
TIM514.................................................................75  
TIM516.................................................................76  
TIM518.................................................................78  
TIM521.................................................................79  
USB port...............................................................24  
ADSL PIM..............................................................64  
air filter, replacing...............................................206  
Avaya VoIP modules.............................................66  
boot devices..........................................................31  
boot sequence......................................................31  
chassis..................................................................27  
cooling system......................................................38  
Dual-Port Channelized T1/E1/ISDN PRI PIM..........57  
Dual-Port E1 PIM..................................................56  
Dual-Port Fast Ethernet PIM..................................60  
Dual-Port Serial PIM..............................................55  
Dual-Port T1 PIM..................................................56  
electrical specifications.......................................109  
fans.......................................................................38  
front panel............................................................32  
FRUs, replacing...................................................171  
G.SHDSL PIM........................................................65  
Gigabit Ethernet ePIM...........................................52  
Gigabit Ethernet uPIMs.........................................49  
hardware..............................................................26  
hardware components..........................................30  
hardware, replacing............................................171  
installation..........................................................120  
interfaces supported.............................................47  
mounting brackets, installing..............................121  
overview.................................................................5  
physical specifications..........................................30  
PIM overview........................................................46  
PIMs supported.....................................................47  
ports supported....................................................47  
power management............................................112  
power system.......................................................36  
restricted access installation.............25, 37, 38, 120  
Routing Engine, hardware.....................................31  
TGM550................................................................69  
TIM508.................................................................73  
TIM510.................................................................74  
TIM514.................................................................75  
TIM516.................................................................76  
TIM518.................................................................78  
TIM521.................................................................79  
USB port...............................................................36  
J2350  
air filter, replacing...............................................205  
Avaya VoIP modules.............................................66  
boot devices..........................................................19  
boot sequence......................................................19  
chassis..................................................................13  
chassis cover, replacing......................................176  
compact flash location........................................179  
compact flash, replacing.....................................179  
cooling system......................................................25  
electrical specifications.......................................109  
external compact flash..........................................24  
fans.......................................................................25  
front panel............................................................19  
hardware........................................................13, 26  
installation..........................................................119  
interfaces supported.............................................46  
mounting brackets..............................................119  
overview.................................................................4  
physical specifications..........................................17  
PIMs supported.....................................................46  
ports supported....................................................46  
power management............................................112  
power system.......................................................24  
restricted access installation...............................119  
Routing Engine, hardware.....................................18  
TGM550................................................................69  
TIM508.................................................................73  
TIM510.................................................................74  
TIM514.................................................................75  
TIM516.................................................................76  
TIM518.................................................................78  
TIM521.................................................................79  
USB port...............................................................24  
J6350  
4-Port Fast Ethernet ePIM.....................................61  
4-Port ISDN BRI S/T PIM.......................................62  
4-Port ISDN BRI U PIM..........................................62  
ADSL PIM..............................................................64  
air filter, replacing...............................................206  
Avaya VoIP modules.............................................66  
boot devices....................................................19, 31  
boot sequence......................................................31  
chassis..................................................................27  
cooling system......................................................38  
Dual-Port Channelized T1/E1/ISDN PRI PIM..........57  
Dual-Port E1 PIM..................................................56  
Dual-Port Fast Ethernet PIM..................................60  
J4350  
4-Port Fast Ethernet ePIM.....................................61  
4-Port ISDN BRI S/T PIM.......................................62  
4-Port ISDN BRI U PIM..........................................62  
Index  
299  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
Dual-Port Serial PIM..............................................55  
Dual-Port T1 PIM..................................................56  
E3 PIM..................................................................59  
electrical specifications.......................................109  
fans.......................................................................38  
front panel............................................................32  
FRUs, replacing...................................................171  
G.SHDSL PIM........................................................65  
Gigabit Ethernet ePIM...........................................52  
Gigabit Ethernet uPIMs.........................................49  
hardware..............................................................26  
hardware components..........................................30  
hardware, replacing............................................171  
installation..........................................................120  
interfaces supported.............................................47  
mounting brackets, installing..............................121  
overview.................................................................6  
physical specifications..........................................30  
PIM overview........................................................46  
PIMs supported.....................................................47  
ports supported....................................................47  
power management............................................112  
power supplies See power supplies, J6350  
screen width.........................................................99  
ssh........................................................................92  
starting.................................................................92  
telnet....................................................................92  
terminal type........................................................99  
working directory.................................................98  
JUNOS Internet software  
release notes, URL.................................................xv  
JUNOS software  
establishing connectivity.....................................131  
establishing secure Web access..........................153  
Internet Explorer, modifying for worldwide  
version..............................................................83  
licenses...............................................................162  
overview...............................................................39  
Packet Forwarding Engine....................................40  
processes..............................................................40  
Routing Engine.....................................................40  
worldwide version, modifying Internet Explorer  
for.....................................................................83  
JUNOScope application................................................42  
JUNOScript API  
defining access (Quick Configuration).................146  
enabling secure access........................................155  
management access...........................................135  
verifying secure access configuration..................159  
JUNOScript over SSL..................................................155  
restricted access installation.............25, 37, 38, 120  
Routing Engine, hardware.....................................31  
T3 PIM..................................................................59  
TGM550................................................................69  
TIM508.................................................................73  
TIM510.................................................................74  
TIM514.................................................................75  
TIM516.................................................................76  
TIM518.................................................................78  
TIM521.................................................................79  
USB port...............................................................36  
Japan, compliance statement.....................................286  
JTAC (Juniper Networks Technical Assistance Center)  
contacting...........................................................212  
contacting for hardware return...........................216  
information required for hardware return...........216  
Juniper Networks Technical Assistance Center See JTAC  
JUNOS CLI  
K
kernel...........................................................................40  
key sequences, editing, in CLI......................................94  
L
labels, serial number..........................................213, 214  
laptop See management device  
lasers  
beam warning.....................................................273  
Class 1 product warning.....................................272  
open aperture warning.......................................274  
safety guidelines.................................................272  
layout, J-Web...............................................................84  
leaf statements.............................................................94  
LEDs  
CLI terminal..........................................................92  
command completion...........................................95  
command hierarchy..............................................91  
command modes..................................................82  
command prompts See command prompts  
connecting locally...............................................139  
connecting remotely...........................................141  
console.................................................................92  
context-sensitive help...........................................96  
editing keystrokes.................................................94  
environment, changing.........................................97  
idle time...............................................................98  
managing licenses..............................................165  
overview...............................................................82  
screen length........................................................98  
ACT (TGM550 active)............................................72  
ACT (TIM508 active).............................................74  
ACT (TIM510 active).............................................75  
ACT (TIM514 active).............................................76  
ACT (TIM516 active).............................................77  
ACT (TIM518 active).............................................79  
ACT (TIM521 active).............................................80  
ACTIVITY status (dual-port PIM)............................61  
ADSL PIM status...................................................65  
ADSL port status...................................................65  
ALARM............................................................21, 34  
300  
Index  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
ALM (TGM550 alarm)............................................72  
ALM (TIM508 alarm).............................................74  
ALM (TIM510 alarm).............................................75  
ALM (TIM514 alarm).............................................76  
ALM (TIM516 alarm).............................................77  
ALM (TIM518 alarm).............................................79  
ALM (TIM521 alarm).............................................80  
ASB (alternate software bank)...............................72  
channelized E1 ports............................................58  
channelized T1 ports.............................................58  
Class 1 product warning.....................................273  
E1 port status........................................................57  
E3 port status........................................................60  
ETR (emergency transfer relay).............................72  
Fast Ethernet port status (4-port ePIM)..................62  
Fast Ethernet port status (dual-port PIM)...............61  
G.SHDSL PIM status..............................................66  
Gigabit Ethernet port status......................23, 35, 54  
HA..................................................................22, 34  
ISDN PIM status....................................................63  
ISDN port status....................................................63  
J4350 power supply..............................................36  
J6350 power supply..............................................37  
LAN port status...............................................23, 35  
LINK.........................................................23, 35, 54  
link activity (4-Port Fast Ethernet ePIM)................62  
link status (4-port ePIM)........................................62  
LINK/ SPEED status (Dual-Port Fast Ethernet  
displaying (J-Web)...............................................164  
status..................................................................163  
version................................................................163  
licenses  
adding (CLI)........................................................165  
adding (J-Web)....................................................164  
BGP route reflectors............................................162  
deleting (CLI).......................................................165  
deleting (J-Web)..................................................164  
displaying (CLI)...................................................166  
displaying (J-Web)...............................................163  
displaying usage.................................................167  
downloading (J-Web)...........................................164  
features requiring a license.....................................7  
group..................................................................163  
infringement, preventing....................................163  
See also license infringement  
installed..............................................................163  
J-Flow traffic analysis..........................................162  
JUNOS software..................................................162  
key......................................................................162  
See also license keys  
managing (CLI)...................................................165  
managing (J-Web)...............................................163  
overview.............................................................161  
preparation for....................................................162  
saving (CLI).........................................................166  
traffic analysis.....................................................162  
verifying.............................................................166  
lifting guidelines.........................................................266  
lightning activity warning...........................................278  
LINE and TRUNK ports, on Avaya VoIP TGM550..........69  
LINE ports, TIM514......................................................75  
link activity LED (4-Port Fast Ethernet ePIM)................62  
LINK LED.........................................................23, 35, 54  
link status LED (4-Port Fast Ethernet ePIM)..................62  
LINK/ SPEED LED (Dual-Port Fast Ethernet PIM)..........61  
lithium battery compliance........................................283  
lo0.0..........................................................................134  
local connection to the router console port................139  
loopback address  
PIM)..................................................................61  
ONLINE status (ADSL PIM)....................................65  
ONLINE status (G.SHDSL PIM)..............................66  
ONLINE status (ISDN BRI PIMs)............................63  
POWER...........................................................20, 33  
safety warnings...................................................271  
serial port status...................................................55  
SHDSL port status.................................................66  
SIG (signal)............................................................75  
STATUS (router)..............................................21, 34  
T1 port status........................................................57  
T3 port status........................................................60  
TGM550 port status..............................................72  
TIM508 link status................................................74  
TIM510 link status................................................75  
TIM514 link status................................................76  
TIM516 link status................................................77  
TIM518 link status................................................79  
TIM521 link status................................................80  
TST (test)..............................................................75  
TX/RX.......................................................23, 35, 54  
license infringement  
defining (configuration editor)............................149  
defining (Quick Configuration)............................146  
overview.............................................................134  
LX transceiver  
Gigabit Ethernet ePIM...........................................54  
Gigabit Ethernet uPIM...........................................52  
M
identifying any licenses needed..........................163  
verifying license usage........................................167  
verifying licenses installed..................................166  
license keys  
main pane, J-Web........................................................85  
maintenance  
AC power cord, replacing....................................191  
air filter...............................................................206  
console port cable (chassis).................................172  
Crypto Accelerator Module..........................198, 201  
components........................................................162  
displaying (CLI)...................................................167  
Index  
301  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
DC power cable, replacing..................................194  
N
DRAM modules...................................................188  
external compact flash........................................184  
internal compact flash................................178, 181  
PIM cables..........................................................175  
PIMs...................................................................172  
power system.....................................................191  
tools and parts required......................................171  
USB storage device.............................................186  
warnings.............................................................275  
major (red) alarms  
NEBS (Network Equipment Building System)  
identifying NEBS-compliant routers......................38  
shutdown temperature for NEBS-compliant  
routers........................................................25, 38  
network cable pinouts................................................223  
Network Equipment Building System See NEBS  
Network Time Protocol (NTP) server See NTP server  
notice icons................................................................xvii  
NT1 device, provisioning information........................115  
NTP server  
PIMs...................................................................210  
Routing Engine...................................................210  
management access...................................................135  
management device  
defining (configuration editor)............................149  
defining (Quick Configuration)............................145  
overview.............................................................133  
requirement for Common Criteria  
connecting through the CLI.................................141  
connecting to J-Web....................................137, 139  
management interface address  
environments..................................................133  
after initial configuration.....................................134  
before initial configuration..................................134  
defining (configuration editor)............................150  
defining (Quick Configuration)............................146  
during initial configuration..................................134  
loopback.............................................................134  
management interfaces.............................................134  
management ports.................................................23, 35  
See also management interface address;  
O
OK button  
J-Web configuration editor....................................88  
Quick Configuration..............................................88  
ONLINE LEDs  
ADSL PIM status...................................................65  
channelized E1 ports............................................58  
channelized T1 ports.............................................58  
G.SHDSL PIM status..............................................66  
ISDN BRI PIM status..............................................63  
openssl command......................................................155  
operating system See JUNOS software  
operational mode  
management interfaces  
management software process....................................40  
manuals  
comments on.......................................................xxi  
memory See compact flash; DRAM modules; USB  
mgd process................................................................40  
microkernel.................................................................40  
midplane................................................................18, 31  
minor (yellow) alarms  
alternative boot device........................................209  
internal compact flash........................................209  
Routing Engine...................................................210  
modem commands  
commands............................................................92  
prompt (>)...........................................................92  
overview  
J2320......................................................................3  
J2350......................................................................4  
J4350......................................................................5  
J6350......................................................................6  
at remote end.....................................................143  
at router end.......................................................142  
modem connection to router console port  
configuring modem at router end.......................141  
configuring modem at user end..........................143  
connecting modem to router..............................142  
overview.............................................................141  
monoammonium phosphate......................................107  
mounting brackets  
P
Packet Forwarding Engine...........................................40  
microkernel..........................................................40  
packing materials  
packing a Services Router for shipment..............218  
packing components for shipment......................218  
saving.................................................................118  
pages, layout in J-Web..................................................83  
parentheses, in syntax descriptions...........................xviii  
password See root password  
PC See management device  
personnel warning.....................................................250  
PIC See PIMs  
installing on J4350 and J6350.............................123  
on J2320 and J2350............................................119  
multiple routers  
safe rack order............................................119, 121  
PIM number, always 0...............................................176  
302  
Index  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
PIMs (Physical Interface Modules)  
RJ-48 connector to RJ-48 connector  
4-Port Fast Ethernet..............................................61  
4-Port ISDN BRI....................................................62  
ADSL.....................................................................64  
Avaya VoIP modules See Avaya VoIP modules  
cables and connectors........................................223  
Dual-Port Channelized T1/E1/ISDN PRI PIM..........57  
Dual-Port E1.........................................................56  
Dual-Port Fast Ethernet.........................................60  
Dual-Port Serial.....................................................55  
Dual-Port T1.........................................................56  
E3 ........................................................................59  
failure.................................................................210  
field-replaceable PIMs...........................................46  
G.SHDSL ..............................................................65  
Gigabit Ethernet ePIMs..........................................52  
Gigabit Ethernet uPIMs.........................................49  
heat dissipation...................................................112  
installing.............................................................174  
installing cables..................................................175  
LEDs See LEDs  
(straight)..........................................................236  
RS-232 DCE serial cable......................................225  
RS-232 DTE serial cable......................................224  
RS-422/449 (EIA-449) DCE serial cable...............227  
RS-422/449 (EIA-449) DTE serial cable...............225  
SHDSL RJ-11 connector.......................................238  
TGM550 analog RJ-11 connector.........................240  
TGM550 console DB-9 connector........................239  
TGM550 console port..........................................239  
TIM508...............................................................241  
TIM510 E1/T1 RJ-45............................................241  
TIM514 analog RJ-11 connector..........................242  
TIM516...............................................................242  
TIM518...............................................................244  
TIM521 ISDN BRI ports.......................................245  
V.35 DCE serial cable..........................................231  
V.35 DTE serial cable..........................................230  
X.21 DCE serial cable..........................................232  
X.21 DTE serial cable..........................................231  
plug types, AC............................................................110  
ports  
major (red) alarm................................................210  
midplane to Routing Engine............................18, 31  
non-hot-swappability............................43, 173, 174  
offline, troubleshooting.......................................210  
overview...............................................................43  
See also Avaya VoIP modules  
0.........................................................................134  
ADSL See ADSL ports  
AUX................................................................23, 36  
cables, PIM, installing.........................................175  
cables, WAN, removing......................................175  
channelized See channelized E1 ports; channelized  
T1 ports  
console (chassis).............................................23, 36  
See also console port  
console (TGM550).................................................69  
DS1 See E1 ports; T1 ports  
DS3 See E3 ports; T3 ports  
E1 See E1 ports  
E3 See E3 ports  
G.SHDSL See SHDSL ports  
PIM number, always 0................................176, 213  
power consumption............................................112  
power management, planning............................112  
power management, troubleshooting.................210  
removing............................................................172  
replacing cables..................................................175  
serial number label.............................................216  
slot numbering, J2320 and J2350..........................20  
slot numbering, J4350 and J6350..........................32  
T3 ........................................................................59  
pinouts  
interface naming.................................................176  
ISDN See ISDN BRI ports  
ADSL RJ-11 connector.........................................238  
Avaya VoIP modules...........................................239  
chassis console DB-9 connector..........................235  
chassis console port............................................234  
EIA-530A DCE serial cable..................................229  
EIA-530A DTE serial cable..................................228  
Fast Ethernet connector......................................233  
Gigabit Ethernet connector (ePIM)......................234  
Gigabit Ethernet connector (uPIMs).....................233  
ISDN RJ-45 connector.........................................239  
RJ-45 chassis console connector.........................234  
RJ-45 TGM550 console connector.......................239  
RJ-48 connector to DB-15 connector  
J2320 types supported..........................................46  
J2350 types supported..........................................46  
J4350 types supported..........................................47  
J6350 types supported..........................................47  
LINE and TRUNK, on Avaya VoIP TGM550...........69  
lo0.0...................................................................134  
serial See serial ports  
SHDSL See SHDSL ports  
T1 See T1 ports  
T3 See T3 ports  
telephone and trunk, on Avaya VoIP TGM550.......69  
TGM550................................................................69  
TIM510.................................................................74  
TIM514.................................................................75  
TIM521.................................................................79  
USB.................................................................24, 36  
(crossover).......................................................237  
RJ-48 connector to DB-15 connector  
(straight)..........................................................237  
RJ-48 connector to RJ-48 connector  
(crossover).......................................................236  
Index  
303  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
power  
product disposal.........................................................281  
product overview...........................................................3  
prompt See command prompts; restart-after-upgrade  
prompt  
AC power See AC power  
applying..............................................................129  
button.............................................................20, 33  
connecting..........................................................124  
consumption, PIMs.............................................112  
DC power See DC power  
provisioning an ISDN line...........................................115  
grounding requirement.......................................123  
LED.................................................................20, 33  
managing............................................................112  
power cables See DC power cables  
power cords See AC power cords  
power supplies See power supplies  
Q
Quick Configuration  
basic settings......................................................143  
buttons.................................................................88  
initial configuration.............................................143  
Secure Access page.............................................156  
secure Web access..............................................155  
Set Up page........................................................145  
power system See power system  
removing............................................................129  
requirements......................................................109  
troubleshooting...................................................210  
power button.........................................................20, 33  
power cables See DC power cables  
R
rack installation  
power cords See AC power cords  
POWER LED..........................................................20, 33  
power management  
planning.............................................................112  
troubleshooting...................................................210  
power supplies  
general requirements..........................................104  
lifting guidelines..................................................266  
mounting brackets..............................................123  
order of multiple routers.............................119, 121  
procedure...................................................119, 120  
safety guidelines and warnings...........................267  
securing rack to building.....................................105  
size requirements.......................................104, 105  
support for front-mount rack......................104, 105  
ventilation requirement..............................104, 105  
radio frequency interference (RFI), reducing..............108  
ramp angle requirement............................................271  
read or write error, Routing Engine............................210  
red alarms See major alarms  
J2320....................................................................24  
J2350....................................................................24  
J4350....................................................................36  
J6350 See power supplies, J6350  
LED states.............................................................36  
power supplies, J6350  
blank panel required in empty slot.....................191  
dedicated AC power feed requirement................194  
dedicated DC power feed requirement...............197  
description............................................................37  
installing AC........................................................193  
installing DC.......................................................196  
LED states.............................................................37  
redundancy...........................................................37  
removing AC.......................................................192  
removing DC.......................................................195  
serial number label.............................................216  
power system  
connecting..................................................125, 126  
fan..................................................................25, 38  
J2320....................................................................24  
J4350....................................................................36  
J6350....................................................................37  
power supply LED.................................................36  
preparing for installation............................................103  
processes, software  
red asterisk (*).............................................................86  
redundant J6350 power supplies  
description............................................................37  
safety guidelines for power sources....................255  
regulatory compliance................................................247  
release notes, URL........................................................xv  
remote connection to router console port  
configuring modem at router end.......................141  
configuring modem at user end..........................143  
connecting modem to router..............................142  
overview.............................................................141  
replacement  
AC power cord....................................................191  
air filter...............................................................206  
console port cable (chassis).................................172  
Crypto Accelerator Module..........................198, 201  
DC power cable..................................................194  
DRAM modules...................................................188  
external compact flash........................................184  
internal compact flash................................178, 181  
PIM cables..........................................................175  
PIMs...................................................................172  
power system (J6350).........................................191  
chassis process.....................................................40  
forwarding process...............................................40  
interface process...................................................40  
management process............................................40  
routing protocol process.......................................40  
304  
Index  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
tools and parts required......................................171  
USB storage device.............................................186  
request chassis pic fpc-slot command........................175  
request system license add command.......................165  
request system license add terminal command.........165  
request system license delete command....................165  
request system license save command......................166  
required entry .............................................................86  
rescue configuration, resetting with RESCUE CONFIG  
button................................................................22, 35  
reset  
Common Criteria limitations...............................133  
defining (configuration editor)............................148  
defining (Quick Configuration)............................145  
required to commit a configuration....................133  
route reflectors, BGP, license......................................162  
router See Services Router  
Routing Engine  
fan..................................................................25, 38  
fan failure...........................................................210  
J2320 functions and components.........................18  
J2350 functions and components.........................18  
J4350 functions and components.........................31  
J6350 functions and components.........................31  
kernel...................................................................40  
major (red) alarm................................................210  
midplane to PIMs............................................18, 31  
minor (yellow) alarm..........................................210  
read or write error..............................................210  
software component.............................................40  
too warm............................................................210  
routing protocol software process................................40  
rpd process..................................................................40  
RS-232 DCE cable pinouts..........................................225  
RS-232 DTE cable pinouts..........................................224  
RS-422/449 (EIA-449) DCE cable pinouts...................227  
RS-422/449 (EIA-449) DTE cable pinouts...................225  
power button for restart..................................20, 33  
RESET CONFIG button for factory  
configuration...............................................22, 35  
RESET CONFIG button  
for factory configuration.................................22, 35  
for rescue configuration..................................22, 35  
restart-after-upgrade prompt........................................98  
Return Materials Authorization See RMA  
returning hardware....................................................213  
packing a Services Router for shipment..............218  
packing components for shipment......................218  
procedure...........................................................216  
tools and parts required......................................217  
RJ-11 connector pinouts  
TGM550 analog ports..........................................240  
TIM514 analog ports...........................................242  
RJ-45 connector pinouts  
chassis console port............................................234  
Fast Ethernet port...............................................233  
Gigabit Ethernet port (ePIM)................................234  
Gigabit Ethernet port (uPIMs)..............................233  
TGM550 console port..........................................239  
TIM510 E1/T1 ports............................................241  
TIM521 ISDN BRI ports.......................................245  
RJ-45 to DB-9 serial port adapter  
chassis console port....................................139, 142  
TGM550 console port............................................70  
RJ-48 connector to DB-15 connector (crossover)  
pinouts...................................................................237  
RJ-48 connector to DB-15 connector (straight)  
pinouts...................................................................237  
RJ-48 connector to RJ-48 connector (crossover)  
pinouts...................................................................236  
RJ-48 connector to RJ-48 connector (straight)  
pinouts...................................................................236  
RMA (Return Materials Authorization)........................213  
number...............................................................217  
packing a Services Router for shipment..............218  
packing components for shipment......................218  
procedure...........................................................216  
tools and parts required......................................217  
root password  
S
S/T port See ISDN BRI ports  
safety guidelines and warnings  
AC power............................................................253  
battery handling.................................................276  
DC power (general).............................................254  
DC power disconnection.....................................255  
DC power wiring sequence warning...................257  
DC power wiring terminations warning..............259  
DC power, grounding requirements and  
warning...........................................................257  
DC power, redundant power supplies.................255  
electrical.............................................................252  
general................................................................249  
grounded equipment..........................................260  
in case of electrical accident...............................261  
installation..........................................................266  
jewelry removal..................................................277  
lasers and LEDs..................................................271  
levels..................................................................247  
lightning activity.................................................278  
maintenance and operation................................275  
multiple power supplies .....................................262  
operating temperature........................................279  
power disconnection...........................................263  
product disposal.................................................281  
rack-mounting....................................................267  
ramps.................................................................271  
at initial local connection (none).........................140  
at initial remote connection (none).....................143  
characteristics.....................................................133  
Index  
305  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
read installation instructions...............................266  
telecommunications cord....................................265  
TN power system................................................264  
safety standards.........................................................282  
fire safety............................................................106  
sample configuration  
for basic connectivity..........................................150  
for secure access.................................................160  
for SSL certificates..............................................159  
saving licenses (CLI)...................................................166  
screen length, CLI, setting ...........................................98  
screen width, CLI, setting ............................................99  
secure access  
establishing software connectivity......................131  
grounding a DC-powered model.........................127  
grounding an AC-powered model........................124  
hardware..............................................................13  
hardware replacement........................................171  
hardware return..................................................213  
HTTPS Web access.............................................153  
installation and connection.................................117  
licenses...............................................................161  
network cables and connectors...........................223  
operating environment.......................................106  
overview.............................................................3, 7  
packing for shipment..........................................218  
PIM overview........................................................43  
powering on and off...........................................129  
preparation checklist...........................................115  
safety and compliance........................................247  
site preparation...................................................103  
software................................................................39  
SSL access...........................................................153  
unpacking...........................................................118  
user interfaces See user interfaces  
generating SSL certificates..................................155  
HTTPS access (configuration editor)....................158  
HTTPS access (Quick Configuration)...................155  
HTTPS recommended.........................................154  
installing SSL certificates (configuration  
editor).............................................................158  
installing SSL certificates (Quick  
Configuration).................................................155  
JUNOScript SSL access........................................155  
overview.............................................................154  
requirements......................................................154  
sample configuration..........................................160  
verifying secure access configuration..................159  
Secure Access page  
description..........................................................156  
field summary....................................................157  
Secure Sockets Layer See SSL  
sessions, J-Web............................................................90  
set cli commands.........................................................97  
Set Up page  
description..........................................................143  
field summary....................................................145  
setup  
configuration editor............................................147  
Quick Configuration............................................143  
requirements......................................................136  
SFP Gigabit Ethernet ePIMs  
optical interface support.......................................54  
overview...............................................................52  
SFPs supported.....................................................53  
SFP Gigabit Ethernet uPIMs  
optical interface support.......................................52  
overview...............................................................49  
SHDSL ports  
description............................................................65  
LED states on a G.SHDSL PIM...............................66  
RJ-11 connector pinouts......................................238  
shipping carton  
packing a Services Router for shipment..............218  
packing components for shipment......................218  
saving.................................................................118  
show chassis alarms command..................................209  
show chassis fpc pic-status command........................176  
show chassis hardware command  
serial number  
chassis components, label..........................213, 214  
PIMs...................................................................216  
power supply......................................................216  
serial ports  
cables and connectors........................................223  
Dual-Port Serial PIM..............................................55  
EIA-530A DCE pinouts........................................229  
EIA-530A DTE pinouts........................................228  
LED states.............................................................55  
RS-232 DCE pinouts............................................225  
RS-232 DTE pinouts............................................224  
RS-422/449 (EIA-449) DCE pinouts.....................227  
RS-422/449 (EIA-449) DTE pinouts.....................225  
V.35 DCE pinouts................................................231  
V.35 DTE pinouts................................................230  
X.21 DCE pinouts...............................................232  
X.21 DTE pinouts................................................231  
service provider, contacting for ISDN  
provisioning...........................................................115  
Services Router  
identifying NEBS-compliant routers......................38  
locating component serial numbers....................213  
verifying Crypto Accelerator Module  
Avaya VoIP module overview...............................66  
backup................................................................134  
clearance............................................................103  
connecting..........................................................137  
establishing secure Web access..........................153  
installation..............................................201, 204  
show chassis power-ratings command.......................211  
306  
Index  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
show chassis routing-engine command  
J4350 hardware....................................................30  
J6350 hardware....................................................30  
serial PIM cables and connectors........................223  
SFP Gigabit Ethernet ePIM....................................54  
SFP Gigabit Ethernet uPIMs...................................52  
SRC application............................................................42  
SSH  
defining (configuration editor)............................148  
defining access (Quick Configuration).................146  
management access...........................................136  
SSL (Secure Sockets Layer)  
checking CPU temperature.............................25, 38  
checking DRAM amount.................................18, 31  
verifying DRAM installation and  
configuration...................................................191  
show cli command.......................................................97  
show system license command..................................166  
explanation.........................................................166  
show system license keys command.........................167  
show system license usage command........................167  
explanation.........................................................167  
shutdown  
enabling secure access (Quick  
graceful...............................................................129  
immediate..........................................................129  
temperature See shutdown temperature  
Configuration).................................................155  
management access...........................................154  
verifying SSL configuration.................................159  
SSL 3.0 option, disabling on Internet Explorer for  
worldwide version of JUNOS software......................83  
SSL certificates  
adding (configuration editor)...............................159  
adding (Quick Configuration)..............................157  
generating...........................................................155  
sample configuration..........................................159  
verifying SSL configuration.................................159  
standards compliance................................................282  
startup  
J-Web interface.....................................................83  
JUNOS CLI.............................................................92  
Services Router...................................................129  
standby power....................................................129  
statements, configuration types...................................94  
status  
shutdown temperature  
NEBS-compliant routers..................................25, 38  
non-NEBS-compliant routers.................................38  
side pane, J-Web..........................................................86  
SIG LED........................................................................75  
signaling limitations...................................................108  
site preparation  
checklist..............................................................115  
electrical wiring guidelines..................................108  
fire safety............................................................106  
for rack installation.............................................104  
guidelines...........................................................103  
operating environment.......................................106  
power requirements...........................................109  
size  
J2320....................................................................17  
J2350....................................................................17  
J4350....................................................................30  
J6350....................................................................30  
requirements for rack installation...............104, 105  
slot numbers, PIM  
license key..........................................................163  
router..............................................................21, 34  
See also STATUS LEDs  
STATUS LEDs  
ADSL ports............................................................65  
channelized E1 ports............................................58  
channelized T1 ports.............................................58  
E1 ports................................................................57  
E3 ports................................................................60  
ISDN ports............................................................63  
router status....................................................21, 33  
serial ports............................................................55  
SHDSL ports..........................................................66  
T1 ports................................................................57  
T3 ports................................................................60  
storage media  
chassis diagram..............................................20, 32  
displayed as FPC number in command  
output.............................................................176  
small form-factor pluggable transceivers See SFP  
SNMP (Simple Network Management Protocol), no  
Gigabit Ethernet support.....................................51, 53  
software.......................................................................39  
features.................................................................39  
licenses See licenses  
See also JUNOS software  
specifications  
AC electrical connection......................................109  
AC power cords..................................................110  
DC electrical connection.....................................111  
DC power cables.................................................111  
electrical.............................................................109  
environmental....................................................106  
grounding cable..................................................123  
J2320 hardware....................................................17  
J2350 hardware....................................................17  
replacing the external compact flash..................184  
replacing the internal compact flash...........178, 181  
replacing the USB storage device........................186  
support, technical See technical support  
SX transceiver  
Gigabit Ethernet ePIM...........................................54  
Gigabit Ethernet uPIM...........................................52  
symmetric high-speed digital subscriber line See SHDSL  
syntax conventions....................................................xvii  
Index  
307  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
system overview  
port LED states.....................................................72  
ports.....................................................................69  
thermal output...........................................................106  
TIM508  
hardware..............................................................13  
software................................................................39  
system time  
defining (Quick Configuration)............................146  
overview.............................................................133  
synchronizing (configuration editor)...................149  
synchronizing (Quick Configuration)...................145  
connector port pinouts........................................241  
description............................................................73  
port configurations................................................73  
ports, LED states...................................................74  
TIM510  
description............................................................74  
E1 trunk ports.......................................................74  
ports, LED states...................................................75  
RJ-45 connector port pinouts..............................241  
T1 trunk ports.......................................................74  
TIM514  
analog port pinouts.............................................242  
analog telephone ports..........................................75  
analog trunk ports.................................................75  
description............................................................75  
port configurations................................................76  
ports, LED states...................................................76  
TIM516  
T
T1 ports  
description............................................................56  
See also channelized T1 ports  
LED states.............................................................57  
RJ-48 cable pinouts.............................................235  
T1 trunk ports, TIM510  
description............................................................74  
pinouts................................................................241  
T1/E1 media module See TIM508 See TIM510 See  
TIM516 See TIM518  
T3 ports  
BNC connector pinouts.......................................238  
description............................................................59  
LED states.............................................................60  
taskbar.........................................................................85  
technical support  
connector port pinouts........................................242  
description............................................................76  
port configurations................................................77  
ports, LED states...................................................77  
TIM518  
contacting JTAC....................................................xxi  
contacting JTAC for hardware return...................216  
information required for hardware return...........216  
telecommunications line wire gauge..........................265  
telephone and trunk ports, on Avaya VoIP  
TGM550...................................................................69  
Telephony Gateway Module See TGM550  
Telephony Interface Modules See TIM508; TIM510;  
TIM514; TIM516; TIM518; TIM521  
connector port pinouts........................................244  
description............................................................78  
port configurations................................................78  
ports, LED states...................................................79  
TIM521  
description............................................................79  
ISDN BRI connector port pinouts........................245  
ISDN BRI ports......................................................79  
ports, LED states...................................................80  
RJ-45 connector port pinouts..............................245  
time See system time  
time zone...................................................................133  
defining (configuration editor)............................148  
defining (Quick Configuration)............................145  
TIMs See TIM508; TIM510; TIM514; TIM516; TIM518;  
TIM521  
TN power system.......................................................264  
tolerances, environmental..........................................106  
tools and equipment  
Telnet  
defining access (Quick Configuration).................146  
management access...........................................135  
temperature  
required for operation.........................................106  
Routing Engine, too warm..................................210  
shutdown, NEBS-compliant routers.................25, 38  
shutdown, non-NEBS-compliant routers................38  
warning..............................................................279  
temperature alarm, air filter replacement for.............206  
terminal type, setting ..................................................99  
terminology  
basic connectivity...............................................131  
PIMs.....................................................................43  
secure Web access..............................................153  
TGM550  
for component replacement...............................171  
for hardware return............................................217  
top pane, J-Web...........................................................85  
traffic analysis license................................................162  
troubleshooting a Services Router, hardware  
components  
analog port pinouts.............................................240  
console port pinouts...........................................239  
description............................................................69  
maximum gateway capacities...............................71  
chassis alarm conditions.....................................209  
offline PIMs.........................................................210  
power management............................................210  
TRUNK and LINE ports, on Avaya VoIP TGM550..........69  
308  
Index  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
trunk ports, TIM508  
W
warnings  
pinouts................................................................241  
TRUNK ports, TIM514..................................................75  
trunk ports, TIM516  
battery handling.................................................276  
DC power cables.................................................254  
DC power disconnection.....................................255  
DC power plant and chassis ground....................111  
DC wiring sequence............................................257  
DC wiring terminations.......................................259  
DC-powered J4350, and J6350 routers, restricted  
access installation only ...................................108  
earthed mains socket (Norway and Sweden  
pinouts................................................................242  
trunk ports, TIM518  
pinouts................................................................244  
TST LED.......................................................................75  
turning on a Services Router......................................129  
TX/RX LED.......................................................23, 35, 54  
Type C fire extinguishers............................................107  
types of configuration statements................................94  
only)................................................................261  
electrical.............................................................252  
ESD strap to prevent router damage.....................27  
follow lifting guidelines...............................119, 121  
general................................................................249  
grounded equipment..........................................260  
installation..........................................................266  
jewelry removal..................................................277  
laser and LED.....................................................271  
levels defined......................................................247  
lightning activity.................................................278  
maintenance and operational.............................275  
multiple power supply disconnection..................262  
operating temperature........................................279  
personnel............................................................250  
power disconnection...........................................263  
product disposal.................................................281  
rack-mounting requirements...............................267  
ramp angle.........................................................271  
read installation instructions...............................266  
restricted access location for DC-powered  
U
U port See ISDN BRI ports  
United States, compliance statements........................287  
universal serial bus See USB  
unpacking the router..................................................118  
uPIMs, Gigabit Ethernet See Gigabit Ethernet uPIMs  
URLs  
datasheets.............................................................43  
PIM information and datasheets...........................43  
release notes.........................................................xv  
return and repair policies....................................217  
support...............................................................212  
USB (universal serial bus)  
storage device, installing.....................................187  
storage device, removing....................................186  
storage device, replacing.....................................186  
USB port.........................................................24, 36  
user interfaces  
J-Web graphical user interface (GUI)......................41  
See also J-Web interface  
routers..................................25, 37, 38, 119, 120  
rotating fans, compact flash  
JUNOS command-line interface (CLI)....................41  
See also JUNOS CLI  
JUNOScope application.........................................42  
overview...............................................................81  
preparation...........................................................82  
SRC application.....................................................42  
replacement............................................179, 182  
safe rack order for multiple routers.............119, 121  
telecommunications lines...................................265  
TN power system................................................264  
Web access, secure See secure access  
Web browser, modifying Internet Explorer for  
worldwide version of JUNOS software......................83  
weight  
V
J2320....................................................................17  
J2350....................................................................17  
J4350....................................................................30  
J6350....................................................................30  
rack-mount requirements...........................104, 105  
windows, J-Web, unpredictable results with  
multiple....................................................................90  
wire gauge  
for grounding cables...........................................123  
for telecommunications lines..............................265  
wiring guidelines  
V.35 DCE cable pinouts..............................................231  
V.35 DTE cable pinouts..............................................230  
ventilation requirement..............................................103  
verification  
active licenses.....................................................166  
basic connectivity...............................................150  
license usage.......................................................167  
licenses ..............................................................166  
secure access......................................................159  
version, license key....................................................163  
voice over IP See Avaya VoIP modules  
DC wiring sequence warning..............................257  
DC wiring terminations warning.........................259  
radio frequency interference (RFI)......................108  
VoIP See Avaya VoIP modules  
Index  
309  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
J2320, J2350, J4350, and J6350 Services Router Getting Started Guide  
signaling limitations............................................108  
suppressing electromagnetic interference  
(EMI)...............................................................108  
working directory, setting............................................98  
X
X.21 DCE cable pinouts.............................................232  
X.21 DTE cable pinouts..............................................231  
310  
Index  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  

Ingersoll Rand Remote Starter 3524832 User Manual
Jenn Air Cooktop CVEX4370B User Manual
JVC Battery Charger AA V15U User Manual
JVC DVD Player XV N372S User Manual
JVC DVD Recorder DR M70SEK User Manual
Karcher Vacuum Cleaner A 2701 User Manual
Kenmore Dishwasher 66516652 User Manual
Kenwood CD Player CD RECEIVER User Manual
KitchenAid Oven KEBI140 User Manual
Klaxon Smoke Alarm 18 980181 User Manual